48cb0155e78d1db7250019dca19cef740ae33dd6
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2017
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458 .cindex "wiki"
459 .cindex "FAQ"
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466 .cindex Bugzilla
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477 .table2 140pt
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482 .endtable
483
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 via this web page:
490 .display
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 .endd
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 lists.
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
512 .endd
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
516
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
521 .display
522 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
524 .endd
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
528
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
540
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
545
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
549
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
551 .display
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
554 .endd
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
558
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
563 .display
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 .endd
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
571
572
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
574 .ilist
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
582 .next
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
589 arrival.
590 .next
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
599 .next
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
603 other means.
604 .next
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
610 .endlist
611
612
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
619
620
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
633
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
638
639
640
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
647
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
656
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
660 otherwise.
661
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
665 until a later time.
666
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
670
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
679
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
686 line.
687
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
693
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
700
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
703 message's envelope.
704
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
710
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
716
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723
724
725
726
727
728
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
731
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
735 .cindex "PCRE"
736 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
738
739 .ilist
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
746 .next
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
753
754 .blockquote
755 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
756
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
760 version.
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
766 .endblockquote
767 .next
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
774 under the Gnu GPL.
775 .next
776 .cindex "Cyrus"
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
783
784 .blockquote
785 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
786
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
789 are met:
790
791 .olist
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
794 .next
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
798 distribution.
799 .next
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
804 .display
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
807 5000 Forbes Avenue
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
811 .endd
812 .next
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
814 acknowledgment:
815
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
818
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
826 .endlist
827 .endblockquote
828
829 .next
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
831 .cindex "X-windows"
832 .cindex "Athena"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
837
838 .blockquote
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
841
842 All Rights Reserved
843
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
851
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
858 SOFTWARE.
859 .endblockquote
860
861 .next
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
867 source code.
868
869 .next
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873 .endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904 .ilist
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914 error code.
915 .next
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918 .next
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923 .next
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929 .next
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933 .next
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
937 .endlist
938
939
940
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
950
951 .ilist
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953 by RFC 3028.
954 .next
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957 .endlist
958
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
967 .cindex "base62"
968 .cindex "base36"
969 .cindex "Darwin"
970 .cindex "Cygwin"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
979
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986 somewhat eccentric:
987
988 .ilist
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
993 .next
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
996 .next
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998 .olist
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004 .next
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1008 .endlist
1009 .endlist
1010
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1025
1026 .ilist
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030 .next
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037 .next
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043 .next
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048 .endlist
1049
1050
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1103
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140 to be sent.
1141
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158 systems.
1159
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1198
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203 to be bounced.
1204
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222 configuration.
1223
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1233
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279 the following:
1280
1281 .ilist
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290 end of routing.
1291
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297 .next
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303 .next
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309 .next
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313 .next
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318 .next
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321 .endlist
1322
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355 .ilist
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366 address.
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1372 .next
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1378 .next
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1382 .next
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1385 .next
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1388 .next
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1399 .next
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1402 .vindex "&$home$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1408 .next
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1414 .next
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1417 .next
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1420 .next
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1425 .endlist
1426
1427
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1435
1436
1437
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1441
1442 .ilist
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1448 filtering'&.
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1451
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1458 filter.
1459 .next
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1465 .next
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1475 .next
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1484 .next
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1493 .next
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1511 .next
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1516 .next
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1520 &'deferred'&.
1521 .next
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1525 .endlist
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1543
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1549 as permanent.
1550
1551
1552
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1562 also apply.
1563
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1567 deferred,
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1573 one connection.
1574
1575
1576
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1588
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1592 automatically.
1593
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1601 of the list.
1602
1603
1604
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1623
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1628
1629 .table2 140pt
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1632 documented"
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1637 instructions"
1638 .endtable
1639
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1642
1643 .table2 140pt
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1656
1657
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1664 system.
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1673
1674
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1689
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1697
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1706
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1715
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1718 possibilities:
1719
1720 .olist
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1723 .next
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1729 .next
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1734 .next
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1738 .next
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1745 .next
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1750 .endlist
1751
1752 .cindex "USE_DB"
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1758 .code
1759 USE_DB=yes
1760 .endd
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1763
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1770
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1774 .code
1775 DBMLIB = -ldb
1776 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1777 .endd
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1782 this example:
1783 .code
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1786 .endd
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1789
1790
1791
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1804
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1811
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1818 be logged.
1819
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1824 .code
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1826 .endd
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1829
1830
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1838
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1844 do this.
1845
1846
1847
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1850 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1858
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1864 .code
1865 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1866 .endd
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1868
1869
1870
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1881 line option).
1882
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1885 implementing SSL.
1886
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1888 .code
1889 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1891 .endd
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1894 .code
1895 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1898 .endd
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1904 .endd
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1907 .code
1908 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1909 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1911 .endd
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1926 .endd
1927
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1936
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1949 you might have
1950 .code
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1954 .endd
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1957 .code
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1959 .endd
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1966 further details.
1967
1968
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1975 library files.
1976
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1982 Exim used to
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1984 withdrawn.
1985
1986
1987
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1994 on demand.
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1997 dependencies.
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1999
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2006
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2010 on demand:
2011 .code
2012 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2013 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2014 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2015 .endd
2016
2017
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2027
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2036
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2040
2041
2042
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2050 .code
2051 FULLECHO='' make -e
2052 .endd
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2056
2057
2058
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2066 order:
2067 .display
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2070 &_Local/Makefile_&
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2075 .endd
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2083
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2093
2094
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2099 default values are.
2100
2101
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2115 .code
2116 CC=cc
2117 CFLAGS=-std1
2118 .endd
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2121
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2125
2126
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2137 .code
2138 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2139 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2140 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2141 .endd
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2150 errors.
2151
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2163 .code
2164 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2166 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2170 .endd
2171
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2175 .code
2176 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2177 .endd
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2180
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2187 .code
2188 X11=/usr/X11R6
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2191 .endd
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/openwin
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2202
2203 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2208
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2214 libraries.
2215
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2221
2222
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2224 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2231
2232
2233
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2238 .display
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2245 .endd
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2253 .ecindex IIDbuex
2254
2255
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2270
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2278
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2287
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2293
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2299 over SMTP.
2300
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2303 command such as
2304 .code
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2306 .endd
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2312
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2319
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2331 command:
2332 .code
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2334 .endd
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2339 command:
2340 .code
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2342 .endd
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2345
2346 .ilist
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2349 .next
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2351 installed binary.
2352 .endlist
2353
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2355 .code
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2357 .endd
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2361 .code
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2363 .endd
2364
2365
2366
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2372 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2373
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2377
2378
2379
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2385 necessary.
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2395 .code
2396 exim -bV
2397 .endd
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2403 example,
2404 .display
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2406 .endd
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2408 .display
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2410 .endd
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2414 .code
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2419
2420 This is a test message.
2421 ^D
2422 .endd
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2426
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2433 .display
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2435 .endd
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2441
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2456
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2462 incoming SMTP mail.
2463
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2468 production version.
2469
2470
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2484
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2491 as follows:
2492 .code
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2497 .endd
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2501
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2508
2509
2510
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2519 configuration file.
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2527 .code
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2529 .endd
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2535 .code
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2537 .endd
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2539
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2549
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2559
2560
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2562 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2566 standard output.
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2570
2571 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2575 format.
2576
2577 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2581
2582 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2596
2597
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2604
2605 .ilist
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2612
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2620
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2628
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2635 .next
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2641
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2646
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2651
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2654 false.
2655 .endlist
2656
2657
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2661 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2674
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2680
2681 .literal xml
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2683 .literal off
2684
2685
2686 .vlist
2687 .vitem &%--%&
2688 .oindex "--"
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2693
2694 .vitem &%--help%&
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2698 no arguments.
2699
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2703 displayed.
2704
2705 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2706 &%-Am%&
2707 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2708 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2710 ignored by Exim.
2711
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2713 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2718
2719 .vitem &%-bd%&
2720 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2721 .cindex "daemon"
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2727
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2732
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2737
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2745 running as root.
2746
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2750
2751 The SIGHUP signal
2752 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2760
2761 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2762 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-be%&
2767 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2774
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2780
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2788
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2793
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3059
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3064
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3068
3069 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3070 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3078
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3084
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3089
3090
3091 .vitem &%-bP%&
3092 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3099 .code
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3101 .endd
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3108 .code
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3110 .endd
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3113
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3123
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3131
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133 .code
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3135 .endd
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3145 .code
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147 .endd
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 &%authenticators%&.
3154
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3158 variables.
3159
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3165
3166 .vitem &%-bp%&
3167 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3168 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3169 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3170 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3171 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3172 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3173 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3174 to allow any user to see the queue.
3175
3176 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3177 .code
3178 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3179 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3180 <other addresses>
3181 .endd
3182 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3183 .cindex "size" "of message"
3184 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3185 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3186 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3187 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3188 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3189 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3190 before the sender address.
3191
3192 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3193 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3194 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3195
3196 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3197 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3198 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3199 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3200 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3201 complete.
3202
3203
3204 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3205 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3206 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3207 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3208 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3209 of just &"D"&.
3210
3211
3212 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3213 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3214 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3215 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3216 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3217 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3218
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3222 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3223 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3224 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3225 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3226
3227 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3228 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3229 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3230
3231 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3232 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3237 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3238 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3239 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3240 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3241 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3242
3243
3244 .vitem &%-brt%&
3245 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3246 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3247 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3248 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3249 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3250 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3251 .code
3252 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3253 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3254 .endd
3255 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3256 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3257 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3258 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3259 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3260 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3261 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3262 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3263 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3264 .code
3265 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3266 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3267 .endd
3268
3269 .vitem &%-brw%&
3270 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3271 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3272 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3273 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3274 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3275 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3276 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3277 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3278
3279 .vitem &%-bS%&
3280 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3281 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3282 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3283 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3284 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3285 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3286 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3287 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3288 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3289 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3290
3291 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3292 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3293 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3294
3295 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3296 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3297 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3298 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3299
3300 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3301 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3302 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3303
3304 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3305 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3306 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3307 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3308 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3309
3310 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3311 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3312
3313 .vitem &%-bs%&
3314 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3315 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3316 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3317 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3318 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3319 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3320 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3321 messages to the MTA.
3322
3323 In
3324 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3325 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3326 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3327 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3328 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3329 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3330 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332 .cindex "inetd"
3333 The
3334 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3335 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3336 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3337 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3338 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3339 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3340 the listening daemon.
3341
3342 .vitem &%-bt%&
3343 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3344 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3345 .cindex "address" "testing"
3346 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3347 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3348 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3349 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3350 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3351
3352 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3353 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3354
3355 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3356 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3357 security issues.
3358
3359 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3360 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3361 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3362 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3363 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3364 program.
3365
3366 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3367 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3368 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3369 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3370
3371 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3372 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3373 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3374 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3375 always shown.
3376
3377 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3378 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3379 message,
3380 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3381 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3382 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3383 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3384 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3385 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3386 doing such tests.
3387
3388 .vitem &%-bV%&
3389 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3390 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3391 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3392 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3393 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3394 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3395 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3396
3397 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3398 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3399 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3400 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3401 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3402 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3403 dynamic testing facilities.
3404
3405 .vitem &%-bv%&
3406 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3407 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3408 .cindex "address" "verification"
3409 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3410 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3411 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3412 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3413 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3414 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3415
3416 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3417 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3418 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3419
3420 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3421 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3422
3423 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3424 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3425 security issues.
3426
3427 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3428 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3429 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3430 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3431 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3432
3433 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3434 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3435 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3436 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3437 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3438 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3439 to succeed.
3440
3441 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3442 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3443 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3444
3445 The
3446 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3447 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3448 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3449 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3450
3451 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3452 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3453 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3454 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3455
3456 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3457 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3458 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3459 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3460 might happen.
3461
3462 .vitem &%-bw%&
3463 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3464 .cindex "daemon"
3465 .cindex "inetd"
3466 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3467 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3468 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3469 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3470
3471 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3472 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3473 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3474 each port only when the first connection is received.
3475
3476 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3477 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3478
3479 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3480 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3481 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3482 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3483 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3484 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3485 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3486 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3487 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3488 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3489 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3490
3491 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3492 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3493 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3494 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3495 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3496 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3497 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3498 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3499 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3500
3501 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3502 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3503 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3504 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3505 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3506 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3507 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3508
3509 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3510 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3511 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3512 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3513 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3514 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3515 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3516
3517 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3518 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3519 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3520 configuration file.
3521
3522 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3523 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3524 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3525 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3526 specified by this option.
3527
3528
3529 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3530 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3531 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3532 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3533 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3534 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3535 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3536 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3537
3538 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3539 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3540 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3541 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3542 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3543 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3544 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3545
3546 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3547 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3548 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3549 synonymous:
3550 .code
3551 exim -DABC ...
3552 exim -DABC= ...
3553 .endd
3554 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3555 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3556 example:
3557 .code
3558 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3559 .endd
3560 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3561 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3562
3563
3564 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3565 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3566 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3567 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3568 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3569 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3570 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3571 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3572 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3573 return code.
3574
3575 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3576 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3577 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3578 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3579 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3580 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3581 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3582 are:
3583 .display
3584 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3585 &`auth `& authenticators
3586 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3587 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3588 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3589 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3590 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3591 &`filter `& filter handling
3592 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3593 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3594 &`ident `& ident lookup
3595 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3596 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3597 &`load `& system load checks
3598 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3599 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3600 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3601 &`memory `& memory handling
3602 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3603 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3604 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3605 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3606 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3607 &`retry `& retry handling
3608 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3609 &`route `& address routing
3610 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3611 &`tls `& TLS logic
3612 &`transport `& transports
3613 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3614 &`verify `& address verification logic
3615 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3616 .endd
3617 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3618 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3619 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3620 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3621 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3622 turn everything off.
3623
3624 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3625 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3626 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3627 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3628 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3629 rather than stderr.
3630
3631 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3632 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3633 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3634 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3635 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3636 run in parallel.
3637
3638 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3639 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3640 in processing.
3641
3642 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3643 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3644
3645 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3646 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3647 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3648 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3649 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3650 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3651
3652 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3653 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3654 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3655 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3656 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-E%&
3659 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3660 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3661 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3662 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3663 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3664 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3665 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3666 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3667 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3668
3669 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3670 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3671 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3672 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3673 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3674 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3675
3676 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3677 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3678 .cindex "sender" "name"
3679 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3680 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3681 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3682 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3683 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3684 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3685
3686 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3687 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3688 .cindex "sender" "address"
3689 .cindex "address" "sender"
3690 .cindex "trusted users"
3691 .cindex "envelope sender"
3692 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3693 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3694 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3695 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3696 users to use it.
3697
3698 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3699 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3700 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3701 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3702 domain.
3703
3704 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3705 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3706 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3707 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3708 examples of shell commands:
3709 .code
3710 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3711 exim -f "" user@domain
3712 .endd
3713 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3714 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3715 &%-bv%& options.
3716
3717 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3718 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3719 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3720 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3721
3722 White
3723 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3724 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3725 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3726 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3727 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3728 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3729
3730 .vitem &%-G%&
3731 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3732 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3733 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3734 .code
3735 control = suppress_local_fixups
3736 .endd
3737 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3738 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3739 in future.
3740
3741 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3742 this option.
3743
3744 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3745 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3746 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3747 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3748 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3749 headers.)
3750
3751 .vitem &%-i%&
3752 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3753 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3754 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3755 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3756 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3757 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3758 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3759
3760 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3761 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3762 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3763 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3764 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3765 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3766 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3767 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3768
3769 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3770
3771 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3772 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3773 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3774 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3775 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3776 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3777 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3778 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3779 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3780
3781 Retry
3782 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3783 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3784 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3785 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3786 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3787 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3788
3789 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3790 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3791 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3792 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3793
3794 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3795 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3796 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3797 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3798 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3799 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3800 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3801 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3802 can be used only by an admin user.
3803
3804 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3805 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3806 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3807 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3808 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3809 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3812 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3813 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3814 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3815
3816 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3817 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3818 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3819 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3820 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3821
3822 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3823 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3824 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3825 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3826 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3827
3828 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3829 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3830 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3831 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3832 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3833
3834 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3835 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3836 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3837 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3838 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3839
3840 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3841 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3842 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3843 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3844 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3847 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3850 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3851 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3852 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3853 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3854
3855 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3856 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3857 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3859 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3860 connection.
3861
3862 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3863 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3864 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3865 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3866 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3869 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3870 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3872 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3873 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3876 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3877 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3878 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3879 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3880 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3881 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3882 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3883 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3884 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3885 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3886 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3887 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3888 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3889 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3890
3891 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3892 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3893 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3894 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3895 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3896 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3897 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3898 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3899 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3900 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3904 .cindex "freezing messages"
3905 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3906 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3907 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3908 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3909 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3910 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3911 user.
3912
3913 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3915 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3916 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3917 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3918 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3919 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3920 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3921 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3922 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3923 user.
3924
3925 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3926 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3927 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3928 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3929 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3930 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3931 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3932
3933 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3934 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3935 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3936 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3937 .cindex "removing recipients"
3938 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3939 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3940 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3941 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3942 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3943 can be used only by an admin user.
3944
3945 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3947 .cindex "removing messages"
3948 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3949 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3950 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3951 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3952 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3953 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3954 placed on the queue.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3958 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3959 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3960 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3961 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3962 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3963 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3964 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3965 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3966 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3967
3968 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3969 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3970 .cindex "thawing messages"
3971 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3972 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3973 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3974 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3975 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3976 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3977 by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3981 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3984 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3987 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3988 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3989 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3990 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3991 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3992 only by an admin user.
3993
3994 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3995 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3996 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3997 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3998 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3999 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4000 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4001
4002 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4003 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4004 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4005 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4006 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4007 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4008
4009 .vitem &%-m%&
4010 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4011 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4012 treats it that way too.
4013
4014 .vitem &%-N%&
4015 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4016 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4017 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4018 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4019 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4020 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4021 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4022 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4023 than &"=>"&.
4024
4025 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4026 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4027 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4028 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4029 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4030 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4031 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4032 for that message.
4033
4034 .vitem &%-n%&
4035 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4036 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4037 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4038 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4039 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4040
4041 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4042 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4043 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4044 Exim.
4045
4046 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4047 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4048 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4049 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4050 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4051 description above.
4052
4053 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4054 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4055 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4056 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4057 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4058 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4059 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4060 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4061
4062 .vitem &%-odb%&
4063 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4064 .cindex "background delivery"
4065 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4066 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4067 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4068 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4069 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4070 processes to finish.
4071
4072 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4073 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4074 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4075 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4076
4077 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4078 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4079 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4080 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4081
4082 .vitem &%-odf%&
4083 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4084 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4085 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4086 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4087 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4088 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4089 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4090
4091 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4092 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4093 during deliveries.
4094
4095 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4096 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4097
4098 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4099 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4100 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4101 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4102
4103
4104 .vitem &%-odi%&
4105 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4106 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4107 Sendmail.
4108
4109 .vitem &%-odq%&
4110 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4111 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4112 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4113 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4114 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4115 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4116 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4117 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4118 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4119 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4120 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4121 forces queueing.
4122
4123 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4124 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4125 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4126 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4127 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4128 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4129 configuration file is in effect.
4130
4131 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4132 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4133 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4134 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4135 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4136 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4137 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4138 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4139 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4140 &%-qq%& option.
4141
4142 .vitem &%-oee%&
4143 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4144 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4145 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4146 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4147 message.
4148
4149 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4150 Provided
4151 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4152 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4153 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4154 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4155
4156 .vitem &%-oem%&
4157 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4158 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4159 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4160 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4161 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4162 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4163
4164 .vitem &%-oep%&
4165 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4166 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4167 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4168 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4169 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4170 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4171
4172 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4173 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4174 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4175 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4176 effect as &%-oep%&.
4177
4178 .vitem &%-oew%&
4179 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4180 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4181 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4182 effect as &%-oem%&.
4183
4184 .vitem &%-oi%&
4185 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4186 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4187 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4188 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4189 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4190 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4191 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4192
4193 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4194 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4195 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4199 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4200 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4201 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4202 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4203 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4204 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4205
4206 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4207 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4208 .code
4209 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4210 .endd
4211 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4212 followed by a colon and the port number:
4213 .code
4214 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4215 .endd
4216 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4217 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4218 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4219 whichever one is last.
4220
4221 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4222 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4223 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4224 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4225 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4226 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4227 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4228 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4229
4230 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4231 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4232 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4233 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4234 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4235 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4236 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4237 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4238
4239 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4240 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4241 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4242 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4243 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4244 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4245 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4246 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4247 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4248 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4249
4250 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4251 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4252 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4253 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4254 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4255 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4256 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4257
4258 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4259 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4260 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4261 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4262 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4263 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4264 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4265 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4266 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4267
4268 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4269 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4270 is sending the bounce.
4271
4272 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4273 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4274 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4275 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4276 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4277 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4278 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4279 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4280 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4281 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4282 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4283 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4284
4285 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4286 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4287 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4288 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4289 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4290 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4291 uses the name it is given.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4294 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4295 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4296 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4297 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4298 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4299 used, when there is no default.
4300
4301 .vitem &%-om%&
4302 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4303 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4304 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4305 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4306 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-oo%&
4309 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4310 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4311 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4312 whatever that means.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4315 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4316 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4317 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4318 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4319 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4320 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4321 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4322 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4323
4324 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4325 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4326 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4327 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4328 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4329 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4330 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4333 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4334 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4335 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4336 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4337 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4338 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4339 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4340
4341 .vitem &%-ov%&
4342 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4343 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4346 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4347 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4348 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4349 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4350 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4351 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4352 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4353 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4354 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4355
4356 .vitem &%-pd%&
4357 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4358 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4359 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4360 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4361 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4362 needed.
4363
4364 .vitem &%-ps%&
4365 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4366 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4367 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4368 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4369 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4370 started.
4371
4372 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4373 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4374 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4375 .display
4376 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4377 .endd
4378 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4379 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4380 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4381 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4382 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4383 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4384
4385 .vitem &%-q%&
4386 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4387 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4388 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4389 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4390 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4391 and &%-S%& options).
4392
4393 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4394 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4395 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4396 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4397 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4398 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4399 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4400
4401 If
4402 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4403 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4404 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4405 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4406 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4407 proceeding.
4408
4409 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4410 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4411 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4412 this to be repeated periodically.
4413
4414 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4415 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4416 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4417 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4418
4419 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4420 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4421 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4422
4423 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4424 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4425 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4426 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4427
4428 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4429 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4430 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4431 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4432 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4433 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4434 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4435 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4436 transports are run.
4437
4438 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4439 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4440 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4441 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4442 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4443 delivered down a single SMTP
4444 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4445 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4446 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4447 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4448 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4449 intermittently.
4450
4451 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4452 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4453 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4454 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4455 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4456 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4457 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4458
4459 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4460 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4461 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4462 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4463 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4464 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4465 their retry times are tried.
4466
4467 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4468 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4469 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4470 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4471 frozen or not.
4472
4473 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4474 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4475 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4476 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4477 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4478 for later delivery.
4479
4480 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4481 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4482 .cindex queue named
4483 .cindex "named queues"
4484 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4485 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4486 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4487 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4488 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4489 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4490
4491 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4492 will specify a queue to operate on.
4493 For example:
4494 .code
4495 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4496 mailq -qGquarantine
4497 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4498 .endd
4499
4500 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4501 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4502 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4503 starting message id. For example:
4504 .code
4505 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4506 .endd
4507 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4508 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4509 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4510 .code
4511 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4512 .endd
4513 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4514 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4515 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4516 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4517 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4518 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4519
4520 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4521 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4522 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4523 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4524 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4525 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4526 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4527 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4528 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4529 .code
4530 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4531 .endd
4532 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4533 process every 30 minutes.
4534
4535 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4536 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4537
4538 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4539 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4540 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4541 compatibility.
4542
4543 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4545 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4546
4547 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4548 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4549 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4550 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4551 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4552 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4553 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4554 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4555 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4556
4557 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4558 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4559 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4560 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4561 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4562 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4563
4564 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4565 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4566 .code
4567 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4568 .endd
4569 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4570 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4571 applied to each queue run.
4572
4573 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4574 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4575 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4576 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4577 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4578 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4579 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4580 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4581 address will be skipped.
4582
4583 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4584 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4585 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4586 &'ff'& is present.
4587
4588 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4589 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4590 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4591 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4592 an arbitrary command instead.
4593
4594 .vitem &%-r%&
4595 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4596 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4597
4598 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4599 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4600 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4601 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4602 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4603 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4604 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4605 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4608 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4609 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4610 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4611 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4612
4613 .vitem &%-t%&
4614 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4615 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4616 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4617 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4618 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4619 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4620 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4621 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4622 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4623 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4624
4625 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4626 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4627 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4628 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4629 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4630 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4631 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4632 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4633 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4634 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4635 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4636
4637 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4638 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4639 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4640 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4641 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4642 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4643
4644 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4645 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4646 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4647 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4648 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4649 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4650 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4651 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4652 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4653
4654 .vitem &%-ti%&
4655 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4656 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4657 compatibility with Sendmail.
4658
4659 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4660 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4661 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4662 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4663 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4664 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4665 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4666 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4667
4668
4669 .vitem &%-U%&
4670 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4671 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4672 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4673 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4674 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4675 set. Exim ignores this option.
4676
4677 .vitem &%-v%&
4678 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4679 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4680 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4681 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4682 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4683 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4684 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4685 unconditional.
4686
4687 .vitem &%-x%&
4688 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4689 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4690 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4691 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4692 this option.
4693
4694 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4695 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4696 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4697 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4698
4699 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4700 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4701 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4702 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4703 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4704 under most shells.
4705 .endlist
4706
4707 .ecindex IIDclo1
4708 .ecindex IIDclo2
4709
4710
4711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4712 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4713 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4714 . creates a man page for the options.
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716
4717 .literal xml
4718 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4719 .literal off
4720
4721
4722
4723
4724
4725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4727
4728
4729 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4730 "The runtime configuration file"
4731
4732 .cindex "run time configuration"
4733 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4734 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4735 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4736 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4737 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4738 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4739 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4740 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4741 control.
4742
4743 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4744 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4745 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4746 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4747 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4748 actually alter the string.
4749
4750 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4751 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4752 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4753 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4754 existing file in the list.
4755
4756 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4757 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4758 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4759 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4760 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4761 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4762 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4763 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4764 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4765 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4766 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4767
4768 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4769 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4770 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4771 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4772 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4773
4774 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4775 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4776 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4777 compromise the Exim user account.
4778
4779 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4780 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4781 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4782 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4783 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4784 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4785 configuration.
4786
4787
4788
4789 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4790 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4791 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4792 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4793 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4794 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4795 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4796 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4797 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4798 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4799 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4800
4801 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4802 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4803 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4804 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4805 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4806 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4807 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4808 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4809 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4810 &%-M%&).
4811
4812 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4813 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4814 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4815 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4816 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4817
4818 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4819 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4820 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4821 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4822 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4823 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4824
4825 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4826 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4827 necessarily be discarded.
4828 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4829 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4830 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4831 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4832 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4833 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4834
4835 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4836 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4837 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4838 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4839 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4840 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4841 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4842
4843 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4844 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4845 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4846
4847
4848
4849 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4850 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4851 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4852 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4853 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4854 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4855 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4856 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4857
4858 .ilist
4859 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4860 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4861 .next
4862 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4863 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4864 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4865 .next
4866 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4867 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4868 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4869 .next
4870 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4871 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4873 .next
4874 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4875 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4876 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4877 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4878 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4879 .next
4880 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4881 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4882 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4883 .next
4884 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4885 want to use this feature, you must set
4886 .code
4887 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4888 .endd
4889 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4890 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4891 .endlist
4892
4893 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4894 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4895 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4896 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4897
4898 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4899 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4900 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4901 and does not introduce a comment.
4902
4903 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4904 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4905 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4906 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4907 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4908
4909 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4910 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4911 change settings as required.
4912
4913 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4914 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4915 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4916 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4917 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4918 described.
4919
4920
4921
4922 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4923 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4924 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4925 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4926 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4927 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4928 using this syntax:
4929 .display
4930 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4931 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4932 .endd
4933 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4934 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4935 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4936 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4937 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4938 name is required.
4939
4940 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4941 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4942 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4943 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4944
4945 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4946 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4947 for example:
4948 .code
4949 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4950 .include /some/file
4951 .endd
4952 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4953 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4954 inclusion appears.
4955
4956
4957
4958 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4959 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4960 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4961 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4962 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4963 definition, and must be of the form
4964 .display
4965 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4966 .endd
4967 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4968 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4969 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4970 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4971 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4972
4973 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4974 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4975 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4976
4977 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4978 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4979 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4980 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4981 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4982 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4983 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4984 define
4985 .display
4986 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4987 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4988 .endd
4989 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4990 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4991 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4992 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4993 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4994 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4995
4996
4997 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4998 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4999 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5000 &'='&. For example:
5001 .code
5002 MAC = initial value
5003 ...
5004 MAC == updated value
5005 .endd
5006 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5007 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5008 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5009 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5010 .code
5011 MAC = initial value
5012 ...
5013 MAC == MAC and something added
5014 .endd
5015 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5016 from a number of other files.
5017
5018 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5019 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5020 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5021 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5022 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5023 file to be ignored.
5024
5025
5026
5027 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5028 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5029 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5030 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5031 .code
5032 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5033 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5034 .endd
5035 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5036 .code
5037 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5038 .endd
5039 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5040 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5041 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5042
5043
5044 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5045 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5046 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5047 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5048 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5049 (see below).
5050
5051 The following classes of macros are defined:
5052 .display
5053 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5054 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5055 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5056 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5057 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5058 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5059 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5060 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5061 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5062 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5063 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5064 .endd
5065
5066 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5067
5068
5069 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5070 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5071 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5072 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5073 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5074 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5075 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5076
5077 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5078 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5079 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5080 line. Thus:
5081 .code
5082 .ifdef AAA
5083 message_size_limit = 50M
5084 .else
5085 message_size_limit = 100M
5086 .endif
5087 .endd
5088 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5089 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5090 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5091 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5092 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5093
5094 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5095 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5096 in this line"& will always be true.
5097
5098 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5099 to clarify complicated nestings.
5100
5101
5102
5103 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5104 .cindex "common option syntax"
5105 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5106 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5107 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5108 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5109 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5110 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5111 space) and then the value. For example:
5112 .code
5113 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5114 .endd
5115 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5116 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5117 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5118 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5119 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5120 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5121 word &"hide"&. For example:
5122 .code
5123 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5124 .endd
5125 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5126 .code
5127 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5128 .endd
5129 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5130 all instances of the same driver.
5131
5132 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5133 that are found in option settings.
5134
5135
5136 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5137 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5138 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5139 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5140 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5141 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5142 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5143 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5144 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5145 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5146 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5147 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5148 .code
5149 queue_only
5150 queue_only = true
5151 .endd
5152 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5153 .code
5154 no_queue_only
5155 queue_only = false
5156 .endd
5157 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5158
5159
5160
5161
5162 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5163 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5164 .cindex "format" "integer"
5165 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5166 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5167 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5168 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5169 hexadecimal number.
5170
5171 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5172 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5173 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5174 When the values
5175 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5176 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5177 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5178 used.
5179
5180
5181 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5182 .cindex "integer format"
5183 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5184 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5185 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5186 Such options are always output in octal.
5187
5188
5189 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5190 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5191 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5192 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5193 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5194
5195
5196
5197 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5198 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5199 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5200 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5201 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5202
5203 .table2 30pt
5204 .irow &%s%& seconds
5205 .irow &%m%& minutes
5206 .irow &%h%& hours
5207 .irow &%d%& days
5208 .irow &%w%& weeks
5209 .endtable
5210
5211 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5212 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5213 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5214
5215
5216
5217 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5218 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5219 .cindex "format" "string"
5220 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5221 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5222 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5223 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5224 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5225 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5226 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5227 therefore equivalent:
5228 .code
5229 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5230 trusted_users = uucp:\
5231 # This comment line is ignored
5232 mail
5233 .endd
5234 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5235 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5236 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5237 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5238 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5239
5240 .table2 100pt
5241 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5242 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5243 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5244 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5245 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5246 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5247 character"
5248 .endtable
5249
5250 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5251 character, that character replaces the pair.
5252
5253 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5254 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5255 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5256 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5257 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5258 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5259
5260
5261 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5262 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5263 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5264 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5265 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5266 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5267 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5268 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5269 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5270 within a quoted configuration string.
5271
5272
5273 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5274 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5275 .cindex "format" "user name"
5276 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5277 .cindex "format" "group name"
5278 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5279 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5280 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5281 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5282
5283
5284 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5285 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5286 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5287 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5288 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5289 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5290 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5291 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5292 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5293 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5294 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5295
5296 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5297 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5298 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5299 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5300 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5301 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5302 example, the list
5303 .code
5304 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5305 .endd
5306 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5307
5308 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5309 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5310 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5311 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5312
5313 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5314 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5315 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5316 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5317 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5318 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5319 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5320 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5321 .code
5322 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5323 .endd
5324 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5325 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5326 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5327
5328 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5329 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5330 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5331 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5332 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5333 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5334 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5335 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5336 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5337 .code
5338 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5339 .endd
5340 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5341 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5342 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5343 the value in quotes. For example:
5344 .code
5345 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5346 .endd
5347 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5348 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5349 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5350 enclosing an empty list item.
5351
5352
5353
5354 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5355 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5356 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5357 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5358 .code
5359 senders = user@domain :
5360 .endd
5361 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5362 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5363 items, the second of which is empty:
5364 .code
5365 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5366 .endd
5367 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5368 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5369 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5370 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5371 .code
5372 senders = :
5373 .endd
5374 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5375 is at the end of the list.
5376
5377
5378
5379
5380 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5381 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5382 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5383 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5384 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5385 a sequence of lines like this:
5386 .display
5387 <&'instance name'&>:
5388 <&'option'&>
5389 ...
5390 <&'option'&>
5391 .endd
5392 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5393 followed by three options settings:
5394 .code
5395 localuser:
5396 driver = accept
5397 check_local_user
5398 transport = local_delivery
5399 .endd
5400 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5401 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5402 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5403 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5404 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5405 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5406
5407 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5408 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5409
5410 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5411 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5412 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5413 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5414 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5415 server.
5416
5417 .cindex "generic options"
5418 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5419 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5420 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5421 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5422 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5423 .cindex "private options"
5424 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5425 they all have default values.
5426
5427 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5428 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5429 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5430
5431 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5432 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5433 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5434 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5435 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5436 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5437 configuration lines:
5438 .code
5439 remote_smtp:
5440 driver = smtp
5441 .endd
5442 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5443 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5444 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5445 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5446 thus:
5447 .code
5448 special_smtp:
5449 driver = smtp
5450 port = 1234
5451 command_timeout = 10s
5452 .endd
5453 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5454 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5455 lines.
5456
5457 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5458 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5459 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5460 option.
5461
5462
5463
5464
5465
5466
5467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5469
5470 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5471 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5472 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5473 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5474 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5475 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5476 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5477 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5478 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5479 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5480 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5481
5482
5483
5484 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5485 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5486 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5487 the line
5488 .code
5489 # primary_hostname =
5490 .endd
5491 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5492 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5493 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5494 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5495
5496 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5497 .code
5498 domainlist local_domains = @
5499 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5500 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5501 .endd
5502 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5503 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5504 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5505 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5506
5507 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5508 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5509 on the local host.
5510
5511 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5512 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5513 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5514 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5515 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5516 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5517
5518 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5519 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5520 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5521 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5522 domain is permitted.
5523
5524 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5525 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5526 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5527 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5528 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5529 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5530
5531 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5532 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5533 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5534
5535 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5536 .code
5537 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5538 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5539 .endd
5540 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5541 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5542 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5543 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5544 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5545 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5546 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5547 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5548 contents of a message to be checked.
5549
5550 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5551 .code
5552 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5553 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5554 .endd
5555 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5556 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5557 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5558 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5559
5560 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5561 .code
5562 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5563 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5564 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5565 .endd
5566 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5567 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5568 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5569 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5570 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5571 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5572 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5573
5574 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5575 .code
5576 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5577 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5578 .endd
5579 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5580 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5581 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5582 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5583 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5584 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5585 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5586 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5587 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5588 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5589 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5590 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5591 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5592 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5593 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5594 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5595
5596 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5597 .code
5598 # qualify_domain =
5599 # qualify_recipient =
5600 .endd
5601 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5602 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5603 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5604 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5605 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5606 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5607
5608 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5609 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5610 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5611 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5612 .code
5613 # allow_domain_literals
5614 .endd
5615 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5616 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5617 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5618 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5619 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5620 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5621
5622 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5623 .code
5624 never_users = root
5625 .endd
5626 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5627 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5628 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5629 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5630 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5631 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5632 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5633 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5634
5635 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5636 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5637 line,
5638 .code
5639 host_lookup = *
5640 .endd
5641 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5642 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5643 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5644 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5645 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5646 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5647 unreachable.
5648
5649 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5650 1413 (hence their names):
5651 .code
5652 rfc1413_hosts = *
5653 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5654 .endd
5655 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5656 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5657 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5658 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5659 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5660 information, you can change this.
5661
5662 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5663 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5664 .code
5665 prdr_enable = true
5666 .endd
5667
5668 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5669 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5670 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5671 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5672 .code
5673 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5674 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5675 .endd
5676 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5677 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5678
5679 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5680 over the default:
5681 .code
5682 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5683 +tls_certificate_verified
5684 .endd
5685
5686 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5687 .code
5688 # percent_hack_domains =
5689 .endd
5690 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5691 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5692 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5693
5694 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5695 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5696 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5697 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5698 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5699 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5700 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5701 always bounce messages.
5702 .code
5703 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5704 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5705 .endd
5706 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5707 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5708 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5709 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5710 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5711
5712 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5713 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5714 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5715 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5716 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5717 not often needed).
5718 .code
5719 # split_spool_directory = true
5720 .endd
5721
5722 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5723 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5724 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5725 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5726 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5727 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5728 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5729 .code
5730 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5731 .endd
5732
5733 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5734 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5735 that are not 8-bit clean.
5736 .code
5737 # accept_8bitmime = false
5738 .endd
5739
5740 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5741 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5742 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5743 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5744 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5745 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5746 .code
5747 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5748 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5749 .endd
5750
5751
5752 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5753 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5754 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5755 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5756 It starts with the line
5757 .code
5758 begin acl
5759 .endd
5760 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5761 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5762 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5763
5764 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5765 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5766 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5767 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5768 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5769 result of the ACL processing.
5770 .code
5771 acl_check_rcpt:
5772 .endd
5773 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5774 ACL, and names it.
5775 .code
5776 accept hosts = :
5777 .endd
5778 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5779 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5780 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5781 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5782 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5783 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5784
5785 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5786 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5787 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5788 manner.
5789 .code
5790 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5791 domains = +local_domains
5792 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5793
5794 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5795 domains = !+local_domains
5796 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5797 .endd
5798 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5799 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5800 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5801 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5802 in Internet mail addresses.
5803
5804 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5805 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5806 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5807 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5808 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5809 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5810 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5811 policy of being as safe as possible.
5812
5813 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5814 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5815 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5816 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5817 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5818 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5819
5820 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5821 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5822 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5823 have to modify this rule.
5824
5825 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5826 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5827 common convention of local parts constructed as
5828 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5829 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5830 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5831 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5832 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5833 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5834
5835 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5836 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5837 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5838 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5839 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5840 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5841 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5842 .code
5843 accept local_parts = postmaster
5844 domains = +local_domains
5845 .endd
5846 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5847 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5848 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5849 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5850 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5851
5852 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5853 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5854 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5855 .code
5856 require verify = sender
5857 .endd
5858 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5859 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5860 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5861 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5862 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5863 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5864 discusses the details of address verification.
5865 .code
5866 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5867 control = submission
5868 .endd
5869 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5870 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5871 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5872 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5873 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5874 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5875 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5876 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5877 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5878 .code
5879 accept authenticated = *
5880 control = submission
5881 .endd
5882 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5883 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5884 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5885 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5886 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5887 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5888 .code
5889 require message = relay not permitted
5890 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5891 .endd
5892 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5893 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5894 .code
5895 require verify = recipient
5896 .endd
5897 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5898 fails, the address is rejected.
5899 .code
5900 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5901 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5902 # $dnslist_text
5903 # dnslists = black.list.example
5904 #
5905 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5906 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5907 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5908 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5909 .endd
5910 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5911 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5912 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5913 line.
5914 .code
5915 # require verify = csa
5916 .endd
5917 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5918 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5919 records.
5920 .code
5921 accept
5922 .endd
5923 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5924 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5925 .code
5926 acl_check_data:
5927 .endd
5928 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5929 of this ACL are commented out:
5930 .code
5931 # deny malware = *
5932 # message = This message contains a virus \
5933 # ($malware_name).
5934 .endd
5935 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5936 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5937 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5938 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5939 .code
5940 # warn spam = nobody
5941 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5942 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5943 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5944 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5945 .endd
5946 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5947 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5948 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5949 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5950 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5951 whatever the spam score.
5952 .code
5953 accept
5954 .endd
5955 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5956
5957
5958 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5959 .cindex "default" "routers"
5960 .cindex "routers" "default"
5961 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5962 by the line
5963 .code
5964 begin routers
5965 .endd
5966 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5967 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5968 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5969 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5970 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5971 .code
5972 # domain_literal:
5973 # driver = ipliteral
5974 # domains = !+local_domains
5975 # transport = remote_smtp
5976 .endd
5977 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5978 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5979 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5980 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5981 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5982 .code
5983 dnslookup:
5984 driver = dnslookup
5985 domains = ! +local_domains
5986 transport = remote_smtp
5987 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5988 no_more
5989 .endd
5990 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5991 domains. This is specified by the line
5992 .code
5993 domains = ! +local_domains
5994 .endd
5995 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5996 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5997 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5998 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5999 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6000 passed on to the following routers.
6001
6002 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6003 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6004 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6005 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6006 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6007
6008 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6009 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6010 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6011 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6012 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6013 the address fails and is bounced.
6014
6015 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6016 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6017 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6018 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6019 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6020 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6021 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6022 out.
6023 .code
6024 system_aliases:
6025 driver = redirect
6026 allow_fail
6027 allow_defer
6028 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6029 # user = exim
6030 file_transport = address_file
6031 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6032 .endd
6033 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6034 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6035 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6036 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6037 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6038 the next router.
6039
6040 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6041 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6042 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6043 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6044 .code
6045 userforward:
6046 driver = redirect
6047 check_local_user
6048 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6049 # local_part_suffix_optional
6050 file = $home/.forward
6051 # allow_filter
6052 no_verify
6053 no_expn
6054 check_ancestor
6055 file_transport = address_file
6056 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6057 reply_transport = address_reply
6058 .endd
6059 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6060 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6061 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6062 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6063 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6064 namely:
6065 .code
6066 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6067 # local_part_suffix_optional
6068 .endd
6069 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6070 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6071 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6072 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6073 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6074 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6075 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6076
6077 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6078 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6079 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6080 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6081
6082 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6083 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6084 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6085 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6086 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6087 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6088 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6089
6090 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6091 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6092 There are two reasons for doing this:
6093
6094 .olist
6095 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6096 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6097 unnecessary work.
6098 .next
6099 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6100 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6101 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6102 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6103 this time.
6104 .endlist
6105
6106 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6107 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6108 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6109 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6110
6111 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6112 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6113 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6114 .code
6115 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6116 .endd
6117 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6118 transport.
6119 .code
6120 localuser:
6121 driver = accept
6122 check_local_user
6123 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6124 # local_part_suffix_optional
6125 transport = local_delivery
6126 .endd
6127 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6128 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6129 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6130 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6131 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6132
6133
6134 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6135 .cindex "default" "transports"
6136 .cindex "transports" "default"
6137 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6138 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6139 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6140 .code
6141 begin transports
6142 .endd
6143 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6144 .code
6145 remote_smtp:
6146 driver = smtp
6147 hosts_try_prdr = *
6148 .endd
6149 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6150 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6151 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6152 It is negotiated between client and server
6153 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6154 All other options are defaulted.
6155 .code
6156 local_delivery:
6157 driver = appendfile
6158 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6159 delivery_date_add
6160 envelope_to_add
6161 return_path_add
6162 # group = mail
6163 # mode = 0660
6164 .endd
6165 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6166 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6167 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6168 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6169 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6170 show how this can be done.
6171
6172 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6173 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6174 similarly-named options above.
6175 .code
6176 address_pipe:
6177 driver = pipe
6178 return_output
6179 .endd
6180 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6181 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6182 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6183 be returned to the sender.
6184 .code
6185 address_file:
6186 driver = appendfile
6187 delivery_date_add
6188 envelope_to_add
6189 return_path_add
6190 .endd
6191 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6192 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6193 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6194 .code
6195 address_reply:
6196 driver = autoreply
6197 .endd
6198 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6199 filter files.
6200
6201
6202
6203 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6204 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6205 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6206 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6207 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6208 introduced by the line
6209 .code
6210 begin retry
6211 .endd
6212 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6213 errors:
6214 .code
6215 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6216 .endd
6217 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6218 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6219 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6220 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6221 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6222
6223 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6224 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6225 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6226
6227
6228 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6229 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6230 .code
6231 begin rewrite
6232 .endd
6233 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6234 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6235
6236
6237
6238 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6239 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6240 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6241 .code
6242 begin authenticators
6243 .endd
6244 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6245 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6246 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6247 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6248 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6249 to support most MUA software.
6250
6251 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6252 .code
6253 #PLAIN:
6254 # driver = plaintext
6255 # server_set_id = $auth2
6256 # server_prompts = :
6257 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6258 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6259 .endd
6260 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6261 .code
6262 #LOGIN:
6263 # driver = plaintext
6264 # server_set_id = $auth1
6265 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6266 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6267 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6268 .endd
6269
6270 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6271 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6272 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6273 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6274 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6275 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6276 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6277 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6278
6279 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6280 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6281 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6282 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6283
6284 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6285 usercode and password are in different positions.
6286 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6287
6288 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6289
6290
6291
6292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6294
6295 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6296
6297 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6298 .cindex "PCRE"
6299 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6300 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6301 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6302 regular expressions is discussed in
6303 online Perl manpages, in
6304 many Perl reference books, and also in
6305 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6306 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6307
6308 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6309 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6310 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6311 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6312 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6313 case-insensitive.
6314
6315 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6316 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6317 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6318 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6319 .code
6320 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6321 .endd
6322 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6323 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6324 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6325 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6326 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6327 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6328 matched.
6329
6330 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6331 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6332 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6333 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6334 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6335 match anywhere in the subject string.
6336
6337 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6338 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6339 .code
6340 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6341 .endd
6342 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6343 You need to use:
6344 .code
6345 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6346 .endd
6347 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6348 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6349
6350
6351
6352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6354
6355 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6356 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6357 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6358 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6359 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6360 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6361
6362 .olist
6363 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6364 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6365 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6366 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6367 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6368 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6369 .next
6370 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6371 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6372 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6373 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6374 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6375 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6376 .endlist
6377
6378 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6379 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6380 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6381 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6382 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6383 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6384
6385 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6386 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6387 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6388 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6389 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6390 .code
6391 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6392 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6393 .endd
6394 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6395 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6396 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6397 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6398 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6399 .code
6400 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6401 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6402 .endd
6403 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6404 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6405
6406 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6407 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6408 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6409 .code
6410 domain1:
6411 domain2:
6412 .endd
6413 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6414 matches the list item.
6415
6416 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6417 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6418 .code
6419 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6420 .endd
6421 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6422 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6423 causes a second lookup to occur.
6424
6425 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6426 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6427 lookup is permitted.
6428
6429
6430 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6431 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6432 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6433 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6434
6435 .ilist
6436 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6437 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6438 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6439 .next
6440 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6441 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6442 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6443 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6444 .endlist
6445
6446 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6447 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6448 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6449 .code
6450 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6451 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6452 .endd
6453 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6454 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6455 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6456
6457
6458
6459
6460 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6461 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6462 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6463 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6464
6465 .ilist
6466 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6467 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6468 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6469 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6470 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6471 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6472 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6473 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6474 be found in several places:
6475 .display
6476 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6477 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6478 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6479 .endd
6480 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6481 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6482 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6483 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6484 .next
6485 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6486 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6487 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6488 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6489 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6490 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6491 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6492
6493 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6494 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6495 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6496 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6497 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6498 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6499 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6500 .next
6501 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6502 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6503 .cindex "sasldb2"
6504 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6505 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6506 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6507 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6508 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6509 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6510 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6511 .next
6512 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6513 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6514 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6515 .cindex "Courier"
6516 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6517 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6518 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6519 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6520 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6521 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6522 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6523 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6524 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6525 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6526 .next
6527 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6528 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6529 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6530 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6531 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6532 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6533 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6534 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6535 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6536 .next
6537 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6538 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6539 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6540 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6541 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6542 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6543 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6544 .code
6545 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6546 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6547 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6548 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6549 .endd
6550 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6551 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6552 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6553 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6554 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6555
6556 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6557 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6558 lookup types support only literal keys.
6559
6560 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6561 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6562 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6563 .next
6564 .cindex "linear search"
6565 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6566 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6567 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6568 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6569 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6570 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6571 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6572 in the file is used.
6573
6574 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6575 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6576 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6577 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6578 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6579 colon, for example:
6580 .code
6581 baduser: :fail:
6582 .endd
6583 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6584 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6585 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6586 wildcarding of any kind.
6587
6588 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6589 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6590 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6591 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6592 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6593 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6594 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6595 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6596 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6597
6598 .next
6599 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6600 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6601 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6602 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6603 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6604 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6605 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6606 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6607
6608 .next
6609 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6610 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6611 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6613 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6614 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6615 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6616 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6617 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6618
6619 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6620 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6621 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6622 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6623
6624 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6625 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6626
6627 .olist
6628 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6629 .code
6630 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6631 *fish data for anythingfish
6632 .endd
6633 .next
6634 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6635 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6636 .code
6637 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6638 .endd
6639 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6640 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6641 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6642 .code
6643 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6644 .endd
6645 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6646 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6647 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6648 .code
6649 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6650 .endd
6651
6652 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6653 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6654 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6655 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6656 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6657
6658 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6659 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6660 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6661 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6662 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6663
6664 .next
6665 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6666 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6667 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6668 example:
6669 .code
6670 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6671 .endd
6672 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6673 .endlist olist
6674
6675 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6676 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6677 be followed by optional colons.
6678
6679 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6680 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6681 lookup types support only literal keys.
6682 .endlist ilist
6683
6684
6685 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6686 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6687 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6688 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6689 many of them are given in later sections.
6690
6691 .ilist
6692 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6693 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6694 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6695 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6696 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6697 .next
6698 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6699 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6700 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6701 .next
6702 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6703 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6704 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6705 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6706 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6707 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6708 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6709 .next
6710 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6712 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6713 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6714 .next
6715 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6716 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6717 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6718 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6719 .next
6720 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6721 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6722 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6723 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6724 .next
6725 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6726 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6727 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6728 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6729 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6730 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6731 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6732 password value. For example:
6733 .code
6734 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6735 .endd
6736 .next
6737 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6738 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6739 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6740 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6741
6742 .next
6743 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6744 .cindex lookup Redis
6745 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6746 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6747
6748 .next
6749 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6750 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6751 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6752 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6753
6754 .next
6755 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6756 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6757 .next
6758 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6759 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6760 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6761 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6762 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6763 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6764 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6765 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6766 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6767 .code
6768 require condition = \
6769 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6770 .endd
6771 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6772 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6773 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6774 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6775 .endlist
6776
6777
6778
6779 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6780 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6781 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6782 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6783 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6784 options such as a list of local domains.
6785
6786 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6787 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6788 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6789 or may give up altogether.
6790
6791
6792
6793 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6794 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6795 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6796 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6797 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6798 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6799 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6800 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6801
6802 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6803 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6804 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6805
6806 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6807 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6808 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6809
6810 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6811 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6812 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6813 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6814 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6815 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6816 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6817 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6818 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6819 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6820 .code
6821 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6822 .endd
6823 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6824 looks up these keys, in this order:
6825 .code
6826 jane@eyre.example
6827 *@eyre.example
6828 *
6829 .endd
6830 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6831 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6832 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6833 Exim move on to try the next key.
6834
6835
6836
6837 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6838 .cindex "partial matching"
6839 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6840 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6842 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6843 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6844 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6845 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6846 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6847 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6848 a key in a DBM file is
6849 .code
6850 *.dates.fict.example
6851 .endd
6852 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6853 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6854 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6855 file.
6856
6857 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6858 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6859 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6860
6861 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6862 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6863 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6864 partial matching keys
6865 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6866 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6867 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6868
6869 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6870 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6871 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6872 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6873 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6874 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6875 remains.
6876
6877 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6878 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6879 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6880 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6881 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6882 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6883 .code
6884 2250.dates.fict.example
6885 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6886 *.dates.fict.example
6887 *.fict.example
6888 .endd
6889 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6890 finishes.
6891
6892 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6893 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6894 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6895 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6896 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6897 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6898 .code
6899 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6900 .endd
6901 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6902 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6903 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6904 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6905 .code
6906 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6907 .endd
6908 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6909 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6910
6911 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6912 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6913 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6914
6915 .ilist
6916 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6917 .next
6918 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6919 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6920 .next
6921 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6922 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6923 for &"*"& on its own.
6924 .next
6925 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6926 .endlist
6927
6928
6929 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6930 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6931 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6932 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6933 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6934 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6935 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6936
6937 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6938 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6939 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6940 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6941 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6942
6943
6944
6945
6946 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6947 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6948 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6949 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6950 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6951 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6952 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6953
6954 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6955 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6956 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6957 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6958 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6959 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6960
6961 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6962 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6963 complete.
6964
6965
6966
6967
6968 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6969 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6970 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6971 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6972 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6973 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6974 .code
6975 [name=$local_part]
6976 .endd
6977 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6978 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6979 .code
6980 [name="$local_part"]
6981 .endd
6982 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6983 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6984 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6985 of the following form is provided:
6986 .code
6987 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6988 .endd
6989 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6990 .code
6991 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6992 .endd
6993 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6994 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6995 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6996
6997
6998
6999
7000 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7001 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7002 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7003 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7004 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7005 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7006 an expansion string could contain:
7007 .code
7008 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7009 .endd
7010 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7011 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7012 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7013 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7014
7015 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7016 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7017 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7018
7019 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7020 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7021 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7022 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7023 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7024 .code
7025 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7026 .endd
7027 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7028 white space is ignored.
7029 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7030 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7031 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7032
7033 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7034 When the type is PTR,
7035 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7036 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7037 .code
7038 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7039 .endd
7040 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7041 altered and nothing is added.
7042
7043 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7044 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7045 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7046 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7047 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7048 The field separator can be modified as above.
7049
7050 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7051 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7052 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7053 unless a field separator is specified.
7054 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7055 For SPF records the
7056 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7057 .code
7058 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7059 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7060 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7061 .endd
7062 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7063 white space is ignored.
7064
7065 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7066 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7067 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7068 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7069 specified.
7070 .code
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7072 .endd
7073
7074 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7075 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7076 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7077 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7078 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7079 each followed by a comma,
7080 that may appear before the record type.
7081
7082 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7083 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7084 a defer-option modifier.
7085 The possible keywords are
7086 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7087 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7088 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7089 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7090 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7091 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7092 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7093 .code
7094 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7095 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7096 .endd
7097 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7098 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7099
7100 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7101 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7102 The possible keywords are
7103 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7104 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7105 with the lookup.
7106 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7107 is not labelled as authenticated data
7108 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7109 The default is &"never"&.
7110
7111 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7112
7113 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7114 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7115 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7116 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7117 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7118 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7119
7120 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7121 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7122 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7123
7124 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7125 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7126 .cindex DNS TTL
7127 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7128 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7129 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7130
7131
7132 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7133 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7134 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7135 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7136 the pseudo-type MXH:
7137 .code
7138 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7139 .endd
7140 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7141 returned.
7142
7143 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7144 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7145 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7146 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7147 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7148 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7149 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7150 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7151 .code
7152 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7153 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7154 .endd
7155 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7156 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7157 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7158
7159 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7160 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7161 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7162 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7163 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7164 such a list.
7165
7166 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7167 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7168 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7169 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7170 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7171 result of a successful lookup such as:
7172 .code
7173 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7174 .endd
7175 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7176 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7177 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7178
7179 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7180 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7181 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7182 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7183 .code
7184 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7185 .endd
7186
7187
7188 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7189 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7190 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7191 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7192 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7193 .code
7194 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7195 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7196 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7197 .endd
7198 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7199 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7200 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7201 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7202
7203 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7204 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7205 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7206
7207
7208
7209
7210 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7211 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7212 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7213 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7214 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7215 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7216 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7217 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7218 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7219 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7220 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7221 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7222 .code
7223 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7224 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7225 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7226 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7227 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7228 .endd
7229 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7230 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7231
7232 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7233 the way they handle the results of a query:
7234
7235 .ilist
7236 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7237 gives an error.
7238 .next
7239 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7240 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7241 .next
7242 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7243 from all of them are returned.
7244 .endlist
7245
7246
7247 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7248 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7249 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7250 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7251
7252
7253 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7254 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7255 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7256 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7257 .code
7258 data = ${lookup ldap \
7259 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7260 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7261 .endd
7262 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7263 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7264 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7265 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7266
7267 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7268 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7269 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7270
7271 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7272 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7273 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7274 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7275 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7276 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7277 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7278 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7279 &_exim.conf_&.
7280
7281
7282 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7283 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7284 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7285 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7286 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7287 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7288
7289 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7290 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7291 the string:
7292 .code
7293 * => \2A
7294 ( => \28
7295 ) => \29
7296 \ => \5C
7297 .endd
7298 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7299 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7300 .code
7301 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7302 .endd
7303 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7304 .code
7305 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7306 .endd
7307 yields
7308 .code
7309 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7310 .endd
7311 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7312 .code
7313 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7314 .endd
7315 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7316 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7317 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7318 .code
7319 , + " \ < > ;
7320 .endd
7321 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7322 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7323 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7324 .code
7325 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7326 .endd
7327 yields
7328 .code
7329 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7330 .endd
7331 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7332 .code
7333 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7334 .endd
7335 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7336 authentication below.
7337
7338
7339 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7340 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7341 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7342 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7343 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7344 by starting it with
7345 .code
7346 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7347 .endd
7348 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7349 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7350 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7351 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7352 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7353 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7354 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7355 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7356 failures, and timeouts.
7357
7358 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7359 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7360 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7361 doubled. For example
7362 .code
7363 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7364 .endd
7365 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7366 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7367 the local host) is used.
7368
7369 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7370 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7371 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7372 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7373 not available.
7374
7375 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7376 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7377 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7378 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7379 .code
7380 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7381 .endd
7382 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7383 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7384 .code
7385 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7386 .endd
7387 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7388 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7389 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7390 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7391 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7392 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7393 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7394 backup host.
7395
7396 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7397 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7398 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7399
7400 .ilist
7401 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7402 interface.
7403 .next
7404 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7405 .endlist
7406
7407
7408 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7409 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7410
7411
7412
7413 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7414 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7415 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7416 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7417 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7418 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7419 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7420 them. The following names are recognized:
7421 .display
7422 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7423 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7424 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7425 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7426 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7427 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7428 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7429 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7430 .endd
7431 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7432 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7433 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7434 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7435
7436 .cindex LDAP timeout
7437 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7438 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7439 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7440 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7441 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7442 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7443 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7444 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7445 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7446 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7447
7448 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7449 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7450
7451 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7452 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7453 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7454 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7455 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7456 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7457 alternate list (colon-separated).
7458
7459 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7460 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7461 .code
7462 ${lookup ldap
7463 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7464 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7465 {$value}fail}
7466 .endd
7467 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7468 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7469 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7470 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7471
7472 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7473 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7474 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7475
7476 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7477 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7478 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7479 quoting has two advantages:
7480
7481 .ilist
7482 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7483 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7484 .next
7485 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7486 .endlist
7487
7488 For example, a setting such as
7489 .code
7490 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7491 .endd
7492 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7493
7494 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7495 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7496 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7497 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7498 .code
7499 PASS=${quote:$3}
7500 .endd
7501 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7502 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7503 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7504
7505
7506
7507 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7508 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7509 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7510 as a sequence of values, for example
7511 .code
7512 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7513 .endd
7514 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7515 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7516 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7517 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7518 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7519 directory.
7520
7521 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7522 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7523 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7524 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7525
7526 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7527 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7528 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7529 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7530 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7531 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7532 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7533 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7534 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7535
7536 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7537 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7538 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7539 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7540 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7541
7542 .code
7543 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7544 value1.1,value1,,2
7545
7546 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7547 value two
7548
7549 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7550 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7551
7552 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7553 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7554
7555 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7556 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7557 .endd
7558 You can
7559 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7560 results of LDAP lookups.
7561 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7562 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7563 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7564 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7565 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7566 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7567
7568
7569
7570
7571 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7572 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7573 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7574 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7575 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7576 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7577 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7578 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7579 .code
7580 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7581 .endd
7582 might return the string
7583 .code
7584 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7585 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7586 .endd
7587 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7588 .code
7589 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7590 .endd
7591 would just return
7592 .code
7593 Martin Guerre
7594 .endd
7595 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7596 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7597 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7598
7599
7600
7601 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7602 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7603 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7604 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7605 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7606 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7607 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7608 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7609 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7610 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7611 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7612 .cindex lookup Redis
7613 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7614 and SQLite
7615 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7616 might be
7617 .code
7618 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7619 {$value}fail}
7620 .endd
7621 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7622 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7623 .code
7624 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7625 {$value}}
7626 .endd
7627 might be
7628 .code
7629 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7630 .endd
7631 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7632 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7633 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7634 .code
7635 Mister X
7636 .endd
7637 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7638 with a newline between the data for each row.
7639
7640
7641 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7642 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7643 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7644 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7645 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7646 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7647 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7648 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7649 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7650 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7651 .cindex lookup Redis
7652 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7653 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7654 or &%redis_servers%&
7655 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7656 information.
7657 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7658 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7659 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7660 For all but Redis
7661 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7662 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7663 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7664 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7665 .code
7666 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7667 .endd
7668 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7669 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7670 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7671 .code
7672 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7673 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7674 .endd
7675 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7676 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7677 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7678 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7679 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7680 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7681
7682 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7683 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7684 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7685 information.
7686 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7687 host, database number, and password.
7688 .olist
7689 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7690 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7691 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7692 .next
7693 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7694 .next
7695 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7696 .endlist
7697
7698 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7699 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7700 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7701 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7702
7703 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7704 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7705
7706 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7707 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7708 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7709 done by starting the query with
7710 .display
7711 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7712 .endd
7713 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7714 .olist
7715 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7716 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7717 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7718 taken from there.
7719 .next
7720 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7721 .endlist
7722 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7723 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7724 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7725
7726 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7727 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7728 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7729 like this:
7730 .code
7731 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7732 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7733 master/db/name/pw
7734 .endd
7735 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7736 .code
7737 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7738 .endd
7739 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7740 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7741 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7742 .code
7743 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7744 .endd
7745
7746
7747 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7748 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7749 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7750 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7751 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7752 the default value is &"exim"&.
7753 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7754 .display
7755 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7756 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7757 .endd
7758 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7759 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7760
7761 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7762 the queries.
7763
7764 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7765 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7766
7767 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7768 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7769 is zero because no rows are affected.
7770
7771
7772 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7773 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7774 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7775 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7776 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7777 looks like this:
7778 .code
7779 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7780 .endd
7781 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7782 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7783 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7784
7785 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7786 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7787 affected.
7788
7789 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7790 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7791 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7792 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7793 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7794 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7795 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7796 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7797 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7798 .code
7799 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7800 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7801 .endd
7802 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7803 .code
7804 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7805 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7806 .endd
7807 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7808 quote, which it doubles.
7809
7810 .cindex timeout SQLite
7811 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7812 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7813 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7814 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7815 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7816 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7817 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7818 option.
7819
7820 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7821 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7822 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7823 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7824 Examples:
7825 .code
7826 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7827 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7828 .endd
7829
7830 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7831 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7832
7833
7834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7836
7837 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7838 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7839 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7840 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7841 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7842 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7843 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7844 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7845 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7846
7847 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7848 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7849 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7850 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7851
7852 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7853 support all the complexity available in
7854 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7855
7856
7857
7858 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7859 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7860 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7861
7862 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7863 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7864
7865 The result of
7866 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7867 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7868 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7869 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7870 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7871
7872
7873 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7874 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7875 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7876
7877 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7878 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7879 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7880 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7881 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7882 .code
7883 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7884 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7885 .endd
7886 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7887 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7888 senders based on the receiving domain.
7889
7890
7891
7892
7893 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7894 .cindex "list" "negation"
7895 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7896 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7897 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7898 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7899 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7900 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7901
7902 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7903 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7904 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7905 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7906 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7907 .code
7908 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7909 .endd
7910 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7911 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7912 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7913 .code
7914 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7915 .endd
7916 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7917 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7918 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7919
7920 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7921 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7922 item.
7923
7924
7925
7926 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7927 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7928 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7929 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7930 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7931 file names are not allowed,
7932 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7933 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7934 lines:
7935
7936 .ilist
7937 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7938 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7939 .next
7940 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7941 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7942 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7943 .code
7944 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7945 .endd
7946 .endlist
7947
7948 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7949 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7950 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7951 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7952
7953 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7954 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7955 .code
7956 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7957 .endd
7958 and the file contains the lines
7959 .code
7960 !a.b.c
7961 *.b.c
7962 .endd
7963 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7964 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7965
7966
7967
7968 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7969 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7970 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7971 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7972 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7973 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7974 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7975 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7976
7977 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7978 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7979 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7980 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7981
7982
7983
7984
7985 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7986 .cindex "named lists"
7987 .cindex "list" "named"
7988 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7989 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7990 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7991 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7992 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7993 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7994 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7995 .code
7996 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7997 .endd
7998 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7999 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8000 configured with the line
8001 .code
8002 domains = +local_domains
8003 .endd
8004 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8005 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8006 .code
8007 dnslookup:
8008 driver = dnslookup
8009 domains = ! +local_domains
8010 transport = remote_smtp
8011 no_more
8012 .endd
8013 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8014 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8015 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8016 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8017 .code
8018 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8019 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8020 .endd
8021 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8022 .code
8023 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8024 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8025 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8026 .endd
8027 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8028 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8029 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8030 .code
8031 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8032 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8033 .endd
8034 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8035 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8036 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8037 .code
8038 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8039 .endd
8040 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8041 referenced lists if you can.
8042
8043 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8044 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8045 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8046 .code
8047 domains = +local_domains
8048 .endd
8049 on several of your routers
8050 or in several ACL statements,
8051 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8052 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8053 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8054 the same each time they are referenced.
8055
8056 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8057 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8058 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8059 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8060
8061
8062
8063 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8064 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8065 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8066 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8067 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8068 write
8069 .code
8070 ALIST = host1 : host2
8071 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8072 .endd
8073 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8074 .code
8075 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8076 .endd
8077 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8078 list, and write
8079 .code
8080 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8081 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8082 .endd
8083 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8084 .code
8085 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8086 .endd
8087
8088
8089 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8090 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8091 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8092 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8093 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8094 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8095 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8096 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8097 message. For example:
8098 .code
8099 domainlist special_domains = \
8100 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8101 .endd
8102 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8103 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8104 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8105 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8106 same list each time.
8107
8108 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8109 cache the result anyway. For example:
8110 .code
8111 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8112 .endd
8113 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8114 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8115
8116
8117
8118 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8119 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8120 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8121 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8122 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8123
8124 .ilist
8125 .cindex "primary host name"
8126 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8127 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8128 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8129 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8130 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8131 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8132 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8133 differ only in their names.
8134 .next
8135 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8136 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8137 .cindex "domain literal"
8138 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8139 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8140 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8141 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8142 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8143 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8144 .next
8145 .cindex "@mx_any"
8146 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8147 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8148 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8149 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8150 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8151 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8152 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8153 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8154 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8155 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8156 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8157
8158 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8159 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8160 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8161 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8162 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8163
8164 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8165 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8166 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8167 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8168 on a router). For example:
8169 .code
8170 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8171 .endd
8172 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8173 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8174
8175 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8176 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8177 contain negative items.
8178
8179 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8180 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8181 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8182 .code
8183 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8184 an.other.domain : ...
8185 .endd
8186 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8187 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8188 .code
8189 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8190 an.other.domain ? ...
8191 .endd
8192 .next
8193 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8194 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8195 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8196 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8197 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8198 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8199 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8200 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8201 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8202 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8203
8204 .next
8205 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8206 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8207 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8208 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8209 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8210 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8211 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8212 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8213 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8214
8215 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8216 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8217 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8218 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8219 expression by expansion, of course).
8220 .next
8221 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8222 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8223 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8224 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8225 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8226 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8227 .code
8228 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8229 .endd
8230 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8231 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8232 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8233 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8234 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8235 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8236 other statements in the same ACL.
8237
8238 .next
8239 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8240 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8241 .code
8242 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8243 .endd
8244 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8245 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8246
8247 .next
8248 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8249 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8250 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8251 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8252 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8253 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8254 expansion variable.
8255 .next
8256 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8257 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8258 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8259 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8260 .code
8261 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8262 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8263 .endd
8264 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8265 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8266 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8267 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8268 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8269 .next
8270 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8271 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8272 between the pattern and the domain.
8273 .endlist
8274
8275 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8276 .code
8277 domainlist funny_domains = \
8278 @ : \
8279 lib.unseen.edu : \
8280 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8281 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8282 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8283 nis;domains.byname : \
8284 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8285 .endd
8286 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8287 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8288 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8289 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8290 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8291 patterns earlier.
8292
8293
8294
8295 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8296 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8297 .cindex "list" "host list"
8298 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8299 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8300 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8301 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8302 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8303 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8304 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8305
8306
8307 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8308 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8309 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8310 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8311 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8312 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8313 not used.
8314
8315 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8316 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8317 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8318
8319
8320
8321 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8322 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8323 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8324 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8325 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8326 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8327 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8328 concerns.)
8329
8330 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8331 inspecting its IP address:
8332
8333 .ilist
8334 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8335 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8336 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8337 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8338 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8339 with the IP address of the subject host.
8340
8341 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8342 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8343 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8344 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8345 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8346
8347 .next
8348 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8349 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8350 domain name, as just described.
8351
8352 .next
8353 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8354 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8355 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8356 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8357 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8358 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8359 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8360 that can never match a client host.
8361
8362 .next
8363 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8364 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8365 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8366 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8367 .code
8368 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8369 accept hosts = @[]
8370 .endd
8371 .next
8372 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8373 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8374 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8375 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8376 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8377 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8378 significant end of the address.
8379
8380 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8381 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8382 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8383 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8384 .code
8385 192.168.23.236/31
8386 .endd
8387 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8388 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8389 matches.
8390
8391 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8392 .code
8393 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8394 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8395 .endd
8396 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8397 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8398 For example:
8399 .code
8400 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8401 .endd
8402 could make use of a file containing
8403 .code
8404 172.16.0.0/12
8405 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8406 .endd
8407 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8408 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8409 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8410 .code
8411 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8412 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8413 .endd
8414 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8415 list.
8416 .endlist
8417
8418
8419
8420 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8421 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8422 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8423 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8424 address, the pattern takes this form:
8425 .display
8426 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8427 .endd
8428 For example:
8429 .code
8430 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8431 .endd
8432 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8433 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8434 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8435 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8436 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8437 returned by the lookup is not used.
8438
8439 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8440 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8441 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8442 patterns of this form:
8443 .display
8444 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8445 .endd
8446 For example:
8447 .code
8448 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8449 .endd
8450 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8451 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8452 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8453 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8454 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8455
8456 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8457 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8458 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8459 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8460 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8461 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8462 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8463 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8464 addresses are always used.
8465
8466 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8467 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8468 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8469 configurations.
8470
8471 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8472 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8473 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8474 case the IP address is used on its own.
8475
8476
8477
8478 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8479 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8480 .cindex "unknown host name"
8481 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8482 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8483 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8484 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8485 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8486 above.)
8487
8488 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8489 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8490 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8491 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8492 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8493 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8494 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8495
8496 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8497 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8498
8499 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8500 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8501 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8502 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8503 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8504 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8505 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8506 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8507 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8508
8509 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8510 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8511
8512 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8513 .cindex "alias for host"
8514 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8515 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8516
8517 .ilist
8518 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8519 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8520 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8521 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8522 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8523 expression.
8524 .next
8525 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8526 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8527 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8528 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8529 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8530 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8531 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8532 example,
8533 .code
8534 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8535 .endd
8536 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8537 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8538 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8539 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8540 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8541 .code
8542 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8543 .endd
8544 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8545 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8546 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8547 required.
8548 .endlist
8549
8550
8551
8552
8553 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8554 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8555 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8556 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8557 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8558 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8559
8560 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8561 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8562
8563 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8564 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8565 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8566 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8567 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8568 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8569 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8570 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8571 not recognized in an indirected file).
8572
8573 .ilist
8574 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8575 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8576 .code
8577 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8578 .endd
8579 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8580 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8581
8582 .next
8583 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8584 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8585 example:
8586 .code
8587 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8588 192.168.4.5
8589 .endd
8590 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8591 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8592 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8593 .endlist
8594
8595 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8596 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8597 list.
8598
8599 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8600 "SECTmixwilhos"
8601 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8602
8603 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8604 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8605 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8606
8607 .ilist
8608 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8609 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8610 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8611 .code
8612 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8613 .endd
8614 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8615 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8616 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8617 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8618 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8619 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8620 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8621
8622 .next
8623 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8624 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8625 .code
8626 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8627 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8628 .endd
8629 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8630 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8631 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8632 this section.
8633 .endlist
8634
8635
8636 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8637 "SECTtemdnserr"
8638 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8639 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8640 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8641 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8642 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8643 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8644 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8645 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8646 host lists such as whitelists.
8647
8648
8649
8650 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8651 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8652 .cindex "unknown host name"
8653 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8654 If a pattern is of the form
8655 .display
8656 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8657 .endd
8658 for example
8659 .code
8660 dbm;/host/accept/list
8661 .endd
8662 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8663 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8664 is not used.
8665
8666 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8667 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8668 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8669 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8670 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8671 lookup, both using the same file.
8672
8673
8674
8675 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8676 If a pattern is of the form
8677 .display
8678 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8679 .endd
8680 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8681 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8682 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8683 .code
8684 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8685 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8686 .endd
8687 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8688 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8689 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8690 operator.
8691
8692 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8693 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8694 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8695
8696 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8697 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8698 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8699 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8700 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8701 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8702
8703
8704
8705
8706
8707 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8708 .cindex "list" "address list"
8709 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8710 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8711 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8712 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8713 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8714 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8715 using this option setting:
8716 .code
8717 senders = :
8718 .endd
8719 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8720 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8721 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8722 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8723
8724 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8725 example:
8726 .code
8727 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8728 .endd
8729 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8730 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8731 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8732 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8733 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8734 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8735 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8736 .code
8737 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8738 *@+hostile_domains:\
8739 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8740 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8741 .endd
8742 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8743 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8744 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8745 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8746 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8747
8748 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8749 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8750 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8751 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8752 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8753 .code
8754 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8755 .endd
8756
8757 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8758 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8759 senders:
8760
8761 .ilist
8762 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8763 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8764 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8765 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8766 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8767 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8768 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8769 .code
8770 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8771 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8772 .endd
8773 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8774 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8775
8776 .next
8777 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8778 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8779 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8780 example:
8781 .code
8782 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8783 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8784 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8785 .endd
8786 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8787 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8788 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8789 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8790
8791 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8792 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8793 panic log.
8794 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8795 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8796 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8797 default. For example, with this lookup:
8798 .code
8799 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8800 .endd
8801 the file could contains lines like this:
8802 .code
8803 user1@domain1.example
8804 *@domain2.example
8805 .endd
8806 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8807 that are tried is:
8808 .code
8809 nimrod@jaeger.example
8810 *@jaeger.example
8811 *
8812 .endd
8813 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8814 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8815
8816 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8817 .code
8818 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8819 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8820 .endd
8821 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8822 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8823 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8824 .endlist
8825
8826
8827 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8828 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8829 always fails.
8830
8831
8832 .ilist
8833 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8834 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8835 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8836 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8837 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8838 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8839 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8840 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8841 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8842
8843 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8844 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8845 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8846 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8847 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8848 with
8849 .code
8850 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8851 .endd
8852 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8853 .code
8854 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8855 .endd
8856 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8857
8858 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8859 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8860 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8861 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8862 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8863 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8864 .code
8865 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8866 spammer3 : spammer4
8867 .endd
8868 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8869 doubling.
8870
8871 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8872 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8873 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8874 might have entries like
8875 .code
8876 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8877 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8878 *: ^\d{8}$
8879 .endd
8880 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8881 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8882 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8883 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8884
8885 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8886 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8887 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8888
8889 .next
8890 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8891 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8892 can only return a single list of local parts.
8893 .endlist
8894
8895 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8896 in these two examples:
8897 .code
8898 senders = +my_list
8899 senders = *@+my_list
8900 .endd
8901 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8902 example it is a named domain list.
8903
8904
8905
8906
8907 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8908 .cindex "case of local parts"
8909 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8910 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8911 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8912 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8913 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8914 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8915 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8916 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8917 default.
8918
8919 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8920 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8921 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8922 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8923 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8924 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8925 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8926 case-independent.
8927
8928 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8929 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8930 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8931 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8932 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8933 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8934 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8935 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8936
8937
8938
8939 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8940 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8941 .cindex "local part" "list"
8942 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8943 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8944 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8945 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8946 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8947 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8948 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8949 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8950
8951 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8952 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8953 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8954 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8955 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8956 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8957 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8958 types.
8959 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8960
8961
8962
8963
8964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8966
8967 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8968 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8969 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8970 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8971
8972 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8973 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8974 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8975 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8976 escape character, as described in the following section.
8977
8978 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8979 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8980 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8981 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8982 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8983 reasons.
8984
8985
8986
8987 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8988 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8989 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8990 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8991 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8992 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8993 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8994 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8995
8996 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8997 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8998 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8999 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9000 .code
9001 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9002 .endd
9003 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9004 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9005 string.
9006
9007
9008
9009 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9010 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9011 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9012 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9013 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9014 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9015 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9016 encoding.
9017
9018 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9019 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9020 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9021
9022
9023 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9024 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9025 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9026 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9027 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9028 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9029 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9030 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9031 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9032 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9033 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9034 and &%nhash%&.
9035
9036 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9037 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9038 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9039
9040 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9041 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9042 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9043 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9044 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9045 .code
9046 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9047 .endd
9048 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9049 Exim message identifier. For example:
9050 .code
9051 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9052 .endd
9053 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9054 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9055
9056
9057 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9058 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9059 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9060 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9061 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9062 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9063 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9064 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9065 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9066 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9067 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9068 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9069 being expanded.
9070
9071
9072
9073
9074 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9075 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9076 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9077 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9078 white space is significant.
9079
9080 .vlist
9081 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9082 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9083 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9084 .code
9085 $local_part
9086 ${domain}
9087 .endd
9088 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9089 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9090 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9091 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9092 given, the expansion fails.
9093
9094 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9095 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9096 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9097 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9098 .code
9099 ${lc:$local_part}
9100 .endd
9101 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9102 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9103 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9104 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9105 string easier to understand.
9106
9107 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9108 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9109 expansion item below.
9110
9111
9112 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9113 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9114 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9115 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9116 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9117 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9118 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9119 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9120 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9121 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9122 the result of the expansion.
9123 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9124 the expansion result is an empty string.
9125 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9126
9127
9128 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9129 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9130 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9131 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9132 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9133 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9134 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9135 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9136 .display
9137 &`version `&
9138 &`serial_number `&
9139 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9140 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9141 &`notbefore `& time
9142 &`notafter `& time
9143 &`sig_algorithm `&
9144 &`signature `&
9145 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9146 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9147 &`crl_uri `& list
9148 .endd
9149 If the field is found,
9150 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9151 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9152 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9153 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9154
9155 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9156 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9157 extracted is used.
9158
9159 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9160
9161 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9162 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9163 not quite
9164 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9165 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9166 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9167 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9168 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9169 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9170 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9171 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9172
9173 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9174 take an optional modifier of "int"
9175 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9176 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9177 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9178
9179 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9180 newline-separated by default,
9181 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9182 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9183 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9184
9185 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9186 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9187 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9188 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9189 if so the element tags are omitted.
9190
9191 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9192
9193 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9194 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9195 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9196 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9197 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9198 .code
9199 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9200 .endd
9201 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9202 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9203 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9204
9205 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9206 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9207 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9208 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9209 must have the following type:
9210 .code
9211 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9212 .endd
9213 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9214 function should return one of the following values:
9215
9216 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9217 into the expanded string that is being built.
9218
9219 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9220 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9221
9222 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9223 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9224
9225 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9226
9227 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9228 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9229 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9230
9231
9232 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9233 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9234 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9235 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9236 removed.
9237 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9238 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9239 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9240
9241 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9242 appear, for example:
9243 .code
9244 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9245 .endd
9246 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9247 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9248
9249 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9250 search failure.
9251 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9252 search success.
9253
9254 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9255 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9256
9257
9258 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9259 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9260 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9261 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9262 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9263 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9264 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9265 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9266 .display
9267 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9268 .endd
9269 .vindex "&$value$&"
9270 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9271 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9272 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9273 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9274 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9275 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9276 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9277 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9278 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9279
9280 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9281 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9282 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9283 yield &"2001"&:
9284 .code
9285 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9286 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9287 .endd
9288 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9289 appear, for example:
9290 .code
9291 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9292 .endd
9293 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9294 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9295
9296
9297 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9298 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9299 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9300 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9301 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9302 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9303 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9304 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9305 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9306 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9307 <&'string3'&> as before.
9308
9309 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9310 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9311 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9312 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9313 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9314 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9315 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9316 provided. For example:
9317 .code
9318 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9319 .endd
9320 yields &"42"&, and
9321 .code
9322 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9323 .endd
9324 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9325 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9326
9327
9328 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9329 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9330 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9331 .vindex "&$item$&"
9332 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9333 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9334 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9335 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9336 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9337 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9338 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9339 .code
9340 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9341 .endd
9342 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9343 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9344
9345
9346 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9347 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9348 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9349 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9350 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9351 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9352
9353 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9354 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9355 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9356 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9357 .code
9358 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9359 .endd
9360 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9361 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9362 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9363 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9364 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9365 .code
9366 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9367 .endd
9368 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9369 letters appear. For example:
9370 .display
9371 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9372 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9373 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9374 .endd
9375
9376 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9377 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9378 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9379 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9380 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9381 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9382 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9383 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9384 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9385 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9386 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9387 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9388 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9389 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9390 .code
9391 $header_reply-to:
9392 .endd
9393 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9394 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9395 lines) may be present.
9396
9397 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9398 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9399
9400 .ilist
9401 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9402 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9403 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9404
9405 .next
9406 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9407 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9408 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9409 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9410 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9411 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9412 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9413 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9414
9415 .next
9416 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9417 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9418 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9419 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9420 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9421 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9422 .endlist ilist
9423
9424 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9425 command of the following form:
9426 .code
9427 headers charset "UTF-8"
9428 .endd
9429 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9430 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9431 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9432 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9433 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9434 ISO-8859-1.
9435
9436 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9437 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9438 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9439 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9440
9441 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9442 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9443 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9444 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9445 router or transport are not accessible.
9446
9447 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9448 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9449 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9450 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9451 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9452 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9453 point they are added.
9454 When any of the above ACLs ar
9455 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9456
9457 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9458 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9459 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9460 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9461 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9462 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9463 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9464 header.)
9465
9466 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9467 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9468 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9469 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9470 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9471 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9472 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9473 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9474
9475
9476 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9477 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9478 .cindex &%hmac%&
9479 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9480 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9481 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9482 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9483 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9484 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9485 present. For example:
9486 .code
9487 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9488 .endd
9489 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9490 produces:
9491 .code
9492 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9493 .endd
9494 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9495 an Exim configuration:
9496 .code
9497 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9498 .endd
9499 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9500 .code
9501 headers_add = \
9502 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9503 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9504 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9505 .endd
9506 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9507 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9508 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9509 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9510 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9511 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9512
9513
9514 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9515 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9516 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9517 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9518 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9519 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9520 .code
9521 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9522 .endd
9523 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9524 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9525 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9526 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9527 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9528
9529 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9530 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9531 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9532 .code
9533 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9534 .endd
9535 you can use
9536 .code
9537 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9538 .endd
9539
9540
9541
9542 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9543 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9544 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9545 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9546 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9547 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9548
9549
9550
9551 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9552 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9553 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9554 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9555 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9556 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9557 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9558 some of the braces:
9559 .code
9560 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9561 .endd
9562 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9563 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9564 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9565
9566
9567 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9568 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9569 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9570 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9571 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9572 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9573 apart from an optional leading minus,
9574 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9575
9576 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9577 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9578
9579 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9580 If the number is negative, the fields are
9581 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9582 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9583 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9584
9585 If the modulus of the
9586 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9587 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9588
9589 For example:
9590 .code
9591 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9592 .endd
9593 yields &"42"&, and
9594 .code
9595 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9596 .endd
9597 yields &"result: 42"&.
9598
9599 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9600 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9601 extracted is used.
9602 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9603
9604
9605 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9606 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9607 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9608 described in the next item.
9609
9610 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9611 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9612 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9613 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9614 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9615 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9616 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9617 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9618 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9619
9620 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9621 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9622 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9623 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9624 out by the system administrator.
9625
9626 .vindex "&$value$&"
9627 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9628 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9629 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9630 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9631 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9632 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9633 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9634 original lookup fails.
9635
9636 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9637 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9638 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9639 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9640 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9641 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9642 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9643 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9644
9645 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9646 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9647 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9648 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9649
9650 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9651 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9652 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9653 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9654
9655 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9656 .code
9657 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9658 .endd
9659 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9660 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9661 .code
9662 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9663 {$value}fail}
9664 .endd
9665
9666
9667 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9668 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9669 .vindex "&$item$&"
9670 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9671 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9672 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9673 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9674 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9675 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9676 .code
9677 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9678 .endd
9679 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9680 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9681 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9682
9683 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9684 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9685 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9686 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9687 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9688 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9689 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9690 .code
9691 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9692 .endd
9693 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9694 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9695 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9696 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9697 example,
9698 .code
9699 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9700 .endd
9701 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9702
9703
9704
9705 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9706 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9707 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9708 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9709 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9710 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9711 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9712 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9713
9714 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9715 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9716 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9717 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9718 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9719 not its contents.
9720
9721 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9722 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9723 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9724
9725 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9726 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9727
9728
9729 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9730 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9731 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9732 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9733 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9734 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9735 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9736 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9737
9738 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9739 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9740 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9741 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9742 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9743 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9744 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9745 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9746 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9747 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9748
9749 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9750 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9751 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9752 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9753
9754 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9755 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9756 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9757 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9758 is the expansion of the third argument.
9759
9760 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9761 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9762 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9763
9764 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9765 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9766 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9767 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9768 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9769 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9770 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9771 newlines are left in the string.
9772 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9773 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9774 the string expansion fails.
9775
9776 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9777 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9778
9779
9780
9781 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9782 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9783 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9784 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9785 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9786 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9787 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9788 examples:
9789 .code
9790 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9791 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9792 .endd
9793 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9794 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9795 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9796 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9797 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9798 example:
9799 .code
9800 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9801 .endd
9802 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9803 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9804 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9805 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9806 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9807 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9808 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9809 .code
9810 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9811 .endd
9812 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9813 and must be present if the argument is given.
9814 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9815 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9816 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9817 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9818 .code
9819 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9820 .endd
9821 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9822 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9823 turns them into spaces:
9824 .code
9825 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9826 .endd
9827 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9828 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9829 addition, the following errors can occur:
9830
9831 .ilist
9832 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9833 .next
9834 Failure to connect the socket;
9835 .next
9836 Failure to write the request string;
9837 .next
9838 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9839 .endlist
9840
9841 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9842 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9843 errors occurs. For example:
9844 .code
9845 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9846 {socket failure}}
9847 .endd
9848 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9849 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9850 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9851 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9852 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9853
9854 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9855 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9856
9857
9858 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9859 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9860 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9861 .vindex "&$value$&"
9862 .vindex "&$item$&"
9863 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9864 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9865 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9866 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9867 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9868 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9869 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9870 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9871 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9872 .code
9873 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9874 .endd
9875 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9876 can be found:
9877 .code
9878 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9879 .endd
9880 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9881 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9882 expansion items.
9883
9884 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9885 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9886 expansion item above.
9887
9888 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9889 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9890 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9891 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9892 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9893 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9894 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9895 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9896 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9897
9898 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9899 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9900 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9901 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9902 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9903 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9904 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9905 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9906 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9907 character.
9908
9909 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9910 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9911 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9912 .vindex "&$value$&"
9913 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9914 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9915 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9916 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9917 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9918 &$value$&.
9919
9920 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9921 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9922 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9923 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9924
9925 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9926 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9927 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9928 troubleshoot:
9929 .code
9930 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9931 log_message = Output of id: $value
9932 .endd
9933 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9934 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9935 .code
9936 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9937 .endd
9938
9939 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9940 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9941 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9942 .code
9943 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9944 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9945 ...
9946 endif
9947 .endd
9948 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9949 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9950 commands.
9951
9952 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9953 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9954 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9955 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9956
9957 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9958 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9959
9960
9961 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9962 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9963 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9964 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9965 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9966 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9967 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9968 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9969 .code
9970 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9971 .endd
9972 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9973 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9974 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9975 .code
9976 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9977 .endd
9978 yields &"defabc"&, and
9979 .code
9980 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9981 .endd
9982 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9983 the regular expression from string expansion.
9984
9985
9986
9987 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9988 .cindex sorting "a list"
9989 .cindex list sorting
9990 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9991 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9992 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9993 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9994 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9995 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9996 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9997 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9998 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9999 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10000 to give values for comparison.
10001
10002 The item result is a sorted list,
10003 with the original list separator,
10004 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10005
10006 Examples:
10007 .code
10008 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10009 .endd
10010 sorts a list of numbers, and
10011 .code
10012 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10013 .endd
10014 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10015
10016
10017 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10018 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10019 .cindex "substring extraction"
10020 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10021 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10022 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10023 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10024 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10025 .code
10026 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10027 .endd
10028 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10029 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10030 omitted.
10031
10032 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10033 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10034 length required. For example
10035 .code
10036 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10037 .endd
10038 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10039 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10040 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10041 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10042
10043 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10044 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10045 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10046 .code
10047 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10048 .endd
10049 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10050 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10051 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10052 .code
10053 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10054 .endd
10055 yields an empty string, but
10056 .code
10057 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10058 .endd
10059 yields &"1"&.
10060
10061 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10062 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10063 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10064 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10065 .code
10066 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10067 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10068 .endd
10069 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10070
10071
10072
10073 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10074 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10075 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10076 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10077 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10078 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10079 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10080 replacement list. For example
10081 .code
10082 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10083 .endd
10084 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10085 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10086 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10087 place.
10088 .endlist
10089
10090
10091
10092 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10093 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10094 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10095 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10096 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10097 following operations can be performed:
10098
10099 .vlist
10100 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10101 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10102 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10103 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10104 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10105 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10106
10107
10108 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10109 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10110 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10111 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10112 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10113 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10114 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10115 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10116 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10117
10118 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10119 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10120 character. For example:
10121 .code
10122 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10123 .endd
10124 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10125 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10126 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10127 separator explicitly:
10128 .code
10129 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10130 .endd
10131
10132 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10133 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10134 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10135 processing lists.
10136
10137 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10138 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10139 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10140 email address separator. For the example header line:
10141 .code
10142 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10143 .endd
10144 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10145 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10146 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10147 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10148 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10149 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10150 quoted.
10151 .code
10152 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10153 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10154 user@example.com
10155 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10156 Last:user@example.com
10157 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10158 user@example.com
10159 .endd
10160
10161 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10162 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10163 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10164 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10165 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10166 Only lowercase letters are used.
10167
10168 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10169 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10170 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10171 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10172 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10173
10174 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10175 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10176 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10177 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10178 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10179 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10180 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10181 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10182 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10183
10184 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10185 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10186 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10187 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10188 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10189 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10190 string.
10191
10192 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10193 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10194 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10195 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10196 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10197 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10198
10199 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10200 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10201
10202
10203 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10204 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10205 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10206 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10207 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10208
10209
10210 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10211 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10212 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10213 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10214 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10215
10216
10217 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10218 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10219 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10220 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10221 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10222 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10223 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10224
10225 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10226 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10227 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10228 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10229 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10230 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10231
10232
10233 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10234 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10235 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10236 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10237 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10238 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10239 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10240 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10241 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10242 C programming language):
10243 .table2 70pt 300pt
10244 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10245 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10246 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10247 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10248 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10249 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10250 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10251 .endtable
10252 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10253 space is permitted before or after operators.
10254
10255 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10256 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10257 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10258 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10259 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10260
10261 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10262 or 1024*1024*1024,
10263 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10264 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10265
10266 .display
10267 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10268 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10269 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10270 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10271 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10272 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10273 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10274 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10275 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10276 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10277 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10278 .endd
10279
10280 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10281 .code
10282 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10283 condition = \
10284 ${if and { \
10285 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10286 { \
10287 < \
10288 {$recipients_count} \
10289 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10290 } \
10291 }{yes}{no}}
10292 .endd
10293 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10294 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10295
10296
10297 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10298 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10299 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10300 example,
10301 .code
10302 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10303 .endd
10304 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10305 and then re-expands what it has found.
10306
10307
10308 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10309 .cindex "Unicode"
10310 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10311 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10312 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10313 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10314 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10315 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10316 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10317 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10318 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10319
10320 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10321 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10322 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10323 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10324 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10325 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10326 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10327
10328
10329 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10330 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10331 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10332 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10333 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10334 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10335 .code
10336 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10337 .endd
10338 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10339 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10340
10341
10342
10343 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10344 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10345 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10346 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10347 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10348 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10349
10350
10351
10352 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10353 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10354 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10355 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10356 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10357 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10358 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10359
10360
10361 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10362 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10363 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10364 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10365 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10366 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10367 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10368
10369 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10370 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10371 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10372 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10373 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10374 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10375 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10376 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10377 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10378
10379
10380 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10381 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10382 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10383 .cindex "lower casing"
10384 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10385 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10386 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10387 .code
10388 ${lc:$local_part}
10389 .endd
10390
10391 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10393 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10394 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10395 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10396 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10397 .code
10398 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10399 .endd
10400 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10401 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10402 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10403
10404
10405 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10406 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10407 .cindex "list" "item count"
10408 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10409 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10410 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10411
10412
10413 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10414 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10415 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10416 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10417 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10418 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10419 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10420 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10421 matching list is returned.
10422
10423
10424 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10425 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10426 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10427 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10428 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10429 empty.
10430
10431
10432 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "masked IP address"
10434 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10435 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10436 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10437 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10438 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10439 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10440 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10441 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10442 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10443 .code
10444 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10445 .endd
10446 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10447 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10448 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10449 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10450 .code
10451 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10452 .endd
10453 returns the string
10454 .code
10455 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10456 .endd
10457 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10458
10459
10460 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10461 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10462 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10463 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10464 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10465 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10466 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10467
10468 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10469 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10470
10471
10472 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10473 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10474 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10475 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10476 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10477 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10478 .code
10479 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10480 .endd
10481 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10482
10483
10484 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10485 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10486 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10487 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10488 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10489 is an empty string or
10490 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10491 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10492 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10493 respectively For example,
10494 .code
10495 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10496 .endd
10497 becomes
10498 .code
10499 "ab\"*\"cd"
10500 .endd
10501 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10502 variable or a message header.
10503
10504 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10505 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10506 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10507 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10508 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10509 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10510 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10511
10512
10513 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10514 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10515 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10516 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10517 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10518 .code
10519 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10520 .endd
10521 returns
10522 .code
10523 two%20%5C2A%20two
10524 .endd
10525 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10526 yields an unchanged string.
10527
10528
10529 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10530 .cindex "random number"
10531 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10532 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10533 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10534 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10535 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10536 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10537 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10538 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10539 random().
10540
10541
10542 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10543 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10544 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10545 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10546 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10547 for DNS. For example,
10548 .code
10549 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10550 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10551 .endd
10552 returns
10553 .code
10554 4.2.0.192
10555 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10556 .endd
10557
10558
10559 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10560 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10561 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10562 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10563 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10564 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10565 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10566 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10567 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10568 characters
10569 .code
10570 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10571 .endd
10572 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10573 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10574 characters.
10575
10576
10577 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10578 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10579 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10580 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10581 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10582 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10583 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10584 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10585
10586 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10587 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10588 to use this operator as well.
10589
10590
10591
10592 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10593 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10594 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10595 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10596 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10597 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10598 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10599
10600
10601 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10602 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10603 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10604 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10605 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10606 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10607 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10608
10609 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10610 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10611
10612
10613 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10614 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10615 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10616 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10617 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10618 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10619 and returns
10620 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10621
10622 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10623 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10624
10625
10626 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10627 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10628 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10629 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10630 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10631 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10632 and returns
10633 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10634
10635 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10636 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10637 with 256 being the default.
10638
10639 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10640 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later.
10641
10642
10643 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10644 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10645 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10646 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10647 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10648 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10649 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10650 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10651 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10652 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10653 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10654 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10655 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10656
10657 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10658 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10659 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10660
10661 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10662 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10663 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10664
10665
10666
10667 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10668 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10669 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10670 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10671 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10672 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10673
10674
10675 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10676 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10677 .cindex "substring extraction"
10678 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10679 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10680 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10681 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10682 .code
10683 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10684 .endd
10685 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10686 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10687
10688 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10689 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10690 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10691 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10692 seconds.
10693
10694 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10695 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10696 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10697 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10698 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10699 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10700 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10701
10702 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10703 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10704 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10705 .cindex "upper casing"
10706 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10707 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10708 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10709
10710 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10711 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10712 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10713 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10714 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10715 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10716 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10717
10718 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10719 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10720 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10721 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10722 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10723 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10724 .cindex EAI
10725 .cindex internationalisation
10726 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10727 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10728 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10729 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10730 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10731 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10732 .endlist
10733
10734
10735
10736
10737
10738
10739 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10740 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10741 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10742 while expanding strings:
10743
10744 .vlist
10745 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10746 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10747 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10748 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10749 condition.
10750
10751 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10752 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10753 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10754 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10755 are:
10756 .display
10757 &`= `& equal
10758 &`== `& equal
10759 &`> `& greater
10760 &`>= `& greater or equal
10761 &`< `& less
10762 &`<= `& less or equal
10763 .endd
10764 For example:
10765 .code
10766 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10767 .endd
10768 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10769 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10770 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10771 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10772 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10773 zero.
10774
10775 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10776 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10777 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10778
10779
10780 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10781 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10782 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10783 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10784 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10785 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10786 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10787 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10788 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10789 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10790 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10791 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10792 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10793 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10794
10795 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10796 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10797 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10798 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10799 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10800 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10801 false if zero.
10802 An empty string is treated as false.
10803 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10804 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10805 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10806
10807 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10808 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10809 For example:
10810 .code
10811 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10812 .endd
10813
10814
10815 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10816 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10817 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10818 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10819 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10820 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10821 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10822 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10823
10824 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10825
10826 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10827 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10828 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10829 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10830 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10831 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10832 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10833 included in the binary.
10834
10835 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10836 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10837 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10838 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10839 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10840 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10841 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10842 string in LDAP form is:
10843 .code
10844 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10845 .endd
10846 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10847 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10848 .code
10849 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10850 .endd
10851 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10852 supported:
10853
10854 .ilist
10855 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10856 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10857 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10858 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10859 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10860 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10861 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10862 comparison fails.
10863
10864 .next
10865 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10866 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10867 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10868 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10869 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10870 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10871
10872 .next
10873 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10874 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10875 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10876 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10877 whatever its length.
10878
10879 .next
10880 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10881 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10882 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10883 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10884 .endlist
10885 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10886 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10887 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10888 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10889 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10890 support &[crypt16()]&.
10891
10892 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10893 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10894 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10895 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10896 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10897
10898 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10899 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10900 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10901
10902 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10903 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10904 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10905 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10906 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10907
10908 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10909 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10910 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10911 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10912 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10913 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10914 .code
10915 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10916 .endd
10917 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10918 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10919
10920 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10921 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10922 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10923 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10924 exists in the message. For example,
10925 .code
10926 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10927 .endd
10928 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10929 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10930
10931 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10932 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10933 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10934 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10935 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10936 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10937 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10938 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10939 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10940
10941 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10942 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10943 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10944 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10945 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10946 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10947 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10948 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10949
10950 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10951 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10952 .cindex "first delivery"
10953 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10954 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10955 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10956 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10957
10958
10959 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10960 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10961 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10962 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10963 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10964 .vindex "&$item$&"
10965 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10966 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10967 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10968 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10969 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10970 .ilist
10971 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10972 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10973 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10974 .next
10975 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10976 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10977 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10978 .endlist
10979 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10980 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10981 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10982 list separator is changed to a comma:
10983 .code
10984 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10985 .endd
10986 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10987 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10988
10989 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10990
10991
10992 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10993 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10994 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10995 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10996 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10997 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10998 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10999 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11000 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11001 case-independent.
11002
11003 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11004 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11005 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11006 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11007 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11008 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11009 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11010 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11011 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11012 case-independent.
11013
11014 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11015 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11016 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11017 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11018 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11019 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11020 is true.
11021
11022 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11023 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11024 .code
11025 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11026 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11027 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11028 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11029 .endd
11030
11031 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11032 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11033 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11034 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11035 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11036 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11037 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11038 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11039 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11040 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11041 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11042
11043 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11044 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11045 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11046 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11047 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11048
11049 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11050 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11051 check.
11052 This is no longer the case.
11053
11054 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11055 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11056 .code
11057 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11058 .endd
11059 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11060
11061 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11062 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11063 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11064 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11065 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11066 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11067 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11068 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11069 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11070 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11071 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11072 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11073 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11074 this can be used.
11075
11076
11077 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11078 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11079 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11080 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11081 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11082 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11083 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11084 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11085 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11086 case-independent.
11087
11088 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11089 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11090 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11091 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11092 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11093 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11094 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11095 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11096 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11097 case-independent.
11098
11099
11100 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11101 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11102 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11103 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11104 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11105 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11106 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11107 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11108 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11109 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11110 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11111 For example,
11112 .code
11113 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11114 .endd
11115 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11116 backslashes is also required.
11117
11118 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11119 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11120 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11121 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11122 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11123 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11124
11125 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11126 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11127 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11128 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11129 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11130 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11131 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11132 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11133
11134 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11135 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11136 See &*match_local_part*&.
11137
11138 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11139 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11140 See &*match_local_part*&.
11141
11142 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11143 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11144 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11145 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11146 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11147 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11148 .code
11149 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11150 .endd
11151 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11152
11153 .ilist
11154 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11155 .next
11156 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11157 .next
11158 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11159 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11160 in a single test such as
11161 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11162 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11163 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11164 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11165 .code
11166 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11167 .endd
11168 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11169 .next
11170 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11171 .next
11172 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11173 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11174 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11175 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11176 masks. For example:
11177 .code
11178 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11179 .endd
11180 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11181 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11182 address mask, for example:
11183 .code
11184 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11185 .endd
11186 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11187 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11188 .code
11189 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11190 .endd
11191 .endlist ilist
11192
11193 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11194 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11195
11196 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11197
11198 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11199 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11200 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11201 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11202 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11203 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11204 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11205 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11206 example is:
11207 .code
11208 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11209 .endd
11210 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11211 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11212 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11213 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11214 .code
11215 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11216 .endd
11217 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11218 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11219 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11220 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11221 caselessly.
11222
11223 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11224 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11225
11226 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11227 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11228 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11229 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11230
11231 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11232 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11233 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11234 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11235 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11236 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11237 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11238 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11239 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11240 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11241 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11242 .code
11243 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11244 .endd
11245 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11246 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11247
11248 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11249 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11250 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11251 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11252 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11253 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11254 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11255
11256 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11257 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11258 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11259 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11260 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11261 .code
11262 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11263 .endd
11264 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11265 .code
11266 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11267 .endd
11268 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11269 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11270 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11271 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11272 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11273 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11274 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11275 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11276
11277
11278 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11279 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11280 .cindex "Cyrus"
11281 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11282 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11283 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11284 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11285 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11286 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11287
11288 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11289 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11290 building Exim. For example:
11291 .code
11292 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11293 .endd
11294 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11295 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11296 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11297 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11298
11299 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11300 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11301 configuration, you might have this:
11302 .code
11303 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11304 .endd
11305 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11306 .code
11307 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11308 .endd
11309 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11310 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11311 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11312 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11313 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11314 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11315
11316
11317 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11318 .cindex "Radius"
11319 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11320 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11321 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11322 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11323 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11324 support.
11325
11326 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11327 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11328 this library, you need to set
11329 .code
11330 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11331 .endd
11332 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11333 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11334 .code
11335 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11336 .endd
11337 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11338 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11339 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11340
11341 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11342 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11343 the authentication is successful. For example:
11344 .code
11345 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11346 .endd
11347
11348
11349 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11350 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11351 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11352 .cindex "Cyrus"
11353 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11354 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11355 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11356 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11357 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11358 by a process that is not running as root.
11359
11360 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11361 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11362 building Exim. For example:
11363 .code
11364 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11365 .endd
11366 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11367 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11368 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11369
11370 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11371 two are mandatory. For example:
11372 .code
11373 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11374 .endd
11375 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11376 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11377 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11378 .endlist vlist
11379
11380
11381
11382 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11383 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11384 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11385 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11386 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11387 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11388 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11389
11390
11391 .vlist
11392 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11393 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11394 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11395 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11396 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11397 For example,
11398 .code
11399 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11400 .endd
11401 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11402 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11403 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11404
11405 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11406 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11407 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11408 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11409 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11410 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11411 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11412 parsed but not evaluated.
11413 .endlist
11414 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11415
11416
11417
11418
11419 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11420 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11421 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11422 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11423 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11424
11425 .vlist
11426 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11427 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11428 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11429 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11430 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11431 In the expansion condition case
11432 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11433 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11434 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11435 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11436 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11437 matching condition.
11438
11439 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11440 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11441 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11442 any unused variables being made empty.
11443
11444 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11445 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11446 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11447 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11448 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11449 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11450 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11451 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11452 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11453 during subsequent delivery.
11454
11455 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11456 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11457 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11458 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11459 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11460 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11461 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11462 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11463 delivery.
11464
11465 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11466 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11467 this variable has the number of arguments.
11468
11469 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11470 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11471 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11472 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11473 be preserved by coding like this:
11474 .code
11475 warn !verify = sender
11476 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11477 .endd
11478 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11479 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11480 failure.
11481
11482 .vitem &$address_data$&
11483 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11484 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11485 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11486 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11487 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11488 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11489 user filter files.
11490
11491 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11492 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11493 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11494 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11495 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11496 from the child's routing.
11497
11498 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11499 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11500 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11501 address.
11502
11503 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11504 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11505 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11506
11507 .vitem &$address_file$&
11508 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11509 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11510 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11511 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11512 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11513 .code
11514 /home/r2d2/savemail
11515 .endd
11516 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11517 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11518 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11519 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11520 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11521 to the relevant file.
11522
11523 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11524 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11525 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11526 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11527
11528 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11529 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11530 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11531 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11532
11533 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11534 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11535 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11536 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11537 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11538 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11539 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11540 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11541 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11542 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11543 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11544 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11545 command line option.
11546
11547 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11548 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11549 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11550 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11551 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11552 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11553 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11554 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11555 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11556 the ACL's as well.
11557
11558
11559 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11560 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11561 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11562 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11563 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11564 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11565 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11566 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11567 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11568 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11569 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11570
11571 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11572 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11573 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11574 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11575 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11576
11577
11578 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11579 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11580 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11581 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11582 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11583 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11584 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11585 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11586 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11587 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11588 an undefined mechanism.
11589
11590 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11591 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11592 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11593 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11594 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11595 the ACL malware condition.
11596
11597 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11598 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11599 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11600 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11601 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11602 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11603
11604 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11605 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11606 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11607 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11608 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11609 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11610 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11611
11612 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11613 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11614 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11615 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11616 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11617
11618 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11619 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11620 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11621 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11622 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11623
11624 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11625 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11626 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11627 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11628 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11629 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11630 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11631
11632 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11633 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11634 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11635 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11636 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11637 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11638 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11639
11640 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11641 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11642 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11643 address that was connected to.
11644
11645 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11646 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11647 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11648 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11649 compilations of the same version of the program.
11650
11651 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11652 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11653 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11654 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11655 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11656 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11657
11658 .vitem &$config_file$&
11659 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11660 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11661
11662 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11663 Results of DKIM verification.
11664 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11665
11666 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11667 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11668 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11669 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11670 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11671 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11672 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11673 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11674 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11675 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11676 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11677 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11678 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11679 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11680 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11681 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11682 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11683 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11684 &$dkim_key_length$&
11685 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11686 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11687
11688 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11689 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11690 When a message has been received this variable contains
11691 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11692 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11693
11694 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11695 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11696 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11697 &$dnslist_value$&
11698 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11699 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11700 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11701 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11702 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11703 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11704 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11705 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11706 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11707
11708 .vitem &$domain$&
11709 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11710 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11711 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11712 case for &$domain$&.
11713
11714 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11715 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11716 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11717 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11718
11719 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11720 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11721 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11722 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11723 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11724 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11725
11726 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11727 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11728 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11729
11730 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11731
11732 .ilist
11733 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11734 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11735 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11736 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11737 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11738 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11739 the &(smtp)& transport.
11740
11741 .next
11742 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11743 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11744 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11745 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11746
11747 .next
11748 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11749 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11750 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11751 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11752 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11753 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11754
11755 .next
11756 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11757 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11758 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11759 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11760 .endlist
11761
11762
11763 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11764 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11765 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11766 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11767 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11768 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11769 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11770 used.
11771
11772 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11773 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11774 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11775 to nothing.
11776
11777 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11778 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11779 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11780
11781 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11782 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11783 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11784
11785 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11786 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11787 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11788
11789 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11790 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11791 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11792 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11793 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11794 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11795
11796 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11797 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11798 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11799 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11800 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11801
11802 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11803 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11804 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11805 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11806 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11807
11808 .vitem &$home$&
11809 .vindex "&$home$&"
11810 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11811 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11812 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11813 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11814 by a setting on the transport itself.
11815
11816 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11817 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11818 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11819
11820 .vitem &$host$&
11821 .vindex "&$host$&"
11822 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11823 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11824 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11825 to local and remote transports.
11826
11827 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11828 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11829 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11830 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11831 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11832 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11833 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11834 is connected.
11835
11836 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11837 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11838 client is connected.
11839
11840
11841 .vitem &$host_address$&
11842 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11843 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11844 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11845 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11846
11847 .vitem &$host_data$&
11848 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11849 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11850 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11851 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11852 .code
11853 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11854 message = $host_data
11855 .endd
11856 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11857 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11858 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11859 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11860 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11861 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11862 variables is set to &"1"&.
11863
11864 .ilist
11865 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11866 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11867
11868 .next
11869 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11870 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11871 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11872 .endlist ilist
11873
11874 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11875 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11876 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11877 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11878 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11879 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11880 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11881 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11882 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11883 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11884
11885 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11886 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11887 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11888
11889 .vitem &$host_port$&
11890 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11891 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11892 for an outbound connection.
11893
11894 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11895 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11896 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11897 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11898 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11899 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11900
11901 .vitem &$inode$&
11902 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11903 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11904 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11905 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11906 a unique name for the file.
11907
11908 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11909 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11910 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11911
11912 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11913 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11914 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11915
11916 .vitem &$item$&
11917 .vindex "&$item$&"
11918 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11919 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11920 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11921 empty.
11922
11923 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11924 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11925 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11926 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11927 lookup.
11928
11929 .vitem &$load_average$&
11930 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11931 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11932 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11933 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11934
11935 .vitem &$local_part$&
11936 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11937 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11938 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11939 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11940 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11941
11942 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11943 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11944 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11945 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11946 once.
11947
11948 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11949 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11950 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11951 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11952 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11953 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11954
11955 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11956 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11957 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11958 &$address_pipe$&).
11959
11960 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11961 local part of the recipient address.
11962
11963 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11964 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11965 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11966
11967 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11968 the addresses
11969 .code
11970 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11971 abc\:xyz@test.example
11972 .endd
11973 the value of &$local_part$& is
11974 .code
11975 abc:xyz
11976 .endd
11977 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11978 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11979 have:
11980 .code
11981 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11982 .endd
11983 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11984 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11985 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11986
11987 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11988 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11989 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11990 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11991 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11992 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11993 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11994
11995 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11996 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11997 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11998 variable expands to nothing.
11999
12000 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12001 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12002 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12003 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12004 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12005
12006 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12007 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12008 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12009 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12010 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12011
12012 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12013 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12014 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12015 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12016
12017 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12018 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12019 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12020
12021 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12022 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12023 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12024 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12025 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12026 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12027 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12028 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12029
12030 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12031 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12032 This contains the expanded value of the
12033 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12034 been read.
12035
12036 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12037 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12038 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12039 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12040 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12041 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12042
12043 .vitem &$log_space$&
12044 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12045 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12046 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12047 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12048 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12049 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12050
12051
12052 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12053 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12054 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12055 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12056 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12057 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12058 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12059 and &"yes"& if it was.
12060 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12061 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12062 as authenticated data.
12063
12064 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12065 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12066 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12067 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12068 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12069 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12070 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12071 variable is empty.
12072
12073 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12074 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12075 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12076 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12077 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12078
12079 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12080 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12081 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12082 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12083 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12084 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12085 character(s).
12086 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12087
12088 .vitem &$message_age$&
12089 .cindex "message" "age of"
12090 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12091 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12092 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12093 delivery attempt.
12094
12095 .vitem &$message_body$&
12096 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12097 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12098 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12099 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12100 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12101 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12102 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12103 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12104 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12105
12106 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12107 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12108 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12109 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12110 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12111
12112 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12113 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12114 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12115 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12116 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12117 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12118 &$message_body$&.
12119
12120 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12121 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12122 .cindex "message body" "size"
12123 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12124 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12125 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12126 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12127 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12128
12129 If the spool file is wireformat
12130 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12131 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12132
12133 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12134 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12135 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12136 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12137 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12138 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12139 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12140 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12141
12142 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12143 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12144 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12145 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12146 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12147 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12148
12149 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12150 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12151 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12152 contents of header lines is done.
12153
12154 .vitem &$message_id$&
12155 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12156
12157 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12158 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12159 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12160 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12161 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12162 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12163 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12164 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12165 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12166 from the body is not counted.
12167
12168 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12169 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12170 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12171 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12172 header and the body).
12173
12174 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12175 .code
12176 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12177 condition = \
12178 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12179 .endd
12180 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12181 message has not yet been received.
12182
12183 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12184
12185 .vitem &$message_size$&
12186 .cindex "size" "of message"
12187 .cindex "message" "size"
12188 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12189 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12190 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12191 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12192 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12193 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12194 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12195 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12196 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12197
12198 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12199 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12200 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12201 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12202
12203 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12204 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12205 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12206 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12207
12208 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12209 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12210 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12211
12212 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12213 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12214 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12215 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12216 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12217 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12218 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12219 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12220 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12221 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12222
12223 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12224 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12225 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12226
12227 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12228 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12229 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12230 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12231 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12232 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12233 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12234 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12235 the original address.
12236
12237 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12238 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12239 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12240 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12241 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12242
12243 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12244 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12245 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12246
12247 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12248 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12249 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12250 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12251 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12252 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12253 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12254 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12255 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12256
12257 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12258 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12259 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12260 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12261 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12262 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12263 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12264 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12265 user.
12266
12267 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12268 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12269 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12270 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12271
12272 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12273 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12274 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12275 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12276
12277 .vitem &$pid$&
12278 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12279 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12280 This variable contains the current process id.
12281
12282 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12283 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12284 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12285 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12286 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12287 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12288 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12289 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12290 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12291 variable"& error if encountered.
12292
12293 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12294 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12295 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12296 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12297 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12298 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12299 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12300
12301
12302 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12303 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12304 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12305 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12306 &$proxy_session$&
12307 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12308 or SOCKS5 support.
12309 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12310
12311 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12312 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12313 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12314 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12315
12316 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12317 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12318 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12319 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12320
12321 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12322 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12323 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12324 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12325
12326 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12327 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12328 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12329 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12330
12331 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12332 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12333 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12334
12335 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12336 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12337 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12338 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12339
12340 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12341 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12342 .cindex "named queues"
12343 .cindex queues named
12344 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12345
12346 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12347 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12348 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12349 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12350 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12351
12352 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12353 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12354 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12355 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12356 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12357 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12358
12359 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12360 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12361 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12362 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12363 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12364
12365 .vitem &$received_count$&
12366 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12367 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12368 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12369 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12370 delivering.
12371
12372 .vitem &$received_for$&
12373 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12374 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12375 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12376 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12377 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12378
12379 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12380 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12381 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12382 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12383 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12384 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12385 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12386 option.
12387
12388 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12389 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12390 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12391 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12392 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12393 time.
12394 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12395
12396 .vitem &$received_port$&
12397 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12398 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12399
12400 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12401 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12402 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12403 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12404 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12405 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12406 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12407 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12408 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12409
12410 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12411 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12412 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12413 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12414 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12415 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12416
12417 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12418 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12419 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12420
12421 .vitem &$received_time$&
12422 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12423 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12424 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12425
12426 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12427 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12428 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12429 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12430 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12431 .display
12432 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12433 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12434 .endd
12435 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12436 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12437 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12438 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12439
12440 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12441 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12442 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12443 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12444
12445 .ilist
12446 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12447 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12448
12449 .next
12450 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12451
12452 .next
12453 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12454 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12455 MAIL).
12456
12457 .next
12458 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12459 .next
12460
12461 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12462 .endlist
12463
12464 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12465 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12466
12467 .vitem &$recipients$&
12468 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12469 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12470 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12471 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12472 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12473 cases:
12474
12475 .olist
12476 In a system filter file.
12477 .next
12478 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12479 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12480 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12481 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12482 .next
12483 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12484 .endlist
12485
12486
12487 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12488 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12489 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12490 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12491 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12492 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12493
12494
12495 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12496 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12497 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12498 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12499
12500 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12501 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12502 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12503 these variables contain the
12504 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12505
12506
12507 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12508 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12509 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12510 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12511 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12512 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12513 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12514
12515 .vitem &$return_path$&
12516 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12517 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12518 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12519 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12520 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12521 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12522 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12523 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12524 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12525 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12526 envelope sender.
12527
12528 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12529 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12530 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12531
12532 .vitem &$router_name$&
12533 .cindex "router" "name"
12534 .cindex "name" "of router"
12535 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12536 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12537
12538 .vitem &$runrc$&
12539 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12540 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12541 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12542 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12543 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12544 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12545 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12546 another.
12547
12548 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12549 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12550 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12551 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12552 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12553 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12554 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12555 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12556
12557 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12558 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12559 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12560 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12561 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12562 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12563
12564 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12565 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12566 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12567 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12568 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12569 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12570 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12571 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12572
12573 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12574 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12575 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12576
12577 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12578 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12579 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12580
12581 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12582 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12583 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12584 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12585 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12586 this:
12587 .display
12588 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12589 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12590 .endd
12591 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12592 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12593 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12594 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12595
12596 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12597 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12598 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12599 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12600 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12601 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12602 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12603 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12604 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12605 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12606 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12607 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12608 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12609
12610 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12611 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12612 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12613 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12614 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12615
12616 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12617 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12618 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12619 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12620 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12621 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12622
12623 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12624 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12625 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12626 this variable contains that
12627 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12628
12629 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12630 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12631 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12632 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12633 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12634 &$authenticated_id$&.
12635
12636 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12637 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12638 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12639 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12640 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12641 resolver library states that both
12642 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12643 other times, this variable is false.
12644
12645 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12646 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12647 library, by setting:
12648 .code
12649 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12650 .endd
12651
12652 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12653 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12654
12655 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12656 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12657
12658 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12659 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12660 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12661 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12662
12663
12664 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12665 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12666 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12667 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12668 other means, this variable is empty.
12669
12670 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12671 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12672 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12673 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12674 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12675 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12676 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12677
12678 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12679 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12680 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12681 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12682
12683 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12684 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12685 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12686 is set to &"1"&.
12687
12688 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12689 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12690 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12691 following are true:
12692
12693 .ilist
12694 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12695 .next
12696 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12697 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12698 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12699 .next
12700 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12701 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12702 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12703 .next
12704 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12705 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12706 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12707 .next
12708 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12709 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12710 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12711 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12712 .code
12713 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12714 .endd
12715 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12716 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12717 .endlist
12718
12719
12720 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12721 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12722 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12723 number that was used on the remote host.
12724
12725 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12726 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12727 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12728 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12729 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12730 called Exim.
12731
12732 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12733 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12734 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12735 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12736
12737 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12738 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12739 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12740 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12741 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12742 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12743 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12744 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12745 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12746 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12747 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12748 the parentheses.
12749
12750 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12751 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12752 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12753 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12754 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12755
12756 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12757 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12758 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12759 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12760 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12761
12762 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12763 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12764 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12765 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12766 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12767 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12768 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12769
12770 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12771 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12772 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12773 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12774 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12775
12776 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12777 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12778 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12779 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12780 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12781 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12782
12783 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12784 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12785 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12786 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12787 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12788 .code
12789 MAIL FROM:<>
12790 MAIL FROM: <>
12791 .endd
12792 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12793 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12794 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12795 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12796
12797 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12798 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12799 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12800 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12801 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12802 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12803 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12804
12805 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12806 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12807 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12808 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12809 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12810 are remembered.
12811
12812 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12813 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12814 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12815 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12816 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12817 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12818 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12819 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12820 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12821 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12822 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12823
12824 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12825 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12826 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12827 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12828 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12829 message is junk mail.
12830
12831 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12832 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12833 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12834 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12835
12836
12837 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12838 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12839 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12840
12841 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12842 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12843 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12844 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12845 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12846 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12847
12848 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12849 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12850 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12851 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12852 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12853 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12854 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12855 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12856 .code
12857 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12858 .endd
12859 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12860
12861
12862 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12863 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12864 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12865 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12866 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12867 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12868
12869 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12870 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12871 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12872 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12873 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12874 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12875 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12876 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12877
12878 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12879 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12880 the outbound.
12881
12882 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12883 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12884 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12885 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12886 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12887 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12888
12889 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12890 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12891 .cindex certificate variables
12892 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12893 inbound connection when the message was received.
12894 It is only useful as the argument of a
12895 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12896 or a &%def%& condition.
12897
12898 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12899 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12900
12901 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12902 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12903 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12904 inbound connection when the message was received.
12905 It is only useful as the argument of a
12906 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12907 or a &%def%& condition.
12908 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12909 which is not the leaf.
12910
12911 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12912 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12913 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12914 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12915 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12916 or a &%def%& condition.
12917
12918 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12919 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12920 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12921 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12922 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12923 or a &%def%& condition.
12924 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12925 which is not the leaf.
12926
12927 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12928 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12929 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12930 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12931
12932 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12933 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12934 the outbound.
12935
12936 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12937 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12938 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12939 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12940 and &"0"& otherwise.
12941
12942 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12943 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12944 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12945 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12946 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12947 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12948 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12949 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12950 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12951
12952 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12953 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12954 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12955
12956 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12957 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12958 This variable is
12959 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12960 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12961 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12962 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12963
12964 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12965 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12966 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12967 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12968 .code
12969 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12970 1 No response to request
12971 2 Response not verified
12972 3 Verification failed
12973 4 Verification succeeded
12974 .endd
12975
12976 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12977 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12978 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12979 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12980 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12981
12982 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12983 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12984 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12985 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12986 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12987 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12988 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12989 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12990 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12991 which is not the leaf.
12992
12993 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12994 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12995 the outbound.
12996
12997 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12998 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12999 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13000 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13001 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13002 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13003 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13004 which is not the leaf.
13005
13006 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13007 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13008 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13009 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13010 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13011 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13012 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13013 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13014 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13015 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13016 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13017
13018 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13019 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13020 the outbound.
13021
13022 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13023 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13024 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13025 During outbound
13026 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13027 the transport.
13028
13029 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13030 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13031 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13032 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13033
13034 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13035 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13036 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13037
13038 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13039 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13040 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13041
13042 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13043 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13044 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13045 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13046 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13047 values for those that are behind (west).
13048
13049 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13050 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13051 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13052 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13053
13054 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13055 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13056 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13057 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13058 flag.
13059
13060 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13061 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13062 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13063 -0500.
13064
13065 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13066 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13067 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13068 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13069
13070 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13071 .cindex "transport" "name"
13072 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13073 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13074 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13075
13076 .vitem &$value$&
13077 .vindex "&$value$&"
13078 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13079 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13080 &*reduce*& expansion.
13081
13082 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13083 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13084 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13085 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13086 Otherwise, empty.
13087
13088 .vitem &$version_number$&
13089 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13090 The version number of Exim.
13091
13092 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13093 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13094 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13095 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13096
13097 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13098 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13099 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13100 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13101 .endlist
13102 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13103
13104
13105
13106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13108
13109 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13110 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13111 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13112 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13113 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13114 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13115 the line
13116 .code
13117 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13118 .endd
13119 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13120
13121
13122 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13123 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13124 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13125 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13126 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13127 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13128 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13129 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13130 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13131
13132 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13133 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13134 should usually be something like
13135 .code
13136 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13137 .endd
13138 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13139 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13140 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13141 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13142 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13143 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13144 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13145 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13146 two ways:
13147
13148 .ilist
13149 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13150 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13151 a startup when Exim is entered.
13152 .next
13153 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13154 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13155 .endlist
13156
13157 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13158 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13159
13160 .ilist
13161 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13162 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13163 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13164 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13165 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13166 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13167 defaults to false.
13168
13169
13170 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13171 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13172 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13173 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13174 forms:
13175 .code
13176 ${perl{foo}}
13177 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13178 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13179 .endd
13180 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13181 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13182 with an error message of the form
13183 .code
13184 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13185 .endd
13186 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13187 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13188 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13189 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13190 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13191 that was passed to &%die%&.
13192
13193
13194 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13195 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13196 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13197 the Perl code
13198 .code
13199 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13200 .endd
13201 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13202 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13203 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13204
13205 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13206 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13207 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13208 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13209
13210 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13211 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13212 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13213 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13214 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13215 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13216 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13217
13218
13219 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13220 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13221 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13222 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13223 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13224 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13225 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13226 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13227 avoided, but the output is lost.
13228
13229 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13230 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13231 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13232 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13233 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13234 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13235 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13236 .code
13237 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13238 .endd
13239 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13240 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13241 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13242 as the first subroutine argument.
13243 .ecindex IIDperl
13244
13245
13246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13247 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13248
13249 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13250 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13251 "Starting the daemon"
13252 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13253 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13254 .cindex "network interface"
13255 .cindex "interface" "network"
13256 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13257 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13258 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13259 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13260 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13261 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13262 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13263 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13264 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13265 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13266 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13267
13268 .olist
13269 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13270 and ports to listen on.
13271 .next
13272 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13273 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13274 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13275 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13276 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13277 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13278 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13279 as an error situation.
13280 .next
13281 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13282 for the outgoing connection.
13283 .endlist
13284
13285
13286 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13287 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13288 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13289 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13290 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13291
13292 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13293 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13294 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13295 chapter describes how they operate.
13296
13297 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13298 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13299
13300
13301
13302 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13303 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13304 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13305 following options:
13306
13307 .ilist
13308 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13309 or service names.
13310 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13311 .next
13312 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13313 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13314 .endlist
13315
13316 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13317 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13318 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13319 colons. For example:
13320 .code
13321 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13322 192.168.23.65 ; \
13323 ::1 ; \
13324 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13325 .endd
13326 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13327 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13328
13329 .olist
13330 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13331 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13332 .code
13333 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13334 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13335 .endd
13336 .next
13337 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13338 with a colon separator, for example:
13339 .code
13340 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13341 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13342 .endd
13343 .endlist
13344
13345 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13346 default setting contains just one port:
13347 .code
13348 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13349 .endd
13350 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13351 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13352 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13353 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13354 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13355
13356
13357
13358 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13359 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13360 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13361 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13362 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13363 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13364 .code
13365 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13366 .endd
13367 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13368 .code
13369 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13370 .endd
13371 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13372
13373
13374
13375 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13376 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13377 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13378 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13379 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13380 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13381 exim.
13382
13383 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13384 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13385 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13386 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13387 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13388 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13389 .code
13390 -oX 1225
13391 .endd
13392 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13393 whereas
13394 .code
13395 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13396 .endd
13397 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13398 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13399 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13400
13401
13402
13403 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13404 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13405 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13406 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13407 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13408 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13409 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13410 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13411 list of port numbers or service names,
13412 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13413 common use of this option is expected to be
13414 .code
13415 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13416 .endd
13417 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13418 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13419 this way when a daemon is started.
13420
13421 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13422 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13423 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13424 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13425 connections via the daemon.)
13426
13427
13428
13429
13430 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13431 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13432 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13433 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13434 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13435 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13436 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13437 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13438 .code
13439 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13440 .endd
13441 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13442 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13443 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13444 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13445 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13446 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13447 .code
13448 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13449 .endd
13450 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13451 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13452 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13453 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13454 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13455
13456 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13457 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13458 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13459 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13460 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13461 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13462 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13463 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13464 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13465 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13466 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13467 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13468
13469 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13470 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13471 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13472 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13473 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13474
13475
13476
13477 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13478 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13479 .code
13480 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13481 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13482 .endd
13483 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13484 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13485 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13486 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13487
13488 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13489 .code
13490 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13491 .endd
13492 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13493 .code
13494 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13495 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13496 .endd
13497 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13498 IPv4 loopback address only:
13499 .code
13500 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13501 .endd
13502 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13503 .code
13504 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13505 .endd
13506 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13507
13508
13509
13510 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13511 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13512 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13513 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13514 treated as local.
13515
13516 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13517 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13518 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13519 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13520
13521 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13522 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13523 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13524 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13525 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13526 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13527 used for listening. Consider this example:
13528 .code
13529 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13530 192.168.53.235 ; \
13531 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13532
13533 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13534 .endd
13535 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13536 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13537 Exim is routing.
13538
13539 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13540 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13541 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13542 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13543 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13544 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13545 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13546 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13547
13548
13549
13550 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13551 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13552 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13553 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13554 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13555 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13556 details.
13557
13558
13559
13560
13561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13563
13564 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13565 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13566 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13567 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13568
13569 .ilist
13570 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13571 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13572 .next
13573 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13574 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13575 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13576 .next
13577 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13578 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13579 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13580 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13581 settings.
13582 .endlist
13583
13584 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13585 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13586 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13587 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13588 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13589 listed in more than one group.
13590
13591 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13592 .table2
13593 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13594 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13595 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13596 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13597 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13598 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13599 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13600 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13601 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13602 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13603 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13604 .endtable
13605
13606
13607 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13608 .table2
13609 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13610 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13611 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13612 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13613 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13614 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13615 .endtable
13616
13617
13618
13619 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13620 .table2
13621 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13622 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13623 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13624 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13625 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13626 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13627 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13628 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13629 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13630 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13631 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13632 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13633 .endtable
13634
13635
13636
13637 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13638 .table2
13639 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13640 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13641 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13642 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13643 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13644 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13645 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13646 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13647 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13648 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13649 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13650 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13651 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13652 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13653 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13654 .endtable
13655
13656
13657
13658 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13659 .table2
13660 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13661 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13662 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13663 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13664 .endtable
13665
13666
13667
13668 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13669 .table2
13670 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13671 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13672 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13673 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13674 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13675 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13676 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13677 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13678 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13679 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13680 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13681 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13682 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13683 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13684 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13685 .endtable
13686
13687
13688
13689 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13690 .table2
13691 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13692 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13693 .endtable
13694
13695
13696
13697 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13698 .table2
13699 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13700 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13701 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13702 .endtable
13703
13704
13705
13706 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13707 .table2
13708 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13709 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13710 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13711 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13712 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13713 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13714 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13715 .endtable
13716
13717
13718
13719 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13720 .table2
13721 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13722 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13723 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13724 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13725 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13726 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13727 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13728 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13729 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13730 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13731 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13732 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13733 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13734 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13735 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13736 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13737 connection"
13738 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13739 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13740 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13741 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13742 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13743 .endtable
13744
13745
13746
13747 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13748 .table2
13749 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13750 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13751 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13752 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13753 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13754 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13755 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13756 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13757 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13758 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13759 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13760 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13761 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13762 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13763 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13764 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13765 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13766 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13767 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13768 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13769 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13770 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13771 words""&"
13772 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13773 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13774 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13775 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13776 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13777 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13778 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13779 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13780 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13781 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13782 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13783 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13784 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13785 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13786 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13787 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13788 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13789 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13790 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13791 .endtable
13792
13793
13794
13795 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13796 .table2
13797 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13798 item"
13799 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13800 item"
13801 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13802 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13803 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13804 .endtable
13805
13806
13807
13808 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13809 .table2
13810 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13811 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13812 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13813 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13814 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13815 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13816 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13817 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13818 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13819 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13820 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13821 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13822 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13823 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13824 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13825 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13826 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13827 .endtable
13828
13829
13830
13831 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13832 .table2
13833 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13834 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13835 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13836 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13837 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13838 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13839 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13840 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13841 .endtable
13842
13843
13844
13845 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13846 .table2
13847 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13848 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13849 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13850 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13851 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13852 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13853 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13854 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13855 .endtable
13856
13857
13858
13859
13860 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13861 .table2
13862 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13863 .endtable
13864
13865
13866
13867
13868
13869 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13870 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13871
13872 .table2
13873 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13874 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13875 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13876 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13877 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13878 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13879 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13880 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13881 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13882 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13883 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13884 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13885 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13886 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13887 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13888 connection"
13889 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13890 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13891 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13892 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13893 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13894 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13895 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13896 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13897 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13898 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13899 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13900 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13901 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13902 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13903 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13904 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13905 .endtable
13906
13907
13908
13909 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13910 .table2
13911 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13912 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13913 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13914 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13915 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13916 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13917 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13918 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13919 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13920 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13921 .endtable
13922
13923
13924
13925 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13926 .table2
13927 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13928 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13929 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13930 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13931 words""&"
13932 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13933 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13934 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13935 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13936 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13937 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13938 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13939 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13940 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13941 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13942 .endtable
13943
13944
13945
13946 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13947 .table2
13948 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13949 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13950 directory"
13951 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13952 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13953 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13954 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13955 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13956 .endtable
13957
13958
13959
13960 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13961 .table2
13962 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13963 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13964 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13965 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13966 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13967 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13968 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13969 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13970 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13971 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13972 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13973 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13974 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13975 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13976 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13977 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13978 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13979 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13980 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13981 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13982 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13983 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13984 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13985 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13986 .endtable
13987
13988
13989
13990 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13991 .table2
13992 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13993 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13994 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13995 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13996 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13997 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13998 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13999 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14000 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14001 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14002 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14003 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14004 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14005 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14006 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14007 .endtable
14008
14009
14010
14011 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14012 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14013 &dagger;.
14014
14015 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14016 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14017 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14018 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14019 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14020 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14021 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14022 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14023 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14024
14025 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14026 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14027 It now defaults to true.
14028 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14029 .display
14030 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14031 .endd
14032
14033 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14034 .code
14035 log_selector = +8bitmime
14036 .endd
14037
14038 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14039 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14040 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14041 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14042 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14043 further details.
14044
14045 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14046 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14047 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14048 SMTP messages.
14049
14050 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14051 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14052 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14053 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14054 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14055
14056 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14057 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14058 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14059 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14060 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14061
14062 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14063 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14064 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14065 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14066
14067 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14068 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14069 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14070 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14071 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14072
14073 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14074 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14075 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14076 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14077 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14078 This option defines the ACL that,
14079 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14080 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14081 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14082 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14083
14084 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14085 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14086 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14087 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14088 of a received message.
14089 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
14090
14091 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14092 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14093 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14094 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14095
14096 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14097 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14098 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14099 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14100
14101 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14102 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14103 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14104 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14105 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14106
14107
14108 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14109 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14110 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14111 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14112
14113 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14114 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14115 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14116 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14117 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14118
14119 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14120 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14121 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14122 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14123 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14124
14125 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14126 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14127 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14128 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14129 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14130
14131 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14132 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14133 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14134 further details.
14135
14136 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14137 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14138 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14139 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14140
14141 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14142 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14143 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14144 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14145
14146 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14147 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14148 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14149 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14150
14151 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14152 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14153 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14154 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14155
14156 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14157 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14158 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14159 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14160 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14161
14162 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14163 .cindex "admin user"
14164 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14165 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14166 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14167 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14168 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14169 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14170 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14171
14172 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14173 .cindex "domain literal"
14174 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14175 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14176 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14177 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14178
14179 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14180 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14181 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14182 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14183 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14184 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14185 the local host's IP addresses.
14186
14187
14188 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14189 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14190 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14191 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14192 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14193 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14194 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14195 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14196 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14197
14198 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14199 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14200 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14201 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14202 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14203 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14204 experiment if they wish.
14205
14206 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14207 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14208 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14209 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14210 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14211 suitable setting is:
14212 .code
14213 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14214 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14215 .endd
14216 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14217 .code
14218 dns_check_names_pattern =
14219 .endd
14220 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14221
14222
14223 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14224 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14225 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14226 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14227 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14228 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14229 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14230 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14231 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14232 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14233 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14234
14235 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14236 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14237 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14238 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14239 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14240 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14241
14242 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14243 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14244 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14245 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14246 .code
14247 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14248 .endd
14249 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14250 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14251 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14252 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14253
14254
14255 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14256 .cindex "thawing messages"
14257 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14258 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14259 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14260 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14261 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14262 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14263
14264 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14265 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14266 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14267
14268
14269 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14270 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14271 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14272 .code
14273 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14274 .endd
14275 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14276 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14277
14278
14279 .option bi_command main string unset
14280 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14281 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14282 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14283 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14284 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14285
14286
14287 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14288 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14289 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14290 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14291 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14292 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14293
14294
14295 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14296 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14297 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14298 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14299
14300 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14301 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14302 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14303 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14304 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14305 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14306 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14307 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14308 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14309 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14310
14311 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14312 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14313 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14314 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14315 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14316 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14317 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14318 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14319 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14320 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14321
14322 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14323 during reception of a message.
14324 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14325
14326 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14327
14328
14329 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14330 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14331 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14332 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14333
14334
14335 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14336 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14337 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14338 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14339 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14340 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14341 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14342 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14343 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14344
14345 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14346 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14347 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14348 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14349 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14350 messages.
14351
14352 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14353 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14354 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14355 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14356 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14357 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14358 connection. A typical setting might be:
14359 .code
14360 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14361 .endd
14362 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14363 .code
14364 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14365 .endd
14366 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14367 address.
14368
14369 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14370 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14371 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14372 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14373 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14374 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14375
14376
14377 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14378 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14379 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14380 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14381
14382
14383 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14384 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14385 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14386 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14387
14388
14389 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14390 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14391 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14392 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14393
14394
14395 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14396 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14397 callout verification. The default value is
14398 .code
14399 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14400 .endd
14401 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14402
14403
14404 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14405 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14406
14407
14408 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14409 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14410
14411 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14412 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14413 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14414 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14415 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14416 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14417 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14418 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14419 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14420 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14421
14422
14423 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14424 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14425
14426
14427 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14428 .cindex "checking disk space"
14429 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14430 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14431 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14432 message is accepted.
14433
14434 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14435 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14436 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14437 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14438 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14439 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14440 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14441 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14442
14443
14444 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14445 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14446 .code
14447 check_spool_space = 100M
14448 check_spool_inodes = 100
14449 .endd
14450 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14451 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14452 transit.
14453
14454 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14455 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14456 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14457
14458 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14459 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14460 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14461 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14462 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14463 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14464
14465 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14466 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14467 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14468
14469 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14470 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14471 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14472
14473 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14474 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14475 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14476 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14477
14478 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14479 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14480 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14481 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14482 these hosts.
14483 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14484
14485 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14486 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14487 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14488 administrative user.
14489 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14490
14491 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14492 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14493 .cindex memory debugging
14494 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14495 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14496 it should normally be left as default.
14497
14498 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14499 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14500 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14501 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14502 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14503 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14504
14505 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14506 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14507 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14508 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14509 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14510 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14511 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14512
14513 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14514 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14515
14516 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14517 .cindex "warning of delay"
14518 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14519 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14520 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14521 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14522 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14523 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14524 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14525 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14526 with
14527 .code
14528 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14529 .endd
14530 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14531 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14532 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14533 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14534 .code
14535 delay_warning = 6h
14536 .endd
14537 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14538 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14539 .code
14540 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14541 .endd
14542 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14543 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14544 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14545
14546 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14547 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14548 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14549 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14550 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14551 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14552 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14553 not sent. The default is:
14554 .code
14555 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14556 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14557 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14558 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14559 } {no}{yes}}
14560 .endd
14561 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14562 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14563 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14564 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14565
14566 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14567 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14568 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14569 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14570 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14571 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14572 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14573 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14574
14575 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14576 .cindex "load average"
14577 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14578 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14579 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14580 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14581 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14582
14583
14584 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14585 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14586 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14587 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14588 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14589 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14590 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14591 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14592
14593 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14594 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14595 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14596 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14597 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14598 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14599 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14600 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14601
14602 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14603 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14604 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14605 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14606
14607
14608 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14609 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14610 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14611 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14612 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14613 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14614 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14615
14616
14617 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14618 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14619 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14620 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14621 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14622 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14623
14624
14625 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14626 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14627 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14628 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14629 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14630 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14631 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14632 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14633 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14634 by a setting such as this:
14635 .code
14636 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14637 .endd
14638 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14639 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14640 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14641 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14642 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14643 options are applied after this global option.
14644
14645 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14646 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14647 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14648 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14649 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14650 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14651 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14652 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14653 value of this option. The default pattern is
14654 .code
14655 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14656 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14657 .endd
14658 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14659 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14660 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14661 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14662 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14663 empty string.
14664
14665 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14666 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14667 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14668
14669 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14670 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14671 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14672 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14673
14674
14675 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14676 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14677 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14678 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14679 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14680 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14681
14682 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14683
14684
14685 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14686 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14687 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14688 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14689 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14690 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14691 domain matches this list.
14692
14693 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14694 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14695 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14696
14697
14698 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14699 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14700 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14701 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14702 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14703 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14704 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14705 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14706 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14707 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14708 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14709 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14710 to set in them.
14711 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14712
14713
14714 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14715 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14716
14717
14718 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14719 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14720 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14721 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14722 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14723 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14724 match with this expanded domain list.
14725
14726 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14727 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14728 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14729 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14730 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14731 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14732
14733 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14734 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14735 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14736
14737 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14738 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14739 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14740 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14741 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14742
14743 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14744 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14745 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14746 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14747 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14748 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14749 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14750 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14751 on.
14752
14753 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14754
14755 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14756 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14757 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14758
14759
14760 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14761 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14762 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14763 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14764
14765 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14766 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14767 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14768 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14769 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14770 and accepted from, these hosts.
14771 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14772 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14773 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14774 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14775 are sent.
14776
14777 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14778 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14779 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14780 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14781 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14782 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14783 .code
14784 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14785 .endd
14786 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14787 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14788
14789 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14790 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14791 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14792 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14793 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14794 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14795 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14796 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14797 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14798
14799
14800 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14801 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14802 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14803 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14804 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14805 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14806 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14807 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14808 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14809
14810 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14811 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14812 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14813 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14814 are examined. For example:
14815 .code
14816 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14817 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14818 postmaster@mydomain.example
14819 .endd
14820 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14821 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14822 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14823 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14824 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14825 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14826 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14827
14828
14829 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14830 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14831 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14832 .display
14833 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14834 .endd
14835 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14836 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14837 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14838 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14839 overrides the default.
14840
14841 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14842 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14843 and warning messages. For example:
14844 .code
14845 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14846 .endd
14847 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14848 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14849 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14850 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14851 not used.
14852
14853
14854 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14855 .cindex events
14856 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14857 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14858
14859
14860 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14861 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14862 .cindex "Exim group"
14863 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14864 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14865 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14866 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14867 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14868 security issues.
14869
14870
14871 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14872 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14873 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14874 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14875 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14876 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14877 other place.
14878 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14879 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14880 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14881 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14882
14883
14884 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14885 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14886 .cindex "Exim user"
14887 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14888 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14889 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14890 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14891
14892 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14893 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14894 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14895 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14896
14897
14898 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14899 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14900 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14901 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14902
14903
14904 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14905 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14906
14907 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14908 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14909 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14910 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14911 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14912 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14913 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14914 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14915 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14916 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14917 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14918 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14919 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14920 addresses.
14921
14922
14923 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14924 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14925 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14926 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14927 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14928 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14929 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14930 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14931 retries.
14932
14933 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14934 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14935 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14936 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14937
14938
14939
14940 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14941 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14942 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14943 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14944 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14945 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14946 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14947 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14948 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14949 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14950 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14951 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14952 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14953 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14954 logging that you require.
14955
14956
14957 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14958 .cindex "HP-UX"
14959 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14960 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14961 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14962 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14963 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14964 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14965 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14966 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14967
14968 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14969 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14970 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14971 user's name.
14972
14973 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14974 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14975 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14976 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14977 .code
14978 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14979 gecos_name = $1
14980 .endd
14981
14982 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14983 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14984
14985
14986 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14987 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14988 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14989 implementations of TLS.
14990
14991
14992 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14993 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14994 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14995
14996 See
14997 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14998 for documentation.
14999
15000
15001
15002 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15003 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15004 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15005 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15006 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15007 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15008
15009
15010
15011 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15012 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15013 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15014 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15015 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15016 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15017 sections are rejected.
15018
15019
15020 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15021 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15022 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15023 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15024 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15025 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15026 zero means &"no limit"&.
15027
15028
15029
15030
15031 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15032 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15033 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15034 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15035 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15036 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15037 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15038 if you want to do semantic checking.
15039 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15040 set.
15041
15042
15043 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15044 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15045 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15046 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15047 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15048 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15049 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15050 .code
15051 helo_allow_chars = _
15052 .endd
15053 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15054
15055
15056 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15057 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15058 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15059 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15060 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15061 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15062 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15063 do.
15064
15065
15066 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15067 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15068 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15069 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15070 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15071 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15072 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15073 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15074 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15075 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15076 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15077 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15078
15079 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15080 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15081 EHLO command either:
15082
15083 .ilist
15084 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15085 .next
15086 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15087 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15088 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15089 calling host address, or
15090 .next
15091 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15092 .endlist
15093
15094 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15095 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15096 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15097
15098 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15099 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15100 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15101
15102 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15103 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15104 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15105 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15106 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15107 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15108 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15109 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15110 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15111 error.
15112
15113 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15114 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15115 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15116 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15117 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15118 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15119 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15120 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15121 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15122
15123 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15124 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15125 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15126 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15127 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15128
15129 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15130 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15131 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15132 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15133
15134
15135 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15136 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15137 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15138 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15139 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15140 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15141 default configuration file contains
15142 .code
15143 host_lookup = *
15144 .endd
15145 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15146 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15147
15148 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15149 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15150 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15151
15152 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15153 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15154 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15155 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15156 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15157 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15158
15159
15160 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15161 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15162 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15163 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15164 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15165 if you want.
15166
15167 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15168 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15169 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15170 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15171
15172
15173
15174 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15175 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15176 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15177 as soon as the connection is made.
15178 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15179 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15180 connections immediately.
15181
15182 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15183 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15184 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15185 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15186 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15187
15188
15189 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15190 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15191 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15192 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15193 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15194 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15195 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15196 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15197 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15198 .code
15199 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15200 .endd
15201 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15202
15203
15204
15205 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15206 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15207 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15208 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15209
15210
15211 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15212 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15213 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15214 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15215 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15216 records
15217 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15218 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15219
15220 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15221 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15222 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15223 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15224 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15225 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15226 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15227
15228
15229 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15230 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15231 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15232 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15233 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15234
15235
15236
15237 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15238 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15239 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15240 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15241 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15242 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15243
15244 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15245 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15246 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15247 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15248 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15249 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15250 for frozen messages. For example,
15251 .code
15252 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15253 .endd
15254 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15255 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15256 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15257 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15258 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15259 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15260
15261
15262 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15263 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15264 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15265 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15266 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15267 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15268 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15269 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15270 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15271 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15272
15273
15274 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15275 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15276
15277 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15278 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15279 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15280 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15281 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15282 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15283 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15284 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15285 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15286
15287 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15288 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15289
15290 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15291 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15292 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15293 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15294
15295 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15296 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15297 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15298 anymore.
15299
15300 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15301 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15302 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15303 details.
15304
15305
15306 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15307 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15308 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15309 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15310 logged.
15311
15312
15313 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15314 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15315 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15316 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15317 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15318 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15319 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15320 and constrained to be a directory.
15321
15322
15323 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15324 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15325 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15326 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15327 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15328 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15329 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15330 and constrained to be a file.
15331
15332
15333 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15334 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15335 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15336 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15337 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15338 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15339
15340
15341 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15342 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15343 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15344 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15345 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15346 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15347 identity to be proven.
15348
15349
15350 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15351 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15352 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15353 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15354 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15355
15356
15357 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15358 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15359 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15360 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15361 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15362 with LDAP support.
15363
15364
15365 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15366 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15367 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15368 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15369 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15370 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15371 to hard/demand.
15372
15373
15374 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15375 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15376 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15377 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15378 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15379 of SSL-on-connect.
15380 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15381 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15382 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15383
15384
15385 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15386 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15387 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15388 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15389 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15390 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15391 has been built with LDAP support.
15392
15393
15394
15395 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15396 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15397 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15398 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15399 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15400 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15401 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15402
15403 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15404 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15405 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15406
15407 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15408 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15409 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15410 and the default qualify domain.
15411
15412 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15413 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15414 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15415 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15416
15417 .cindex "envelope sender"
15418 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15419 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15420 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15421
15422 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15423 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15424 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15425
15426
15427
15428
15429 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15430 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15431 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15432 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15433 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15434 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15435 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15436 example, if
15437 .code
15438 local_from_prefix = *-
15439 .endd
15440 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15441 .code
15442 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15443 .endd
15444 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15445 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15446 qualify domain.
15447
15448
15449 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15450 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15451
15452
15453 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15454 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15455 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15456 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15457 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15458 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15459 &%local_interfaces%& is
15460 .code
15461 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15462 .endd
15463 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15464 .code
15465 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15466 .endd
15467
15468 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15469 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15470 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15471 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15472 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15473 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15474 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15475 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15476
15477
15478
15479 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15480 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15481 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15482 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15483 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15484 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15485 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15486 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15487
15488
15489
15490
15491 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15492 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15493 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15494 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15495 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15496 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15497 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15498 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15499 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15500 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15501 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15502 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15503 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15504 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15505 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15506
15507
15508
15509 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15510 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15511 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15512 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15513 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15514 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15515 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15516 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15517 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15518 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15519 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15520 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15521 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15522 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15523 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15524
15525
15526 .option log_selector main string unset
15527 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15528 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15529 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15530 minus characters. For example:
15531 .code
15532 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15533 .endd
15534 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15535 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15536
15537
15538 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15539 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15540 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15541 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15542 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15543 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15544 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15545 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15546 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15547 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15548 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15549 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15550 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15551
15552
15553 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15554 .cindex "too many open files"
15555 .cindex "open files, too many"
15556 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15557 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15558 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15559 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15560 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15561 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15562 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15563 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15564 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15565 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15566 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15567 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15568
15569
15570 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15571 .cindex "length of login name"
15572 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15573 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15574 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15575 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15576 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15577 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15578
15579
15580 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15581 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15582 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15583 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15584 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15585 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15586 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15587 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15588
15589
15590 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15591 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15592 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15593 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15594 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15595 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15596 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15597
15598
15599 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15600 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15601 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15602 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15603 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15604 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15605 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15606 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15607 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15608 empty string, the option is ignored.
15609
15610
15611 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15612 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15613 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15614 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15615 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15616 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15617 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15618 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15619 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15620 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15621 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15622 colons will become hyphens.
15623
15624
15625 .option message_logs main boolean true
15626 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15627 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15628 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15629 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15630 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15631 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15632 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15633 which is not affected by this option.
15634
15635
15636 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15637 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15638 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15639 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15640 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15641 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15642 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15643 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15644 optionally followed by K or M.
15645
15646 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15647 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15648 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15649 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15650 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15651
15652 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15653 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15654 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15655 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15656 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15657 message that an individual transport can process.
15658
15659 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15660 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15661 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15662 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15663 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15664 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15665 some problems may result.
15666
15667 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15668 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15669 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15670
15671
15672 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15673 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15674 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15675 .code
15676 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15677 .endd
15678 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15679 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15680 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15681 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15682 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15683
15684
15685 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15686 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15687 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15688 contains a full description of this facility.
15689
15690
15691
15692 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15693 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15694 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15695 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15696 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15697
15698
15699 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15700 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15701 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15702 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15703 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15704 safety precaution.
15705
15706 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15707 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15708 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15709 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15710 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15711
15712 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15713 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15714 example is
15715 .code
15716 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15717 .endd
15718 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15719 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15720 transport driver.
15721
15722
15723 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15724 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15725 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15726 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15727 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15728
15729 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15730 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15731 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15732 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15733 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15734 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15735 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15736
15737 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15738 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15739 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15740 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15741 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15742
15743 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15744
15745 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15746 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15747 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15748 some now infamous attacks.
15749
15750 Examples:
15751 .code
15752 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15753 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15754 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15755
15756 # Disable older protocol versions:
15757 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15758 .endd
15759
15760 Possible options may include:
15761 .ilist
15762 &`all`&
15763 .next
15764 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15765 .next
15766 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15767 .next
15768 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15769 .next
15770 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15771 .next
15772 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15773 .next
15774 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15775 .next
15776 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15777 .next
15778 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15779 .next
15780 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15781 .next
15782 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15783 .next
15784 &`no_compression`&
15785 .next
15786 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15787 .next
15788 &`no_sslv2`&
15789 .next
15790 &`no_sslv3`&
15791 .next
15792 &`no_ticket`&
15793 .next
15794 &`no_tlsv1`&
15795 .next
15796 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15797 .next
15798 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15799 .next
15800 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15801 .next
15802 &`single_dh_use`&
15803 .next
15804 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15805 .next
15806 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15807 .next
15808 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15809 .next
15810 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15811 .next
15812 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15813 .next
15814 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15815 .endlist
15816
15817 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15818 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15819 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15820 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15821 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15822 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15823
15824
15825 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15826 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15827 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15828 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15829 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15830
15831
15832 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15833 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15834 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15835 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15836 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15837 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15838 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15839 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15840 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15841 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15842 an ACL.
15843
15844 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15845 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15846 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15847 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15848 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15849 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15850 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15851
15852
15853 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15854 .cindex "Perl"
15855 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15856 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15857
15858
15859 .option perl_startup main string unset
15860 .cindex "Perl"
15861 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15862 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15863
15864 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15865 .cindex "Perl"
15866 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15867
15868
15869 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15870 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15871 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15872 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15873 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15874 PostgreSQL support.
15875
15876
15877 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15878 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15879 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15880 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15881 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15882 to the host name:
15883 .code
15884 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15885 .endd
15886 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15887 spool directory.
15888 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15889 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15890 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15891
15892
15893 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15894 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15895 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15896 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15897 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15898 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15899 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15900 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15901 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15902
15903
15904 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15905 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15906 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15907 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15908 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15909 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15910 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15911 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15912
15913 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15914 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15915 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15916 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15917 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15918 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15919 volume of mail. Use with care!
15920
15921
15922 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15923 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15924 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15925 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15926 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15927 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15928 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15929 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15930 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15931 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15932
15933 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15934 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15935 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15936 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15937 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15938 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15939
15940
15941 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15942 .cindex "printing characters"
15943 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15944 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15945 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15946 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15947 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15948 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15949 characters.
15950
15951 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15952 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15953 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15954 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15955 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15956 standards.
15957
15958
15959 .option process_log_path main string unset
15960 .cindex "process log path"
15961 .cindex "log" "process log"
15962 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15963 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15964 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15965 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15966 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15967 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15968 different spool directories.
15969
15970
15971 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15972 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15973 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15974 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15975 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15976 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15977 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15978 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
15979
15980
15981 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15982 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15983 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15984 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15985 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15986 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15987 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15988 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15989 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15990
15991 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15992 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15993 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15994 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15995 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15996 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15997 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15998
15999
16000 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16001 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16002 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16003
16004
16005
16006 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16007 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16008 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16009 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16010 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16011 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16012 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16013 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16014
16015
16016 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16017 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16018 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16019 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16020 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16021 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16022 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16023
16024
16025 .option queue_only main boolean false
16026 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16027 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16028 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16029 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16030 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16031 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16032
16033 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16034 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16035 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16036 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16037
16038
16039 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16040 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16041 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16042 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16043 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16044 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16045 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16046 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16047 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16048 .code
16049 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16050 .endd
16051 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16052 &_/some/file_& exists.
16053
16054
16055 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16056 .cindex "load average"
16057 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16058 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16059 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16060 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16061 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16062 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16063 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16064 false.
16065
16066 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16067 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16068 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16069 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16070
16071
16072 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16073 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16074 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16075 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16076 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16077 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16078 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16079 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16080 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16081 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16082 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16083 re-evaluated for each message.
16084
16085
16086 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16087 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16088 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16089 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16090 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16091 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16092
16093
16094 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16095 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16096 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16097 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16098 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16099 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16100 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16101 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16102 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16103 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16104 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16105 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16106 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16107
16108
16109
16110 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16111 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16112 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16113 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16114 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16115 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16116 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16117 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16118 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16119
16120 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16121 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16122 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16123 the daemon's command line.
16124
16125 .cindex queues named
16126 .cindex "named queues"
16127 To set limits for different named queues use
16128 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16129
16130 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16131 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16132 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16133 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16134 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16135 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16136 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16137 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16138 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16139 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16140 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16141 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16142 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16143 &%queue_domains%&.
16144
16145
16146 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16147 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16148 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16149 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16150 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16151 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16152 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16153
16154 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16155 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16156 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16157 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16158 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16159 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16160 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16161 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16162 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16163 header lines. The default setting is:
16164
16165 .code
16166 received_header_text = Received: \
16167 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16168 {${if def:sender_ident \
16169 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16170 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16171 by $primary_hostname \
16172 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16173 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16174 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16175 ${if def:sender_address \
16176 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16177 id $message_exim_id\
16178 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16179 .endd
16180
16181 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16182 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16183 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16184 header lines such as the following:
16185 .code
16186 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16187 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16188 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16189 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16190 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16191 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16192 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16193 .endd
16194 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16195 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16196 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16197 message was accepted.
16198
16199
16200 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16201 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16202 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16203 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16204 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16205 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16206 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16207 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16208
16209
16210 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16211 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16212 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16213 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16214 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16215 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16216 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16217 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16218 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16219 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16220 option was not set.
16221
16222
16223 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16224 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16225 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16226 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16227 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16228 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16229 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16230 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16231 done.
16232
16233 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16234 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16235 RCPT commands in a single message.
16236
16237
16238 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16239 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16240 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16241 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16242 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16243 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16244 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16245
16246
16247 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16248 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16249 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16250 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16251 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16252 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16253 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16254 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16255 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16256 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16257 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16258 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16259 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16260 tagged with its process id.
16261
16262 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16263 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16264 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16265 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16266 is received.
16267
16268 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16269 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16270 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16271 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16272 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16273 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16274 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16275 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16276 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16277 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16278 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16279
16280 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16281 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16282 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16283 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16284
16285
16286 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16287 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16288 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16289 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16290 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16291 .code
16292 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16293 .endd
16294 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16295 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16296
16297
16298 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16299 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16300 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16301 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16302 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16303 past failures.
16304
16305
16306 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16307 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16308 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16309 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16310 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16311 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16312 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16313 the default value.
16314
16315
16316 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16317 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16318 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16319 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16320 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16321 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16322 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16323 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16324 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16325 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16326
16327
16328 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16329 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16330
16331
16332 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16333 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16334 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16335 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16336 an item in the list.
16337 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16338 for the system.
16339
16340 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16341 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16342 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16343 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16344 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16345
16346
16347 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16348 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16349 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16350 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16351 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16352 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16353 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16354 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16355 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16356 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16357
16358 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16359 .cindex "environment"
16360 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16361 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16362 default list is empty,
16363
16364
16365 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16366 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16367 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16368 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16369 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16370 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16371 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16372
16373
16374
16375 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16376 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16377 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16378 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16379 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16380 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16381 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16382 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16383 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16384 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16385 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16386
16387
16388
16389 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16390 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16391 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16392 .cindex "inetd"
16393 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16394 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16395 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16396 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16397 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16398 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16399
16400 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16401 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16402 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16403 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16404
16405
16406 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16407 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16408 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16409 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16410 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16411 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16412 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16413 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16414
16415 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16416 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16417 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16418 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16419 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16420 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16421 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16422 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16423
16424
16425 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16426 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16427 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16428 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16429 live with.
16430
16431
16432 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16433 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16434 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16435 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16436 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16437 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16438 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16439 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16440 . the option name to split.
16441
16442 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16443 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16444 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16445 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16446 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16447 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16448 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16449 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16450 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16451 seen).
16452
16453
16454 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16455 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16456 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16457 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16458 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16459 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16460 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16461 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16462 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16463 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16464 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16465
16466 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16467 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16468 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16469 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16470 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16471 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16472
16473
16474
16475 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16476 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16477 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16478 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16479 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16480 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16481 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16482 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16483 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16484 to all messages received in the same connection.
16485
16486 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16487 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16488 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16489 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16490
16491
16492 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16493
16494 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16495 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16496 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16497 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16498 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16499 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16500 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16501 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16502 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16503 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16504 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16505 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16506 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16507
16508
16509 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16510 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16511 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16512 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16513 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16514 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16515 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16516 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16517 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16518 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16519 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16520 individual host.
16521
16522 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16523 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16524 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16525 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16526
16527
16528 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16529 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16530 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16531 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16532 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16533 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16534 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16535 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16536 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16537
16538 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16539 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16540 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16541 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16542
16543 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16544 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16545 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16546 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16547 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16548 For example:
16549 .code
16550 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16551 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16552 .endd
16553
16554 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16555 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16556 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16557 &%helo_data%& value.
16558
16559 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16560 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16561 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16562 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16563 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16564 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16565 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16566 .code
16567 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16568 $version_number $tod_full
16569 .endd
16570 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16571 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16572 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16573 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16574 multiline response).
16575
16576
16577 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16578 .cindex "checking disk space"
16579 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16580 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16581 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16582 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16583 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16584 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16585 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16586
16587
16588 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16589 .cindex "connection backlog"
16590 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16591 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16592 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16593 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16594 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16595 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16596 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16597 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16598 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16599 attacks by SYN flooding.
16600
16601
16602 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16603 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16604 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16605 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16606 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16607 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16608 fewer, but they still exist.
16609
16610 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16611 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16612 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16613 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16614 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16615 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16616 does detect many instances.
16617
16618 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16619 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16620 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16621 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16622
16623
16624
16625 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16626 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16627 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16628 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16629 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16630 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16631 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16632 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16633 example:
16634 .code
16635 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16636 $sender_host_address
16637 .endd
16638 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16639 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16640 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16641 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16642 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16643 the command.
16644
16645
16646 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16647 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16648 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16649 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16650 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16651
16652
16653 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16654 .cindex "load average"
16655 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16656 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16657 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16658 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16659 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16660 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16661
16662
16663
16664 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16665 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16666 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16667 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16668 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16669 .code
16670 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16671 .endd
16672 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16673 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16674 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16675 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16676 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16677
16678 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16679 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16680 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16681 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16682 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16683 not count towards the limit.
16684
16685
16686
16687 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16688 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16689 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16690 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16691 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16692 that subvert web
16693 clients
16694 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16695 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16696
16697
16698
16699 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16700 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16701 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16702 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16703 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16704 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16705 recipients.
16706
16707 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16708 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16709 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16710 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16711
16712 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16713 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16714 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16715 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16716 values:
16717
16718 .ilist
16719 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16720 .next
16721 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16722 fractional parts are allowed here.
16723 .next
16724 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16725 .next
16726 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16727 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16728 .endlist
16729
16730 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16731 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16732 .code
16733 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16734 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16735 .endd
16736 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16737 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16738 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16739 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16740
16741
16742 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16743 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16744
16745
16746 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16747 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16748
16749
16750 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16751 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16752 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16753 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16754 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16755 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16756 the message is abandoned.
16757 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16758 .code
16759 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16760 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16761 .endd
16762 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16763 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16764
16765 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16766 expanded before use and may depend on
16767 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16768
16769
16770 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16771 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16772 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16773 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16774 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16775 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16776
16777
16778 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16779 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16780 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16781
16782
16783 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16784 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16785 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16786 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16787 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16788 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16789 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16790 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16791 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16792 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16793 .code
16794 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16795 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16796 .endd
16797
16798
16799 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16800 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16801 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16802 the availability thereof is advertised in
16803 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16804 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16805
16806
16807 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16808 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16809 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16810 The default value is
16811 .code
16812 127.0.0.1 783
16813 .endd
16814 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16815
16816
16817
16818 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16819 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16820 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16821 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16822 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16823 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16824 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16825 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16826 arrival of the message.
16827
16828 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16829 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16830 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16831 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16832 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16833
16834 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16835 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16836 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16837 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16838 automatically deleted.
16839
16840 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16841 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16842 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16843 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16844 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16845 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16846 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16847 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16848 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16849
16850
16851 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16852 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16853 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16854 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16855 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16856 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16857 &$primary_hostname$&.
16858
16859 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16860 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16861 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16862 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16863 as failures in the configuration file.
16864
16865 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16866 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16867
16868 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16869 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16870 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16871 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16872 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16873 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16874 option.
16875
16876 The following variables will not have useful values:
16877 .code
16878 $max_received_linelength
16879 $body_linecount
16880 $body_zerocount
16881 .endd
16882
16883 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16884 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16885 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16886 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16887
16888 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16889 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is contructed for them).
16890 The transimssion benefit is maintained.
16891
16892 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16893 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16894 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16895 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16896
16897 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16898 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16899 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16900 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16901 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16902 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16903
16904 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16905 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16906 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16907 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16908 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16909 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16910 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16911
16912
16913 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16914 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16915 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16916 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16917 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16918 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16919 domain causes a syntax error.
16920 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16921 syntax checking.
16922
16923
16924 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16925 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16926 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16927 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16928 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16929 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16930 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16931 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16932 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16933 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16934 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16935 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16936
16937
16938 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16939 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16940 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16941 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16942 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16943 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16944 details of Exim's logging.
16945
16946
16947 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
16948 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
16949 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
16950 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
16951 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
16952 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
16953 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16954
16955
16956
16957 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16958 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16959 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16960 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16961 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16962
16963
16964
16965 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16966 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16967 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16968 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16969 details of Exim's logging.
16970
16971
16972 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16973 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16974 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16975 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16976 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16977 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16978 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16979 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16980 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16981 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16982 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16983 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
16984
16985
16986 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16987 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16988 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16989 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16990 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16991 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16992
16993
16994 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16995 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16996 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16997 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16998 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16999
17000 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17001 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17002 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17003 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17004 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17005
17006 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17007 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17008 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17009 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17010 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17011 contains the pipe command.
17012
17013
17014 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17015 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17016 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17017 is used in a system filter.
17018
17019
17020 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17021 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17022 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17023 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17024 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17025 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17026 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17027 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17028 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17029 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17030
17031 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17032 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17033 transport option overrides.
17034
17035
17036 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17037 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17038 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17039 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17040 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17041 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17042 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17043 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17044 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17045 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17046 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17047 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17048 TCP_NODELAY.
17049
17050
17051 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17052 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17053 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17054 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17055 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17056 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17057 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17058 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17059 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17060 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17061
17062 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17063 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17064 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17065
17066
17067 .option timezone main string unset
17068 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17069 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17070 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17071 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17072 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17073 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17074 .code
17075 timezone = UTC
17076 .endd
17077 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17078 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17079 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17080 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17081 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17082 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17083
17084
17085 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17086 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17087 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17088 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17089 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17090 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17091 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17092 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17093 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17094 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17095 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17096
17097
17098 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17099 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17100 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17101 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17102 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17103 needed.
17104 The server's private key is also
17105 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17106 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17107
17108 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17109 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17110 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17111 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17112
17113 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17114 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17115
17116 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17117 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& veriable is unreliable.
17118
17119 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable when a list of more than one file is used.
17120
17121 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17122 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17123 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17124 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17125
17126 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17127 generated for every connection.
17128
17129 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17130 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17131 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17132 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17133 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
17134
17135 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17136
17137
17138 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17139 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17140 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17141 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17142 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17143 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17144
17145 The value must be at least 1024.
17146
17147 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17148 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17149 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17150
17151 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17152 number.
17153
17154 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17155 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17156 larger prime than requested.
17157
17158
17159 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17160 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17161 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17162 to be used by Exim.
17163
17164 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17165 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17166 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17167 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17168
17169 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17170 then it names a file from which DH
17171 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17172 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17173 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17174 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17175 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17176 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17177
17178 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17179 loaded by Exim.
17180
17181 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17182 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17183 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17184 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17185
17186 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17187 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17188
17189 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17190 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17191 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17192
17193 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17194 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17195 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17196 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17197 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17198
17199 The available standard primes are:
17200 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17201 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17202 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17203 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17204
17205 The available additional primes are:
17206 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17207
17208 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17209 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17210 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17211 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17212 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17213
17214 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17215 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17216 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17217
17218 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17219 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17220 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17221 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17222 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17223 userbase.
17224
17225 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17226 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17227 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17228 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17229 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17230 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17231 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17232
17233
17234 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17235 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17236 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17237 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17238
17239 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17240 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17241 for valid selections.
17242
17243 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17244 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17245 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17246
17247 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17248
17249
17250 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17251 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17252 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17253 This option
17254 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17255 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17256 Certificate Authority.
17257
17258 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17259
17260 &*Note*&: There is currently no support for multiple OCSP proofs to match the
17261 multiple certificates facility.
17262
17263
17264 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17265 .cindex SSMTP
17266 .cindex SMTPS
17267 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17268 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17269 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17270 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17271
17272
17273
17274 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17275 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17276 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17277 files which contains the server's private keys.
17278 If this option is unset, or if
17279 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17280 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17281 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17282
17283 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17284
17285
17286 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17287 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17288 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17289 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17290 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17291 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17292 TLS session.
17293
17294
17295 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17296 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17297 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17298 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17299 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17300 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17301 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17302 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17303 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17304 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17305 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17306
17307
17308 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17309 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17310 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17311 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17312
17313
17314 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17315 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17316 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17317 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17318 word "system"
17319 or the absolute path to
17320 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17321 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17322
17323 The "system" value for the option will use a
17324 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17325 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17326 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17327 must be specified.
17328
17329 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17330 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17331
17332 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17333 explicitly
17334 either by file or directory
17335 are added to those given by the system default location.
17336
17337 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17338 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17339 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17340 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17341 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17342 use the explicit directory version.
17343
17344 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17345
17346 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17347 being unset.
17348
17349
17350 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17351 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17352 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17353 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17354 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17355 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17356 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17357 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17358
17359 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17360 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17361 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17362 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17363 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17364 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17365 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17366
17367 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17368 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17369 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17370 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17371 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17372 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17373 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17374 certificate"&.
17375
17376 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17377 certificates.
17378
17379
17380 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17381 .cindex "trusted groups"
17382 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17383 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17384 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17385 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17386 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17387 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17388 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17389 are trusted.
17390
17391 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17392 .cindex "trusted users"
17393 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17394 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17395 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17396 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17397 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17398 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17399 Exim user are trusted.
17400
17401 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17402 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17403 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17404 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17405 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17406 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17407 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17408 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17409 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17410 &%-F%& option.
17411
17412 .option unknown_username main string unset
17413 See &%unknown_login%&.
17414
17415 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17416 .cindex "trusted users"
17417 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17418 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17419 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17420 .cindex "envelope sender"
17421 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17422 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17423 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17424 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17425 is used) is ignored.
17426
17427 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17428 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17429 .code
17430 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17431 .endd
17432 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17433 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17434 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17435 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17436 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17437 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17438 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17439 followed by a hyphen
17440 by a setting like this:
17441 .code
17442 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17443 .endd
17444 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17445 restriction, you can use
17446 .code
17447 untrusted_set_sender = *
17448 .endd
17449 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17450 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17451 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17452 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17453 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17454 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17455 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17456 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17457
17458 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17459 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17460 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17461 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17462 sender address.
17463
17464
17465 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17466 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17467 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17468 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17469 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17470 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17471 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17472 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17473 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17474 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17475 .code
17476 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17477 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17478 .endd
17479 The pattern can be seen by running
17480 .code
17481 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17482 .endd
17483 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17484 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17485 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17486 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17487 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17488 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17489
17490
17491 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17492 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17493
17494
17495 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17496 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17497 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17498 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17499 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17500 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17501 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17502 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17503
17504
17505 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17506 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17507 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17508 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17509 .ecindex IIDconfima
17510 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17511
17512
17513
17514
17515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17517
17518 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17519 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17520 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17521 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17522 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17523
17524 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17525 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17526 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17527 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17528 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17529
17530
17531
17532 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17533 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17534 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17535 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17536 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17537 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17538 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17539
17540 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17541 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17542 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17543 routers, and the eventual transport.
17544
17545 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17546 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17547 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17548 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17549 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17550
17551 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17552 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17553 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17554 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17555 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17556
17557 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17558 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17559 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17560 .code
17561 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17562 .endd
17563 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17564 .code
17565 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17566 .endd
17567 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17568 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17569
17570 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17571 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17572 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17573 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17574 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17575 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17576 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17577
17578
17579
17580 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17581 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17582 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17583 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17584 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17585 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17586 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17587 routing.
17588
17589
17590
17591 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17592 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17593 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17594 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17595 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17596 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17597 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17598 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17599 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17600 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17601 you could put:
17602 .code
17603 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17604 .endd
17605 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17606 and
17607 .code
17608 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17609 .endd
17610 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17611 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17612 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17613 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17614
17615
17616 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17617 .cindex "case of local parts"
17618 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17619 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17620 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17621 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17622 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17623 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17624 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17625 more details.
17626
17627 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17628 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17629 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17630 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17631 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17632 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17633 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17634 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17635 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17636
17637 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17638 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17639 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17640 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17641
17642
17643
17644 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17645 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17646 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17647 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17648 .vindex "&$home$&"
17649 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17650 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17651 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17652 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17653 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17654 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17655 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17656 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17657 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17658 the router is skipped.
17659
17660 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17661 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17662 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17663 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17664 setting to achieve this. For example:
17665 .code
17666 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17667 .endd
17668 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17669 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17670 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17671
17672
17673
17674 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17675 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17676 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17677 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17678 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17679 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17680 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17681 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17682
17683 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17684 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17685
17686 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17687 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17688
17689 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17690 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17691 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17692 .code
17693 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17694 .endd
17695 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17696 .code
17697 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17698 .endd
17699
17700 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17701 .code
17702 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17703 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17704 condition = foobar
17705 .endd
17706
17707 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17708 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17709 be specified using &%condition%&.
17710
17711 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17712 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17713 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17714 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17715 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17716 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17717 Router rules processing behavior.
17718
17719 This is best illustrated in an example:
17720 .code
17721 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17722 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17723
17724 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17725 true {yes} {no}}
17726
17727 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17728 {yes} {no}}
17729 .endd
17730 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17731 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17732 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17733 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17734 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17735 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17736 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17737 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17738
17739 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17740 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17741 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17742 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17743 string characters.
17744
17745 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17746 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17747 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17748 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17749 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17750
17751
17752 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17753 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17754 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17755 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17756 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17757 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17758 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17759 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17760 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17761 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17762 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17763 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17764 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17765 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17766
17767
17768
17769 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17770 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17771 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17772 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17773 transport option of the same name.
17774
17775 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17776 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17777 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17778 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17779 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17780 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17781 the dnssec request bit set.
17782 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17783
17784 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17785 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17786 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17787 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17788 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17789 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17790 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17791 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17792 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17793
17794
17795 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17796 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17797 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17798 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17799 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17800 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17801 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17802 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17803
17804
17805
17806 .option driver routers string unset
17807 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17808 to be used.
17809
17810
17811 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17812 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17813 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17814 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17815 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17816 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17817 Not effective on redirect routers.
17818
17819
17820
17821 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17822 .cindex "envelope sender"
17823 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17824 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17825 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17826 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17827 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17828 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17829 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17830
17831 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17832 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17833 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17834 setting.
17835
17836 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17837 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17838 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17839 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17840
17841 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17842 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17843 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17844 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17845 settings:
17846 .code
17847 errors_to =
17848 errors_to = ""
17849 .endd
17850 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17851 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17852 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17853 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17854 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17855
17856 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17857 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17858 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17859 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17860 setting &%return_path%&.
17861
17862 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17863 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17864 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17865
17866
17867
17868 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17869 .cindex "address" "testing"
17870 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17871 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17872 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17873 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17874 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17875 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17876 on for the system alias file.
17877 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17878 are evaluated.
17879
17880 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17881 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17882 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17883
17884
17885
17886 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17887 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17888 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17889 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17890
17891
17892
17893 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17894 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17895 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17896
17897
17898
17899 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17900 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17901 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17902
17903
17904
17905 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17906 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17907 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17908 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17909 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17910 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17911 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17912 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17913 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17914
17915 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17916 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17917 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17918 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17919 transport for further details.
17920
17921
17922 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17923 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17924 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17925 .cindex "transport" "local"
17926 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17927 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17928 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17929 process.
17930 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17931 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17932 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17933 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17934 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17935
17936
17937
17938 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17939 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17940 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17941 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17942 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17943 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17944 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17945 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17946 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17947 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17948 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17949 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17950 &"see"& the added header lines.
17951
17952 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17953 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17954 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17955 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17956
17957 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17958 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17959
17960 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17961 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17962
17963 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17964 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17965 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17966 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17967 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17968 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17969 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17970 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17971 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17972 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17973
17974
17975
17976 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17977 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17978 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17979 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17980 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17981 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17982 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17983 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17984 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17985 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17986 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17987 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17988 &"see"& the original header lines.
17989
17990 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17991 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17992 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17993 errors.
17994
17995 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17996 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17997
17998 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17999 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18000
18001 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18002 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18003 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18004 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18005
18006 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18007 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18008 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18009
18010
18011
18012 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18013 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18014 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18015 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18016 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18017 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18018 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18019 like
18020 .code
18021 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18022 .endd
18023 by setting
18024 .code
18025 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18026 .endd
18027 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18028 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18029 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18030 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18031 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18032 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18033
18034 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18035 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18036 .code
18037 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18038 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18039 .endd
18040 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18041 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18042
18043 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18044 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18045 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18046 domain that is being routed.
18047
18048 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18049 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18050 checked.
18051
18052 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18053 .cindex "additional groups"
18054 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18055 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18056 .cindex "transport" "local"
18057 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18058 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18059 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18060 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18061 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18062
18063
18064
18065 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18066 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18067 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18068 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18069 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18070 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18071 evaluated.
18072
18073 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18074 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18075 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18076 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18077 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18078 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18079 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18080 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18081 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18082
18083 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18084 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18085 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18086 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18087 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18088 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18089 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18090 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18091 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18092 the relevant transport.
18093
18094 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18095 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18096 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18097 callout.
18098
18099 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18100 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18101 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18102 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18103 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18104 .code
18105 real_localuser:
18106 driver = accept
18107 local_part_prefix = real-
18108 check_local_user
18109 transport = local_delivery
18110 .endd
18111 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18112 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18113 .code
18114 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18115 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18116 .endd
18117
18118 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18119 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18120 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18121 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18122
18123
18124 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18125 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18126
18127
18128
18129 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18130 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18131 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18132 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18133 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18134 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18135 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18136 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18137 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18138 &%username-foo%&.
18139
18140
18141 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18142 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18143
18144
18145
18146 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18147 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18148 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18149 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18150 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18151 are evaluated, and
18152 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18153 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18154 example:
18155 .code
18156 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18157 .endd
18158 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18159 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18160 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18161 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18162 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18163 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18164 each virtual domain:
18165 .code
18166 postmaster:
18167 driver = redirect
18168 local_parts = postmaster
18169 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18170 .endd
18171
18172
18173 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18174 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18175 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18176 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18177 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18178 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18179 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18180 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18181 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18182 redirect addresses.
18183
18184
18185
18186 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18187 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18188 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18189 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18190 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18191 delivery to be deferred.
18192
18193 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18194 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18195 .oindex "&%self%&"
18196 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18197 means of the setting
18198 .code
18199 self = pass
18200 .endd
18201 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18202 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18203 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18204
18205 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18206 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18207 controls what happens next.
18208
18209
18210 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18211 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18212 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18213 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18214 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18215 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18216 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18217 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18218
18219 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18220 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18221 applies to all of them.
18222
18223
18224
18225 .option pass_router routers string unset
18226 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18227 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18228 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18229 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18230 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18231 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18232 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18233 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18234 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18235 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18236
18237
18238
18239 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18240 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18241 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18242 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18243 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18244 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18245
18246 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18247 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18248 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18249 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18250
18251
18252
18253 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18254 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18255 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18256 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18257 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18258 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18259 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18260
18261 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18262 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18263 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18264 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18265
18266 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18267 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18268 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18269 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18270 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18271
18272 .cindex "NFS"
18273 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18274 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18275 unavailable.
18276
18277 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18278 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18279 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18280 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18281 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18282 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18283 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18284 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18285
18286 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18287 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18288 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18289 operates as follows:
18290
18291 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18292 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18293 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18294 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18295 used. For example:
18296 .code
18297 require_files = mail:/some/file
18298 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18299 .endd
18300 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18301 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18302
18303 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18304 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18305 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18306 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18307
18308 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18309 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18310 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18311 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18312 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18313
18314 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18315 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18316 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18317 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18318 check again in that process.
18319
18320 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18321 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18322 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18323 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18324 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18325 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18326 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18327 .code
18328 require_files = +/some/file
18329 .endd
18330 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18331 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18332 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18333
18334
18335
18336 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18337 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18338 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18339 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18340 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18341 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18342 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18343 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18344 latter kind.
18345
18346 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18347 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18348 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18349 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18350 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18351 same name.
18352
18353 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18354 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18355 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18356
18357
18358
18359 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18360 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18361 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18362 .vindex "&$home$&"
18363 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18364 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18365 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18366 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18367 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18368 cause the router to defer.
18369
18370 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18371 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18372 place.
18373 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18374 are evaluated.)
18375 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18376 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18377
18378 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18379 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18380 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18381 of these values that is set:
18382
18383 .ilist
18384 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18385 .next
18386 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18387 .next
18388 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18389 .next
18390 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18391 .endlist
18392
18393 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18394 router, but not for the transport.
18395
18396
18397
18398 .option self routers string freeze
18399 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18400 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18401 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18402 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18403 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18404 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18405 of remote hosts.
18406 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18407 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18408 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18409 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18410 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18411
18412 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18413 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18414 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18415 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18416 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18417 cases:
18418
18419 .vlist
18420 .vitem &%defer%&
18421 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18422
18423 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18424 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18425 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18426 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18427
18428 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18429 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18430 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18431 rewritten.
18432
18433 .vitem &%pass%&
18434 .oindex "&%more%&"
18435 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18436 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18437 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18438 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18439 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18440 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18441 combination
18442 .code
18443 self = pass
18444 no_more
18445 .endd
18446 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18447 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18448 be passed to the next router.
18449
18450 .vitem &%fail%&
18451 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18452
18453 .vitem &%send%&
18454 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18455 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18456 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18457 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18458 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18459 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18460 .endlist
18461
18462
18463
18464 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18465 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18466 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18467 address matches something on the list.
18468 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18469 are evaluated.
18470
18471 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18472 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18473 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18474 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18475 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18476 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18477 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18478 matters.
18479
18480
18481 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18482 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18483 .cindex "packet radio"
18484 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18485 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18486 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18487 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18488 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18489 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18490 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18491 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18492
18493 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18494 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18495 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18496 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18497 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18498 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18499 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18500 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18501 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18502 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18503 .code
18504 translate_ip_address = \
18505 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18506 {$value}fail}}
18507 .endd
18508 The file would contain lines like
18509 .code
18510 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18511 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18512 .endd
18513 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18514 are doing.
18515
18516
18517
18518 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18519 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18520 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18521 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18522 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18523 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18524 delivery is deferred.
18525
18526 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18527 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18528 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18529
18530
18531
18532 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18533 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18534 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18535 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18536 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18537 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18538 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18539 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18540 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18541 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18542 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18543 environment.
18544
18545
18546
18547
18548 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18549 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18550 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18551 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18552 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18553 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18554 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18555 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18556 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18557 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18558
18559 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18560 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18561 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18562 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18563 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18564
18565 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18566 environment.
18567
18568
18569
18570
18571 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18572 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18573 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18574 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18575 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18576 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18577 delivery to be deferred.
18578
18579 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18580 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18581 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18582 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18583 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18584 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18585
18586 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18587 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18588 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18589 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18590 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18591 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18592 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18593 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18594
18595 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18596 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18597 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18598 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18599 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18600 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18601 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18602 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18603 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18604 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18605
18606 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18607 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18608 subsequent routers.
18609
18610
18611 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18612 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18613 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18614 .cindex "transport" "local"
18615 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18616 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18617 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18618 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18619 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18620 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18621 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18622 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18623 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18624 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18625 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18626 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18627
18628
18629
18630 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18631 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18632 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18633
18634
18635 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18636 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18637 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18638 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18639 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18640 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18641 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18642 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18643 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18644 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18645
18646 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18647 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18648 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18649 user or group.
18650
18651
18652 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18653 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18654 addresses,
18655 delivering in cutthrough mode
18656 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18657 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18658 are evaluated.
18659 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18660
18661
18662 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18663 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18664 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18665 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18666 are evaluated.
18667 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18668 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18669 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18670
18671
18672
18673
18674
18675
18676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18678
18679 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18680 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18681 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18682 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18683 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18684 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18685 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18686 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18687 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18688 .code
18689 localusers:
18690 driver = accept
18691 domains = mydomain.example
18692 check_local_user
18693 transport = local_delivery
18694 .endd
18695 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18696 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18697 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18698 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18699
18700
18701
18702
18703
18704
18705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18707
18708 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18709 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18710 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18711 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18712 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18713 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18714
18715 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18716 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18717 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18718 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18719 records.
18720
18721 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18722 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18723 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18724 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18725 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18726 generic option, the router declines.
18727
18728 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18729 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18730 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18731
18732 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18733 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18734 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18735 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18736 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18737 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18738
18739
18740 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18741 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18742 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18743 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18744 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18745 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18746
18747 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18748 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18749 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18750 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18751 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18752 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18753 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18754 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18755 case routing fails.
18756
18757
18758 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18759 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18760 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18761 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18762 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18763
18764 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18765 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18766
18767 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18768 .ilist
18769 The domain does not exist in DNS
18770 .next
18771 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18772 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18773 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18774 .next
18775 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18776 .next
18777 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18778 .next
18779 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18780 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18781 .next
18782 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18783 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18784 .next
18785 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18786 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18787 .next
18788 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18789 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18790 .endlist
18791
18792
18793
18794
18795 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18796 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18797 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18798
18799 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18800 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18801 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18802 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18803 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18804 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18805 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18806
18807
18808 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18809 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18810 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18811 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18812 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18813 required. For example,
18814 .code
18815 check_srv = smtp
18816 .endd
18817 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18818 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18819 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18820 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18821 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18822 normal way.
18823
18824 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18825 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18826 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18827 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18828 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18829 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18830
18831 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18832 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18833 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18834 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18835 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18836 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18837 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18838 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18839
18840 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18841 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18842
18843
18844
18845
18846 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18847 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18848 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18849 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18850 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18851 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18852 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18853 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18854 also being queued.
18855
18856
18857 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18858 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18859 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18860 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18861 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18862 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18863 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18864 setting:
18865 .code
18866 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18867 .endd
18868 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18869 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18870 the address record.
18871
18872
18873 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18874 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18875 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18876 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18877
18878
18879
18880
18881 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18882 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18883 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18884 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18885 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18886 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18887 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18888 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18889 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18890 &'resolv.conf'&.
18891
18892
18893
18894 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18895 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18896 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18897 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18898 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18899 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18900 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18901 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18902 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18903 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18904 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18905
18906 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18907 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18908 sense.
18909
18910 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18911 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18912 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18913 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18914 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18915 header rewriting.
18916
18917
18918 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18919 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18920 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18921 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18922 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18923 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18924 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18925 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18926
18927 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18928 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18929 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18930 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18931 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18932 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18933 without processing them independently,
18934 provided the following conditions are met:
18935
18936 .ilist
18937 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18938 &%headers_remove%&.
18939 .next
18940 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18941 the domain.
18942 .endlist
18943
18944
18945
18946
18947 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18948 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18949 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18950 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18951 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18952 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18953 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18954 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18955 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18956 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18957
18958 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18959 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18960 local wildcard.
18961
18962
18963
18964 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18965 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18966 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18967 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18968
18969
18970
18971
18972 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18973 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18974 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18975 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18976 if
18977 .code
18978 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18979 .endd
18980 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18981 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18982 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18983 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18984 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18985 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18986
18987
18988 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18989 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18990 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18991 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18992 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18993
18994 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18995 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18996 such as that implied by
18997 .code
18998 domains = @mx_any
18999 .endd
19000 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19001 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19002 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19003 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19004
19005
19006
19007
19008
19009
19010
19011
19012
19013 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19014 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19015
19016 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19017 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19018 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19019 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19020 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19021 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19022 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19023 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19024 router handles the address
19025 .code
19026 root@[192.168.1.1]
19027 .endd
19028 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19029 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19030 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19031 .code
19032 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19033 .endd
19034 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19035 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19036
19037 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19038 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19039 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19040 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19041
19042 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19043 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19044 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19045 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19046
19047
19048
19049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19051
19052 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19053 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19054 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19055 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19056 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19057 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19058 must set
19059 .code
19060 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19061 .endd
19062 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19063
19064 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19065 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19066 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19067 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19068 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19069 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19070 must not be specified for it.
19071
19072 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19073 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19074 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19075 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19076 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19077 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19078 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19079
19080
19081 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19082 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19083 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19084 delivery to the address is deferred.
19085
19086
19087 .option port iplookup integer 0
19088 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19089 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19090 call.
19091
19092
19093 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19094 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19095 protocols is to be used.
19096
19097
19098 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19099 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19100 default value is:
19101 .code
19102 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19103 .endd
19104 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19105 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19106
19107
19108 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19109 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19110 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19111 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19112 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19113 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19114 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19115 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19116
19117
19118 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19119 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19120 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19121 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19122 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19123 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19124 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19125 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19126 following could be used:
19127 .code
19128 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19129 reroute = $local_part@$1
19130 .endd
19131
19132 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19133 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19134 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19135 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19136
19137
19138
19139
19140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19142
19143 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19144 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19145 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19146 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19147 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19148 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19149 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19150 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19151 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19152 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19153
19154 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19155 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19156 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19157 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19158 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19159 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19160 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19161
19162 .vindex "&$host$&"
19163 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19164 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19165 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19166 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19167 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19168 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19169 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19170 text string.
19171
19172 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19173 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19174 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19175 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19176 below, following the list of private options.
19177
19178
19179 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19180
19181 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19182 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19183
19184 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19185 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19186
19187 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19188 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19189 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19190 of the following values:
19191 .code
19192 decline
19193 defer
19194 fail
19195 freeze
19196 ignore
19197 pass
19198 .endd
19199 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19200 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19201 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19202 &%pass_router%&),
19203 .oindex "&%more%&"
19204 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19205 router only if &%more%& is true.
19206
19207 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19208 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19209 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19210 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19211
19212 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19213 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19214 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19215
19216
19217 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19218 .cindex "randomized host list"
19219 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19220 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19221 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19222 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19223 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19224 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19225 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19226 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19227
19228 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19229 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19230 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19231 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19232 .code
19233 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19234 .endd
19235 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19236 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19237 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19238 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19239 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19240
19241
19242 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19243 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19244 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19245 example:
19246 .code
19247 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19248 .endd
19249 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19250 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19251 deferred.
19252
19253
19254 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19255 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19256 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19257 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19258
19259
19260 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19261 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19262 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19263 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19264 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19265 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19266 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19267 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19268
19269 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19270 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19271 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19272 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19273 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19274 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19275 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19276 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19277
19278
19279
19280
19281 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19282 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19283 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19284 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19285 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19286 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19287 .display
19288 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19289 .endd
19290 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19291 no options:
19292 .code
19293 route_list = \
19294 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19295 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19296 .endd
19297 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19298 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19299 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19300 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19301 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19302 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19303 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19304 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19305 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19306 in a &%route_list%&).
19307
19308 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19309 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19310 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19311 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19312
19313
19314
19315 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19316 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19317 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19318 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19319 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19320 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19321 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19322 like this:
19323 .code
19324 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19325 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19326 .endd
19327 This data can be accessed by setting
19328 .code
19329 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19330 .endd
19331 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19332 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19333 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19334 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19335 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19336
19337
19338
19339
19340 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19341 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19342 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19343 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19344 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19345 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19346 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19347
19348 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19349 variables are set during its expansion:
19350
19351 .ilist
19352 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19353 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19354 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19355 .code
19356 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19357 .endd
19358 .next
19359 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19360 .next
19361 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19362
19363 .next
19364 .vindex "&$value$&"
19365 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19366 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19367 .code
19368 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19369 .endd
19370 .endlist
19371
19372 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19373 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19374
19375
19376
19377 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19378 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19379 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19380 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19381 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19382 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19383
19384 .ilist
19385 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19386 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19387 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19388 .code
19389 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19390 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19391 .endd
19392 .next
19393 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19394 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19395 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19396 number follows. For example:
19397 .code
19398 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19399 .endd
19400 .endlist
19401
19402 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19403 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19404 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19405 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19406 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19407 transport.
19408
19409 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19410 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19411 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19412 records in the DNS. For example:
19413 .code
19414 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19415 .endd
19416 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19417 example:
19418 .code
19419 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19420 .endd
19421 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19422 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19423 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19424 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19425 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19426 happens is controlled by the
19427 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19428 &%self%& option of the router.
19429
19430 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19431 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19432 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19433 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19434 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19435 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19436 defined by MX preferences.
19437
19438 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19439 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19440 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19441
19442 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19443 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19444 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19445 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19446
19447 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19448 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19449 router.
19450
19451 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19452 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19453 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19454
19455 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19456 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19457
19458
19459
19460 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19461 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19462 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19463 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19464 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19465 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19466 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19467
19468 .ilist
19469 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19470 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19471 .next
19472 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19473 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19474 .next
19475 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19476 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19477 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19478 .next
19479 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19480 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19481 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19482 .endlist
19483
19484 For example:
19485 .code
19486 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19487 domain2 host4:host5
19488 .endd
19489 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19490 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19491 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19492 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19493 call.
19494
19495 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19496 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19497 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19498 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19499 function called.
19500
19501 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19502 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19503 option specified.
19504
19505
19506
19507 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19508 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19509
19510 .vindex "&$host$&"
19511 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19512 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19513
19514
19515
19516 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19517 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19518 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19519
19520 .ilist
19521 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19522 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19523 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19524 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19525 .code
19526 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19527 .endd
19528 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19529 your first router something like this:
19530 .code
19531 smart_route:
19532 driver = manualroute
19533 domains = !+local_domains
19534 transport = remote_smtp
19535 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19536 .endd
19537 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19538 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19539 they are tried in order
19540 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19541 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19542 .code
19543 smart_route:
19544 driver = manualroute
19545 transport = remote_smtp
19546 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19547 .endd
19548 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19549 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19550 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19551 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19552 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19553 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19554 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19555 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19556
19557 .next
19558 .cindex "mail hub example"
19559 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19560 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19561 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19562 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19563 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19564 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19565 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19566 lookup is easier to manage.
19567
19568 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19569 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19570 example:
19571 .code
19572 hub_route:
19573 driver = manualroute
19574 transport = remote_smtp
19575 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19576 .endd
19577 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19578 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19579 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19580 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19581 domain can be used to find the host:
19582 .code
19583 through_firewall:
19584 driver = manualroute
19585 transport = remote_smtp
19586 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19587 .endd
19588 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19589 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19590 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19591 next router.
19592
19593 .next
19594 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19595 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19596 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19597 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19598 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19599 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19600 .code
19601 save_in_file:
19602 driver = manualroute
19603 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19604 route_list = saved.domain.example
19605 .endd
19606 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19607 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19608 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19609 .code
19610 save_in_file:
19611 driver = manualroute
19612 route_list = \
19613 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19614 *.saved.domain2.example \
19615 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19616 batch_pipe
19617 .endd
19618 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19619 .vindex "&$host$&"
19620 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19621 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19622 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19623 the address if the lookup fails.
19624
19625 .next
19626 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19627 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19628 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19629 one way it can be done:
19630 .code
19631 # Transport
19632 uucp:
19633 driver = pipe
19634 user = nobody
19635 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19636 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19637 return_fail_output = true
19638
19639 # Router
19640 uucphost:
19641 transport = uucp
19642 driver = manualroute
19643 route_data = \
19644 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19645 .endd
19646 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19647 .code
19648 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19649 .endd
19650 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19651 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19652 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19653 .endlist
19654 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19655 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19656
19657
19658
19659
19660
19661
19662
19663
19664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19666
19667 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19668 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19669 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19670 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19671 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19672 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19673 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19674 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19675 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19676 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19677 options:
19678 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19679
19680 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19681 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19682 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19683 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19684 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19685
19686
19687 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19688 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19689 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19690 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19691 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19692 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19693
19694
19695 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19696 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19697 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19698 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19699 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19700 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19701 not set, a value for the gid also.
19702
19703 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19704 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19705 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19706 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19707 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19708 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19709 gid.
19710
19711
19712 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19713 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19714 before running the command.
19715
19716
19717 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19718 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19719 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19720 timeout.
19721
19722
19723 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19724 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19725 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19726 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19727 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19728
19729 .ilist
19730 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19731 below).
19732 .next
19733 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19734 &%no_more%& is set.
19735 .next
19736 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19737 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19738 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19739 included in the SMTP response.
19740 .next
19741 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19742 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19743 included in any SMTP response.
19744 .next
19745 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19746 .next
19747 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19748 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19749 .next
19750 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19751 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19752 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19753 .endlist
19754
19755 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19756 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19757 the page):
19758 .code
19759 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19760 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19761 .endd
19762 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19763 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19764 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19765 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19766
19767 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19768 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19769 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19770 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19771 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19772
19773 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19774 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19775 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19776 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19777 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19778
19779 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19780 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19781 variable. For example, this return line
19782 .code
19783 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19784 .endd
19785 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19786 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19787 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19788 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19789
19790
19791
19792
19793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19795
19796 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19797 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19798 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19799 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19800 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19801 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19802 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19803 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19804 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19805 redirected in several different ways:
19806
19807 .ilist
19808 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19809 independently.
19810 .next
19811 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19812 .next
19813 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19814 .next
19815 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19816 .next
19817 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19818 .next
19819 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19820 .next
19821 It can be discarded.
19822 .endlist
19823
19824 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19825 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19826 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19827 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19828
19829 If success DSNs have been requested
19830 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19831 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19832 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19833
19834
19835
19836 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19837 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19838 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19839 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19840 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19841 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19842 .code
19843 system_aliases:
19844 driver = redirect
19845 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19846 .endd
19847 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19848 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19849 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19850 cause delivery to be deferred.
19851
19852 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19853 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19854 .code
19855 userforward:
19856 driver = redirect
19857 check_local_user
19858 file = $home/.forward
19859 no_verify
19860 .endd
19861 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19862 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19863 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19864 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19865 comments.
19866
19867
19868
19869 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19870 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19871 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19872 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19873
19874 .ilist
19875 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19876 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19877 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19878 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19879 .next
19880 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19881 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19882 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19883 saves some resources.
19884 .endlist
19885
19886
19887
19888
19889
19890
19891 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19892 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19893 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19894 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19895 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19896
19897 .ilist
19898 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19899 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19900 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19901 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19902 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19903 document is intended for use by end users.
19904 .next
19905 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19906 described in the next section.
19907 .endlist
19908
19909 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19910 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19911 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19912 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19913 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19914
19915
19916
19917 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19918 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19919 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19920 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19921 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19922 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19923 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19924 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19925 commas or newlines.
19926 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19927 quotes.
19928
19929 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19930 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19931 next newline character is ignored.
19932
19933 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19934 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19935 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19936 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19937 removed.
19938
19939 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19940 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19941 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19942 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19943 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19944 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19945 setting:
19946 .code
19947 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19948 .endd
19949
19950
19951 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19952 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19953 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19954 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19955 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19956 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19957 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19958 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19959 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19960 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19961 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19962
19963 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19964 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19965 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19966 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19967 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19968 .code
19969 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19970 .endd
19971 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19972 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19973 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19974 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19975 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19976 synonymously.
19977
19978 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19979 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19980 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19981 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19982 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19983
19984 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19985 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19986 contains:
19987 .code
19988 Sam.Reman: spqr
19989 .endd
19990 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19991 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19992 this forward file:
19993 .code
19994 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19995 .endd
19996 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19997 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19998 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19999 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20000 should really contain
20001 .code
20002 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20003 .endd
20004 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20005 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20006 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20007
20008
20009
20010 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20011 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20012 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20013
20014 .ilist
20015 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20016 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20017 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20018 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20019 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20020 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20021 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20022
20023 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20024 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20025 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20026 in double quotes, for example:
20027 .code
20028 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20029 .endd
20030 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20031 quote just the command. An item such as
20032 .code
20033 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20034 .endd
20035 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20036
20037 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20038 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20039 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20040 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20041 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20042 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20043 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20044 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20045 an &%accept%& router.
20046
20047 .next
20048 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20049 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20050 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20051 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20052 .code
20053 /home/world/minbari
20054 .endd
20055 is treated as a file name, but
20056 .code
20057 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20058 .endd
20059 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20060 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20061 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20062 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20063
20064 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20065 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20066
20067 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20068 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20069 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20070 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20071
20072 .next
20073 .cindex "included address list"
20074 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20075 If an item is of the form
20076 .code
20077 :include:<path name>
20078 .endd
20079 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20080 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20081 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20082 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20083 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20084 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20085 .code
20086 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20087 .endd
20088 It must be given as
20089 .code
20090 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20091 .endd
20092 .next
20093 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20094 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20095 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20096 .cindex "black hole"
20097 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20098 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20099 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20100 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20101 .code
20102 :blackhole:
20103 .endd
20104 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20105 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20106 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20107
20108 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20109 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20110 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20111 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20112 &_/dev/null_&.
20113
20114 .next
20115 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20116 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20117 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20118 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20119 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20120 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20121 redirection items of the form
20122 .code
20123 :defer:
20124 :fail:
20125 .endd
20126 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20127 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20128 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20129 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20130 .code
20131 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20132 .endd
20133 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20134 of a
20135 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20136 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20137 default.
20138 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20139 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20140 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20141
20142 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20143 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20144 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20145 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20146 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20147 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20148 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20149 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20150 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20151 ignored.
20152
20153 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20154 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20155 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20156 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20157
20158 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20159 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20160 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20161 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20162 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20163
20164 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20165 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20166 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20167 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20168 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20169 rules still apply.
20170
20171 .next
20172 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20173 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20174 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20175 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20176 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20177 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20178 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20179 .endlist
20180
20181
20182 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20183 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20184 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20185 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20186 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20187 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20188 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20189 aliasing scheme of the type
20190 .code
20191 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20192 localpart1: pipe
20193 localpart2: pipe
20194 .endd
20195 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20196 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20197 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20198 such as
20199 .code
20200 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20201 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20202 .endd
20203 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20204 the pipes are distinct.
20205
20206
20207
20208 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20209 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20210 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20211 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20212 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20213 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20214 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20215 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20216 can be used to avoid this.
20217
20218
20219 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20220 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20221 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20222 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20223 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20224 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20225 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20226
20227
20228
20229 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20230
20231 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20232 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20233
20234
20235 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20236 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20237 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20238
20239
20240 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20241 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20242 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20243 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20244
20245
20246 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20247 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20248 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20249 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20250 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20251 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20252 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20253
20254 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20255 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20256
20257
20258 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20259 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20260 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20261 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20262 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20263
20264
20265
20266 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20267 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20268 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20269 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20270 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20271 let ordinary users do.
20272
20273
20274
20275 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20276 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20277 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20278 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20279 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20280 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20281
20282 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20283 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20284 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20285 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20286 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20287 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20288 .code
20289 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20290 .endd
20291 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20292 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20293 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20294 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20295 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20296 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20297 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20298 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20299
20300
20301 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20302 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20303 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20304 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20305 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20306 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20307 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20308 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20309
20310
20311
20312 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20313 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20314 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20315 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20316 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20317 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20318
20319
20320 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20321 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20322 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20323 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20324 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20325 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20326
20327 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20328 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20329 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20330 .code
20331 data = #Exim filter\n\
20332 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20333 .endd
20334 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20335 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20336 choice into a newline.
20337
20338
20339 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20340 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20341 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20342 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20343 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20344
20345
20346 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20347 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20348 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20349 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20350 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20351 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20352 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20353 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20354
20355 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20356 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20357 runs a check on the containing directory,
20358 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20359 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20360 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20361 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20362 not, the router declines.
20363
20364
20365 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20366 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20367 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20368 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20369 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20370 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20371 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20372
20373
20374 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20375 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20376 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20377 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20378 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20379
20380
20381 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20382 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20383 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20384 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20385 redirection list.
20386
20387
20388 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20389 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20390 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20391 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20392 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20393
20394
20395
20396
20397 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20398 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20399 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20400 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20401 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20402 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20403 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20404 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20405 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20406 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20407 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20408
20409
20410 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20411 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20412 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20413 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20414 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20415 functions.
20416
20417 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20418 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20419 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20420 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20421 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20422 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20423
20424 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20425 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20426 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20427 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20428 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20429 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20430 &_.forward_& files).
20431
20432
20433 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20434 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20435 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20436 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20437 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20438
20439
20440 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20441 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20442 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20443 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20444 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20445 of the embedded Perl support.
20446
20447
20448 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20449 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20450 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20451 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20452 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20453
20454
20455 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20456 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20457 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20458 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20459 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20460
20461
20462 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20463 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20464 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20465 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20466 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20467 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20468 &%one_time%& is set.
20469
20470
20471 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20472 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20473 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20474 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20475 to make use of &%run%& items.
20476
20477
20478 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20479 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20480 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20481 If this option is true, items of the form
20482 .code
20483 :include:<path name>
20484 .endd
20485 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20486
20487
20488 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20489 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20490 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20491 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20492 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20493 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20494 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20495
20496
20497 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20498 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20499 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20500 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20501 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20502
20503
20504 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20505 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20506 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20507 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20508 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20509
20510
20511
20512
20513 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20514 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20515 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20516 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20517 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20518 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20519 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20520
20521
20522 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20523 .cindex "EACCES"
20524 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20525 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20526 file did not exist.
20527
20528
20529 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20530 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20531 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20532 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20533 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20534
20535 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20536 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20537 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20538 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20539 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20540 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20541 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20542 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20543
20544
20545
20546 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20547 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20548 redirection list must start with this directory.
20549
20550
20551 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20552 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20553 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20554
20555
20556 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20557 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20558 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20559 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20560 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20561 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20562 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20563 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20564 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20565 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20566 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20567 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20568 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20569 before they subscribed.
20570
20571 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20572 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20573 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20574 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20575 attempt.
20576
20577 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20578 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20579 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20580 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20581
20582 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20583 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20584 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20585
20586 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20587 &%one_time%&.
20588
20589 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20590 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20591 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20592 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20593 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20594 expansion.
20595
20596
20597 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20598 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20599 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20600 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20601 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20602 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20603 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20604 See &%check_owner%& above.
20605
20606
20607 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20608 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20609 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20610 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20611
20612
20613 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20614 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20615 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20616 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20617 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20618 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20619 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20620
20621
20622 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20623 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20624 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20625 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20626 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20627 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20628 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20629 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20630
20631 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20632 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20633 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20634 addresses.
20635
20636 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20637 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20638 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20639 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20640 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20641 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20642 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20643 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20644 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20645 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20646
20647
20648 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20649 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20650 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20651 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20652 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20653 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20654
20655
20656 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20657 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20658 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20659 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20660 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20661 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20662
20663
20664 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20665 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20666 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20667 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20668 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20669
20670
20671 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20672 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20673 :subaddress part of an address.
20674
20675 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20676 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20677 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20678 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20679
20680
20681 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20682 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20683 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20684 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20685 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20686 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20687 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20688
20689
20690
20691 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20692 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20693 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20694 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20695 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20696 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20697 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20698 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20699 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20700 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20701 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20702 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20703 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20704 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20705 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20706 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20707
20708 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20709 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20710 the following routers.
20711
20712 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20713 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20714 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20715 so it is passed to the following routers.
20716
20717 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20718 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20719 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20720 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20721
20722 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20723 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20724 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20725 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20726 .code
20727 userforward:
20728 driver = redirect
20729 allow_filter
20730 check_local_user
20731 file = $home/.forward
20732 file_transport = address_file
20733 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20734 reply_transport = address_reply
20735 no_verify
20736 skip_syntax_errors
20737 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20738 syntax_errors_text = \
20739 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20740 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20741 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20742 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20743 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20744 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20745 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20746 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20747 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20748 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20749 .endd
20750 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20751 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20752 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20753 .code
20754 real_localuser:
20755 driver = accept
20756 check_local_user
20757 local_part_prefix = real-
20758 transport = local_delivery
20759 .endd
20760 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20761 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20762 .code
20763 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20764 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20765 .endd
20766
20767
20768 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20769 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20770
20771
20772 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20773 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20774 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20775 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20776
20777
20778
20779
20780
20781
20782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20784
20785 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20786 "Environment for local transports"
20787 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20788 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20789 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20790 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20791 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20792 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20793 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20794
20795 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20796 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20797 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20798 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20799
20800 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20801 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20802 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20803 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20804 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20805
20806
20807
20808 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20809 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20810 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20811 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20812 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20813 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20814 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20815 time.
20816
20817 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20818 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20819 .code
20820 my_transport:
20821 driver = pipe
20822 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20823 .endd
20824 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20825 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20826 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20827 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20828
20829
20830
20831
20832 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20833 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20834 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20835 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20836 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20837 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20838 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20839 group (set by the transport). For example:
20840 .code
20841 # Routers ...
20842 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20843 local_users:
20844 driver = accept
20845 check_local_user
20846 transport = group_delivery
20847
20848 # Transports ...
20849 # This transport overrides the group
20850 group_delivery:
20851 driver = appendfile
20852 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20853 group = mail
20854 .endd
20855 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20856 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20857 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20858 set.
20859
20860 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20861 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20862 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20863 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20864 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20865 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20866
20867 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20868 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20869 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20870 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20871 original gid is also used.
20872
20873 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20874 following that is set is used:
20875
20876 .ilist
20877 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20878 .next
20879 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20880 .next
20881 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20882 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20883 .next
20884 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20885 .next
20886 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20887 the uid is the creator's uid;
20888 .next
20889 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20890 .endlist
20891
20892 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20893 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20894 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20895 The first of the following that is set is used:
20896
20897 .ilist
20898 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20899 .next
20900 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20901 .next
20902 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20903 .next
20904 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20905 .next
20906 The Exim uid.
20907 .endlist
20908
20909 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20910 &%never_users%& list.
20911
20912
20913
20914
20915
20916 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20917 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20918 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20919 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20920 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20921 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20922 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20923 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20924 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20925 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20926
20927 .ilist
20928 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20929 .next
20930 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20931 .next
20932 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20933 .next
20934 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20935 .endlist
20936
20937 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20938
20939 .ilist
20940 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20941 .next
20942 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20943 .endlist
20944
20945
20946 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20947 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20948 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20949
20950
20951
20952 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20953 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20954 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20955 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20956 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20957 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20958 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20959 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20960 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20961 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20962 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20963 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20964 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20965 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20966
20967
20968
20969
20970
20971
20972
20973 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20974 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20975
20976 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20977 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20978 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20979 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20980 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20981
20982
20983 .option body_only transports boolean false
20984 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20985 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20986 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20987 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20988 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20989 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20990 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20991 automatically suppress them.
20992
20993
20994 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20995 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20996 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20997 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20998 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20999 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21000
21001
21002 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21003 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21004 deliveries by the transport or for any
21005 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21006 what you are doing.
21007
21008
21009 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21010 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21011 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21012 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21013 transport is run.
21014 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21015 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21016 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21017 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21018 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21019 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21020 one.
21021 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21022 transport and the router that called it.
21023
21024 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21025 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21026 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21027 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21028 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21029 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21030 safely be resent to other recipients.
21031
21032
21033 .option driver transports string unset
21034 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21035 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21036
21037
21038 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21039 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21040 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21041 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21042 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21043 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21044 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21045 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21046 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21047 resent to other recipients.
21048
21049
21050 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21051 .cindex events
21052 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21053 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21054
21055
21056 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21057 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21058 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21059 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21060 &%user%& (see below).
21061
21062
21063 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21064 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21065 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21066 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21067 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21068 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21069 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21070 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21071 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21072 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21073 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21074
21075 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21076 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21077
21078
21079 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21080 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21081 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21082 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21083 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21084 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21085 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21086 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21087
21088
21089 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21090 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21091 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21092 This option specifies a list of header names,
21093 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21094 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21095 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21096 routers.
21097 Each list item is separately expanded.
21098 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21099 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21100 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21101
21102 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21103 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21104
21105 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21106 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21107 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21108
21109
21110
21111 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21112 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21113 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21114 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21115 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21116 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21117 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21118 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21119 example,
21120 .code
21121 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21122 x@y w@z
21123 .endd
21124 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21125 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21126 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21127 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21128 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21129 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21130 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21131 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21132 change envelope recipients at this time.
21133
21134
21135 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21136 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21137 .vindex "&$home$&"
21138 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21139 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21140 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21141 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21142 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21143 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21144 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21145 deferred.
21146
21147
21148 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21149 .cindex "additional groups"
21150 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21151 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21152 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21153 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21154 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21155
21156
21157 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21158 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21159 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21160 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21161 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21162 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21163 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21164 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21165
21166 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21167 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21168 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21169 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21170 Obviously there is scope for
21171 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21172 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21173
21174 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21175 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21176 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21177 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21178 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21179
21180
21181 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21182 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21183 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21184 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21185 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21186 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21187 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21188 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21189 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21190 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21191 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21192 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21193 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21194 delivered.
21195
21196
21197
21198 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21199 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21200 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21201 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21202 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21203 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21204 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21205 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21206 that contains
21207 .code
21208 local_part_prefix = *-
21209 .endd
21210 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21211 is delivered with
21212 .code
21213 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21214 .endd
21215 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21216 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21217 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21218 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21219 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21220
21221
21222 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21223 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21224 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21225 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21226 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21227 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21228 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21229 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21230 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21231
21232 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21233 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21234 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21235 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21236
21237 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21238 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21239 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21240
21241
21242 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21243 .cindex "envelope sender"
21244 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21245 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21246 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21247 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21248 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21249 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21250 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21251 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21252 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21253
21254 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21255 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21256
21257 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21258 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21259 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21260 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21261 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21262 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21263 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21264
21265 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21266 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21267 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21268 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21269 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21270
21271
21272
21273 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21274 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21275 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21276 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21277 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21278 have easy access to it.
21279
21280 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21281 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21282 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21283 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21284 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21285 recipients.
21286
21287
21288 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21289 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21290
21291
21292 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21293 .cindex "shadow transport"
21294 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21295 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21296 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21297
21298 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21299 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21300 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21301 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21302 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21303 cause a log line to be written.
21304
21305 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21306 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21307 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21308 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21309 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21310 of the form
21311 .code
21312 ST=<shadow transport name>
21313 .endd
21314 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21315 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21316 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21317 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21318 headers that some sites insist on.
21319
21320
21321 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21322 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21323 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21324 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21325 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21326 individual users or via a system filter.
21327 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21328
21329 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21330 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21331 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21332 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21333 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21334
21335 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21336 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21337 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21338 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21339 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21340 &(pipe)& transports.
21341
21342 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21343 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21344 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21345 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21346 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21347
21348 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21349 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21350 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21351 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21352
21353 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21354 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21355 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21356 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21357 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21358 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21359
21360 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21361 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21362 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21363 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21364 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21365 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21366 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21367 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21368
21369 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21370 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21371 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21372 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21373 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21374 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21375 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21376 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21377 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21378 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21379
21380 .vindex "&$host$&"
21381 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21382 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21383 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21384 which the message is being sent. For example:
21385 .code
21386 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21387 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21388 .endd
21389
21390 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21391 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21392 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21393 .ilist
21394 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21395 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21396 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21397 example:
21398 .code
21399 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21400 .endd
21401 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21402 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21403 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21404 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21405 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21406 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21407 .next
21408 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21409 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21410 arguments. Consider this example:
21411 .code
21412 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21413 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21414 .endd
21415 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21416 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21417 .code
21418 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21419 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21420 .endd
21421 .endlist
21422
21423 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21424 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21425 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21426 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21427 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21428 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21429 bounced from a transport filter.
21430
21431 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21432 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21433 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21434
21435
21436 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21437 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21438 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21439 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21440 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21441 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21442 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21443 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21444 becomes a temporary error.
21445
21446
21447 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21448 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21449 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21450 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21451 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21452 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21453 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21454 option is not set.
21455
21456 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21457 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21458 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21459
21460 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21461 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21462 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21463 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21464 retry data.
21465 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21466 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21467 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21468
21469
21470
21471
21472
21473
21474 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21475 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21476
21477 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21478 "Address batching"
21479 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21480 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21481 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21482 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21483 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21484 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21485 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21486
21487 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21488 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21489 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21490 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21491 local transport, for example:
21492
21493 .ilist
21494 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21495 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21496 recipients saves space.
21497 .next
21498 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21499 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21500 .next
21501 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21502 to a scanner program or
21503 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21504 acceptable.
21505 .endlist
21506
21507 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21508 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21509 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21510
21511 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21512 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21513 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21514 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21515 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21516 to certain conditions:
21517
21518 .ilist
21519 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21520 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21521 batching is possible.
21522 .next
21523 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21524 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21525 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21526 .next
21527 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21528 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21529 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21530 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21531 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21532 from taking place.
21533 .next
21534 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21535 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21536 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21537 be the same.
21538 .endlist
21539
21540 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21541 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21542 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21543 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21544 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21545 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21546 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21547 .code
21548 check_string = "."
21549 escape_string = ".."
21550 .endd
21551 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21552 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21553 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21554
21555 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21556 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21557 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21558 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21559 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21560 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21561
21562 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21563 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21564 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21565 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21566 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21567 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21568 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21569 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21570 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21571
21572
21573
21574
21575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21577
21578 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21579 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21580 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21581 .cindex "directory creation"
21582 .cindex "creating directories"
21583 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21584 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21585 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21586 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21587 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21588 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21589 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21590 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21591 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21592 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21593
21594 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21595 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21596 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21597 included.
21598
21599 .cindex "quota" "system"
21600 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21601 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21602 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21603
21604 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21605 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21606 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21607 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21608
21609 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21610 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21611 private options.
21612
21613 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21614 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21615 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21616 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21617 option).
21618
21619
21620
21621 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21622 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21623 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21624 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21625 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21626
21627 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21628 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21629 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21630 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21631 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21632 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21633 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21634 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21635 operation. There are two cases:
21636
21637 .ilist
21638 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21639 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21640 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21641 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21642 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21643 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21644 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21645 .next
21646 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21647 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21648 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21649 .endlist
21650
21651
21652 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21653 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21654 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21655 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21656 form:
21657 .code
21658 save folder23
21659 .endd
21660 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21661 .code
21662 require "fileinto";
21663 fileinto "folder23";
21664 .endd
21665 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21666 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21667 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21668 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21669 way of handling this requirement:
21670 .code
21671 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21672 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21673 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21674 {$address_file} \
21675 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21676 }} \
21677 }
21678 .endd
21679 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21680 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21681 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21682
21683 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21684 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21685 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21686 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21687 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21688 path to the transport.
21689
21690 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21691 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21692
21693
21694
21695
21696 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21697 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21698
21699
21700
21701 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21702 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21703 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21704 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21705 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21706 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21707 delivery is deferred.
21708
21709
21710 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21711 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21712 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21713 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21714 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21715 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21716 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21717 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21718
21719
21720 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21721 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21722 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21723 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21724 file.
21725
21726
21727 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21728 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21729
21730
21731 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21732 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21733 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21734 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21735 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21736
21737
21738 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21739 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21740 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21741 process is running.
21742
21743
21744 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21745 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21746 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21747 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21748 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21749 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21750 contains is significant.
21751
21752 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21753 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21754 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21755 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21756 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21757
21758 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21759 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21760 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21761 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21762 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21763 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21764 .code
21765 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21766 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21767 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21768 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21769 .endd
21770 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21771 .cindex "directory creation"
21772 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21773 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21774 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21775
21776 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21777 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21778 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21779 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21780 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21781
21782
21783
21784 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21785 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21786 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21787 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21788 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21789 beneath.
21790
21791 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21792 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21793 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21794 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21795 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21796 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21797 &%file_must_exist%&.
21798
21799
21800 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21801 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21802 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21803 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21804
21805 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21806 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21807 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21808 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21809 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21810
21811
21812 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21813 .cindex "base62"
21814 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21815 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21816 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21817 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21818 .code
21819 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21820 .endd
21821 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21822 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21823 option.
21824
21825
21826 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21827 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21828 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21829
21830
21831 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21832 See &%check_string%& above.
21833
21834
21835 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21836 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21837 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21838 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21839 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21840 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21841 &%file%&.
21842
21843 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21844 .cindex "locking files"
21845 .cindex "lock files"
21846 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21847 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21848
21849 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21850 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21851 examples:
21852 .code
21853 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21854 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21855 file = $home/inbox
21856 .endd
21857 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21858 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21859 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21860 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21861 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21862 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21863
21864
21865
21866 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21867 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21868 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21869 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21870 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21871 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21872 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21873 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21874 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21875 this added to it:
21876 .code
21877 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21878 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21879 .endd
21880 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21881 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21882 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21883 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21884 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21885 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21886 delivery is deferred.
21887
21888
21889 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21890 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21891 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21892 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21893
21894
21895 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21896 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21897 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21898 .cindex "locking files"
21899 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21900 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21901 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21902 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21903 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21904 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21905 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21906 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21907
21908 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21909 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21910 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21911 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21912
21913 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21914 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21915 retries is
21916 .code
21917 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21918 .endd
21919 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21920 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21921 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21922
21923 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21924 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21925 .code
21926 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21927 .endd
21928
21929 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21930 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21931 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21932 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21933
21934
21935 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21936 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21937 for details of locking.
21938
21939
21940 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21941 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21942 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21943
21944
21945 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21946 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21947 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21948
21949
21950 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21951 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21952 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21953 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21954 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21955
21956
21957 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21958 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21959 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21960 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21961 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21962 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21963 external source that maintains the data.
21964
21965
21966 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21967 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21968 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21969 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21970 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21971 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21972 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21973 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21974
21975
21976
21977 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21978 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21979 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21980 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21981 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21982 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21983 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21984 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21985 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21986 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21987
21988
21989 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21990 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21991 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21992 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21993 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21994 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21995 calculation. The default value is:
21996 .code
21997 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21998 .endd
21999 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22000 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22001 &_Trash_&
22002 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22003 .code
22004 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22005 .endd
22006 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22007 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22008 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22009 directly into that directory.
22010
22011
22012 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22013 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22014 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22015
22016
22017 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22018 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22019 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22020
22021
22022 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22023 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22024 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22025 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22026 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22027 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22028 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22029 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22030
22031 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22032 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22033 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22034 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22035 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22036 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22037 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22038 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22039 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22040 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22041
22042
22043 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22044 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22045 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22046 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22047 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22048 below for further details.
22049
22050
22051 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22052 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22053 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22054
22055
22056 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22057 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22058 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22059
22060
22061 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22062 .cindex "locking files"
22063 .cindex "file" "locking"
22064 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22065 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22066 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22067 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22068 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22069 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22070 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22071
22072 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22073 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22074 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22075 combination:
22076 .code
22077 mbx_format = true
22078 message_prefix =
22079 message_suffix =
22080 .endd
22081 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22082 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22083 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22084 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22085 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22086 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22087 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22088 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22089
22090 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22091 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22092 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22093 append messages to it.
22094
22095
22096 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22097 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22098 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22099 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22100 in which case it is:
22101 .code
22102 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22103 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22104 .endd
22105 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22106 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22107
22108 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22109 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22110 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22111 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22112 setting
22113 .code
22114 message_suffix =
22115 .endd
22116 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22117 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22118
22119 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22120 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22121 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22122 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22123 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22124 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22125 value, and this option is ignored.
22126
22127
22128 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22129 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22130 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22131 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22132 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22133
22134
22135 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22136 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22137 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22138 on users about incoming mail.
22139
22140
22141 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22142 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22143 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22144 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22145 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22146 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22147 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22148 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22149 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22150
22151 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22152 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22153 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22154
22155 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22156 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22157 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22158 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22159 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22160 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22161
22162 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22163 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22164 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22165 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22166 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22167 be handled.
22168
22169 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22170 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22171
22172 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22173
22174 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22175 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22176 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22177 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22178 system quota failures.
22179
22180 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22181 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22182 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22183 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22184 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22185 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22186 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22187 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22188 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22189 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22190
22191
22192 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22193 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22194 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22195 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22196 delivery directory.
22197
22198
22199 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22200 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22201 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22202 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22203 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22204 &"no quota"&.
22205
22206 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22207 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22208
22209 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22210 See &%quota%& above.
22211
22212
22213 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22214 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22215 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22216 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22217 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22218 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22219 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22220
22221 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22222 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22223 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22224 the file length to the file name. For example:
22225 .code
22226 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22227 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22228 .endd
22229 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22230 number of lines in the message.
22231
22232 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22233 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22234 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22235
22236 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22237
22238
22239 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22240 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22241 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22242 .code
22243 quota_warn_message = "\
22244 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22245 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22246 This message is automatically created \
22247 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22248 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22249 a warning threshold that is\n\
22250 set by the system administrator.\n"
22251 .endd
22252
22253
22254 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22255 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22256 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22257 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22258 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22259 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22260 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22261 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22262 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22263 sign. For example:
22264 .code
22265 quota = 10M
22266 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22267 .endd
22268 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22269 percent sign is ignored.
22270
22271 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22272 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22273 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22274 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22275 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22276 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22277 .code
22278 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22279 .endd
22280 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22281 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22282 option.
22283
22284 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22285 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22286 percentage.
22287
22288
22289 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22290 .cindex "envelope sender"
22291 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22292 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22293 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22294 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22295 for details of batch SMTP.
22296
22297
22298 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22299 .cindex "carriage return"
22300 .cindex "linefeed"
22301 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22302 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22303 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22304 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22305
22306 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22307 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22308 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22309 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22310 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22311 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22312
22313
22314 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22315 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22316 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22317 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22318 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22319 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22320
22321
22322 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22323 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22324 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22325 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22326 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22327
22328 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22329 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22330 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22331 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22332
22333 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22334 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22335 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22336 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22337 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22338 error.
22339
22340 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22341 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22342
22343
22344 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22345 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22346 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22347 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22348 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22349 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22350 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22351
22352 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22353 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22354 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22355 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22356 file corruption.
22357
22358 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22359 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22360 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22361
22362
22363 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22364 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22365 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22366 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22367 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22368 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22369 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22370 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22371 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22372
22373 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22374 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22375 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22376 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22377
22378
22379
22380
22381 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22382 .cindex "appending to a file"
22383 .cindex "file" "appending"
22384 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22385
22386 .ilist
22387 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22388 return is given.
22389
22390 .next
22391 .cindex "directory creation"
22392 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22393 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22394 &%directory_mode%& option.
22395
22396 .next
22397 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22398 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22399 transport.
22400
22401 .next
22402 .cindex "file" "locking"
22403 .cindex "locking files"
22404 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22405 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22406 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22407
22408 .olist
22409 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22410 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22411 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22412 .next
22413 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22414 .next
22415 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22416 Unlink the hitching post name.
22417 .next
22418 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22419 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22420 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22421 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22422 .next
22423 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22424 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22425 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22426 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22427 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22428 it before trying again.
22429 .endlist olist
22430
22431 .next
22432 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22433 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22434 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22435
22436 .next
22437 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22438 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22439 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22440 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22441 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22442 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22443 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22444 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22445 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22446 checked.
22447
22448 .next
22449 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22450 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22451 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22452 delivery is deferred.
22453
22454 .next
22455 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22456 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22457 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22458 permissions.
22459
22460 .next
22461 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22462 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22463 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22464
22465 .next
22466 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22467 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22468 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22469
22470 .next
22471 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22472 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22473 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22474 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22475 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22476 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22477 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22478 that prevents link following.
22479
22480 .next
22481 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22482 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22483 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22484 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22485 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22486
22487 .next
22488 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22489
22490 .next
22491 .cindex "file" "locking"
22492 .cindex "locking files"
22493 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22494 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22495 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22496 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22497 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22498 .code
22499 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22500 .endd
22501 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22502 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22503 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22504
22505 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22506 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22507 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22508
22509 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22510 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22511 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22512 delivery is deferred.
22513
22514 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22515 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22516 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22517 immediately. It retries up to
22518 .code
22519 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22520 .endd
22521 times (rounded up).
22522 .endlist
22523
22524 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22525 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22526
22527
22528 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22529 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22530 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22531 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22532 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22533 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22534 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22535 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22536 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22537 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22538
22539 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22540 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22541 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22542 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22543 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22544 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22545 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22546
22547 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22548 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22549 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22550 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22551
22552
22553 .cindex "maildir format"
22554 .cindex "mailstore format"
22555 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22556 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22557 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22558 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22559 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22560
22561 .cindex "directory creation"
22562 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22563 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22564 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22565 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22566 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22567 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22568 deferred.
22569
22570
22571
22572 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22573 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22574 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22575 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22576 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22577 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22578 &_new_& subdirectory.
22579
22580 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22581 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22582 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22583 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22584 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22585 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22586 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22587
22588 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22589 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22590 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22591 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22592 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22593 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22594 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22595 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22596
22597 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22598 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22599 folders. Consider this example:
22600 .code
22601 maildir_format = true
22602 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22603 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22604 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22605 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22606 .endd
22607 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22608 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22609 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22610 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22611 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22612 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22613
22614 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22615 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22616 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22617 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22618 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22619
22620 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22621 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22622 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22623
22624 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22625 .cindex "maildir++"
22626 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22627 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22628 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22629 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22630 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22631 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22632 amount of space used.
22633
22634 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22635 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22636 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22637 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22638 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22639 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22640
22641
22642
22643
22644 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22645 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22646 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22647 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22648 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22649 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22650
22651
22652 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22653 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22654 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22655 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22656 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22657 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22658 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22659 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22660 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22661 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22662 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22663 backwards compatibility).
22664
22665 For one common implementation, you might set:
22666 .code
22667 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22668 .endd
22669 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22670
22671 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22672 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22673 &[stat()]& each message file.
22674
22675
22676 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22677 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22678 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22679 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22680 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22681 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22682 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22683 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22684 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22685
22686 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22687 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22688 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22689 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22690 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22691 need to know the quota.
22692
22693 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22694 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22695
22696 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22697 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22698 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22699 details.
22700
22701
22702 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22703 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22704 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22705 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22706 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22707 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22708 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22709 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22710
22711 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22712 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22713 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22714 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22715 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22716 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22717
22718 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22719 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22720 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22721 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22722 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22723 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22724
22725 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22726 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22727 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22728 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22729
22730
22731 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22732 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22733 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22734 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22735 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22736 .code
22737 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22738 .endd
22739 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22740 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22741 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22742 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22743 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22744
22745
22746
22747
22748
22749
22750 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22752
22753 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22754 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22755 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22756 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22757 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22758 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22759 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22760 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22761
22762 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22763 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22764 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22765 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22766 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22767
22768
22769 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22770 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22771 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22772 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22773 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22774
22775 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22776 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22777 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22778 transport is run as a consequence of a
22779 &%mail%&
22780 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22781 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22782 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22783 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22784 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22785 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22786
22787 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22788 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22789 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22790 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22791
22792 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22793 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22794 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22795 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22796 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22797 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22798 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22799
22800 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22801 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22802 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22803 the transport defers.
22804 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22805 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22806
22807 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22808 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22809 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22810 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22811
22812 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22813 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22814 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22815 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22816 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22817 problems. They are just discarded.
22818
22819
22820
22821 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22822 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22823
22824 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22825 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22826 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22827
22828
22829 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22830 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22831 when the message is specified by the transport.
22832
22833
22834 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22835 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22836 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22837 string comes first.
22838
22839
22840 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22841 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22842 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22843
22844
22845 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22846 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22847 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22848
22849
22850 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22851 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22852 specified by the transport.
22853
22854
22855 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22856 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22857 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22858 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22859
22860
22861 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22862 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22863 the message is specified by the transport.
22864
22865
22866 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22867 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22868 used.
22869
22870
22871 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22872 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22873 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22874 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22875 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22876
22877
22878
22879 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22880 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22881 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22882 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22883
22884 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22885 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22886 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22887 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22888 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22889 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22890 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22891 infinity.
22892
22893 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22894 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22895 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22896 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22897 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22898
22899 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22900 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22901 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22902 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22903 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22904 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22905
22906
22907 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22908 See &%once%& above.
22909
22910
22911 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22912 See &%once%& above.
22913 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22914
22915
22916 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22917 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22918 specified by the transport.
22919
22920
22921 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22922 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22923 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22924 configuration option.
22925
22926
22927 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22928 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22929 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22930 automatic responses. For example:
22931 .code
22932 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22933 .endd
22934 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22935 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22936 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22937 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22938 small.
22939
22940
22941
22942 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22943 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22944 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22945 the text comes first.
22946
22947
22948 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22949 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22950 when the message is specified by the transport.
22951 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22952 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22953
22954
22955
22956
22957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22959
22960 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22961 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22962 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22963 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22964 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22965 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22966 specified command
22967 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22968 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22969 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22970 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22971 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22972 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22973 .code
22974 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22975 .endd
22976 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22977 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22978 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22979 as follows:
22980
22981 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22982 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22983
22984
22985 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22986 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22987 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22988 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22989 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22990
22991
22992 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22993 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22994 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22995 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22996 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22997 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22998 LMTP protocol.
22999
23000 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23001 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23002 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23003 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23004 in its response to the LHLO command.
23005
23006 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23007 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23008 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23009 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23010
23011
23012 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23013 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23014 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23015 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23016 LMTP transport:
23017 .code
23018 lmtp:
23019 driver = lmtp
23020 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23021 batch_max = 20
23022 user = exim
23023 .endd
23024 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23025 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23026
23027
23028
23029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23031
23032 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23033 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23034 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23035 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23036 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23037 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23038 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23039 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23040 following ways:
23041
23042 .ilist
23043 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23044 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23045 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23046 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23047 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23048 .next
23049 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23050 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23051 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23052 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23053 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23054 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23055 that are routed to the transport.
23056 .next
23057 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23058 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23059 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23060 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23061 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23062 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23063 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23064 .endlist
23065
23066
23067 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23068 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23069 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23070
23071 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23072 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23073 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23074 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23075 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23076 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23077 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23078
23079
23080 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23081 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23082 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23083 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23084 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23085 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23086 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23087
23088
23089
23090
23091 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23092 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23093 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23094 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23095 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23096 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23097 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23098 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23099 &"local delivery failed"&.
23100
23101 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23102 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23103 will be sent as normal.
23104
23105 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23106 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23107 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23108 apply in this case.
23109
23110 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23111 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23112 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23113 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23114
23115 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23116 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23117 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23118 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23119 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23120 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23121 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23122 &%temp_errors%&.
23123
23124
23125
23126 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23127 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23128 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23129 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23130 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23131 run.
23132
23133 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23134 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23135 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23136 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23137
23138 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23139 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23140 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23141 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23142 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23143 .code
23144 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23145 .endd
23146 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23147 arguments. You have to write
23148 .code
23149 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23150 .endd
23151 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23152 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23153 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23154 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23155 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23156 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23157 example:
23158 .code
23159 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23160 .endd
23161
23162 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23163 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23164 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23165 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23166 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23167 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23168 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23169 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23170 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23171 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23172
23173 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23174 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23175 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23176 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23177 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23178 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23179 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23180 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23181
23182 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23183 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23184 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23185 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23186 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23187 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23188 control what is done with it.
23189
23190 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23191 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23192 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23193 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23194 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23195 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23196 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23197 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23198 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23199 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23200 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23201
23202
23203
23204 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23205 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23206 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23207 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23208 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23209 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23210 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23211 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23212 .display
23213 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23214 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23215 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23216 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23217 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23218 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23219 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23220 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23221 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23222 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23223 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23224 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23225 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23226 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23227 &`USER `& see below
23228 .endd
23229 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23230 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23231 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23232 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23233 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23234 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23235 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23236
23237 .cindex "HOST"
23238 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23239 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23240 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23241 the router.
23242
23243 .cindex "HOME"
23244 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23245 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23246 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23247 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23248
23249
23250 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23251 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23252
23253
23254
23255 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23256 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23257 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23258 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23259 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23260 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23261 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23262 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23263 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23264 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23265 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23266 example, if
23267 .code
23268 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23269 .endd
23270 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23271 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23272 &%use_shell%& is set.
23273
23274
23275 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23276 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23277
23278
23279 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23280 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23281 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23282
23283
23284 .option check_string pipe string unset
23285 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23286 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23287 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23288 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23289 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23290 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23291 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23292 ignored.
23293
23294
23295 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23296 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23297 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23298 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23299 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23300 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23301 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23302
23303
23304 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23305 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23306 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23307 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23308 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23309 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23310 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23311
23312
23313 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23314 See &%check_string%& above.
23315
23316
23317 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23318 .cindex "exec failure"
23319 .cindex "failure of exec"
23320 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23321 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23322 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23323 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23324 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23325
23326
23327 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23328 .cindex "signal exit"
23329 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23330 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23331 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23332 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23333
23334
23335 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23336 .cindex "force command"
23337 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23338 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23339 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23340 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23341 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23342 command. For example:
23343 .code
23344 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23345 force_command
23346 .endd
23347
23348 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23349 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23350 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23351
23352
23353 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23354 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23355 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23356 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23357 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23358 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23359
23360 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23361 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23362
23363
23364 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23365 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23366 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23367 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23368 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23369 written to the main log.
23370
23371
23372 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23373 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23374 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23375 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23376 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23377 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23378 be set.
23379
23380
23381 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23382 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23383 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23384 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23385 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23386
23387
23388 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23389 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23390 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23391 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23392 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23393 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23394 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23395 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23396
23397
23398 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23399 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23400 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23401 .code
23402 message_prefix = \
23403 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23404 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23405 .endd
23406 .cindex "Cyrus"
23407 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23408 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23409 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23410 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23411 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23412 setting
23413 .code
23414 message_prefix =
23415 .endd
23416 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23417 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23418
23419
23420 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23421 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23422 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23423 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23424 .code
23425 message_suffix =
23426 .endd
23427 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23428 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23429
23430
23431 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23432 This option is expanded and
23433 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23434 variable of the subprocess.
23435 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23436 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23437 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23438
23439
23440 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23441 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23442 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23443 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23444 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23445 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23446 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23447 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23448 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23449
23450
23451 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23452 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23453 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23454 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23455 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23456 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23457 accept the message is used.
23458
23459
23460 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23461 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23462 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23463 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23464 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23465 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23466
23467
23468 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23469 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23470 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23471 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23472 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23473 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23474 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23475
23476
23477
23478 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23479 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23480 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23481 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23482 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23483 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23484 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23485 of them may be set.
23486
23487
23488
23489 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23490 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23491 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23492 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23493 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23494 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23495 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23496 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23497 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23498 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23499 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23500 and 73, respectively.
23501
23502
23503 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23504 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23505 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23506 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23507 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23508 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23509 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23510
23511 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23512 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23513 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23514 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23515 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23516 delivery to be deferred.
23517
23518 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23519 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23520
23521
23522 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23523 .cindex "envelope sender"
23524 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23525 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23526 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23527 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23528 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23529
23530 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23531 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23532 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23533 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23534 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23535 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23536 class database.
23537
23538
23539 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23540 .cindex "carriage return"
23541 .cindex "linefeed"
23542 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23543 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23544 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23545 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23546
23547 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23548 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23549 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23550 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23551 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23552
23553
23554 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23555 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23556 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23557 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23558 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23559 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23560 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23561 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23562 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23563 its &%-c%& option.
23564
23565
23566
23567 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23568 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23569 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23570 .cindex "external local delivery"
23571 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23572 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23573 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23574 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23575 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23576 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23577 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23578 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23579 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23580 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23581 .code
23582 # transport
23583 procmail_pipe:
23584 driver = pipe
23585 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23586 return_path_add
23587 delivery_date_add
23588 envelope_to_add
23589 check_string = "From "
23590 escape_string = ">From "
23591 umask = 077
23592 user = $local_part
23593 group = mail
23594
23595 # router
23596 procmail:
23597 driver = accept
23598 check_local_user
23599 transport = procmail_pipe
23600 .endd
23601 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23602 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23603 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23604 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23605 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23606 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23607
23608 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23609 .code
23610 IFS=" "
23611 .endd
23612 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23613 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23614
23615 .cindex "Cyrus"
23616 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23617 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23618 .code
23619 # transport
23620 local_delivery_cyrus:
23621 driver = pipe
23622 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23623 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23624 user = cyrus
23625 group = mail
23626 return_output
23627 log_output
23628 message_prefix =
23629 message_suffix =
23630
23631 # router
23632 local_user_cyrus:
23633 driver = accept
23634 check_local_user
23635 local_part_suffix = .*
23636 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23637 .endd
23638 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23639 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23640 sender.
23641 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23642 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23643
23644
23645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23647
23648 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23649 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23650 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23651 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23652 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23653 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23654 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23655 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23656
23657
23658 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23659 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23660 two ways:
23661
23662 .ilist
23663 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23664 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23665 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23666 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23667 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23668 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23669 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23670 .next
23671 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23672 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23673 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23674 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23675 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23676 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23677 process.
23678 .endlist
23679
23680
23681 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23682 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23683 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23684
23685
23686
23687 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23688 .vindex "&$host$&"
23689 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23690 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23691 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23692 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23693 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23694 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23695 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23696 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23697
23698
23699 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23700 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23701 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23702 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23703 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23704 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23705 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23706 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23707 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23708 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23709 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23710 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23711 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23712 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23713
23714 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23715 and will be removed in a future release.
23716
23717
23718 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23719 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23720 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23721
23722
23723 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23724 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23725 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23726 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23727 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23728 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23729 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23730 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23731
23732 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23733 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23734 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23735 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23736 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23737 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23738 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23739 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23740 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23741
23742
23743 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23744 .cindex "Cyrus"
23745 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23746 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23747 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23748 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23749 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23750 ignored.
23751
23752 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23753 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23754 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23755 particular connection.
23756
23757 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23758 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23759 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23760 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23761
23762 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23763 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23764 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23765 .code
23766 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23767 .endd
23768 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23769 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23770
23771 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23772 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23773 value.
23774
23775
23776 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23777 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23778 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23779 authenticated as a client.
23780
23781
23782 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23783 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23784 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23785 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23786
23787
23788 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23789 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23790 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23791 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23792 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23793 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23794 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23795
23796
23797 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23798 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23799 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23800 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23801 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23802 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23803 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23804 option.
23805
23806
23807 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23808 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23809 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23810 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23811
23812
23813 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23814 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23815 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23816 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23817 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23818 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23819 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23820 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23821 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23822
23823
23824 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23825 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23826 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23827 cutoff times.
23828
23829 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23830 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23831 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23832 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23833 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23834 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23835
23836 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23837 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23838 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23839 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23840 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23841 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23842 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23843 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23844 to them.
23845
23846
23847 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23848 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23849 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23850 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23851 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23852
23853
23854 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23855 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23856 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23857 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23858 details.
23859
23860
23861 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23862 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23863 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23864 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23865 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23866 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23867 the dnssec request bit set.
23868 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23869
23870
23871
23872 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23873 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23874 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23875 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23876 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23877 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
23878 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23879 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23880 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23881
23882
23883
23884 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23885 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23886 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23887 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23888 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23889 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23890 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23891
23892 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23893 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23894 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23895 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23896 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23897
23898
23899 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23900 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23901 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23902 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23903 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23904 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23905 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23906 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23907
23908 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23909 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23910 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23911 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23912 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23913 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23914
23915 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23916 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23917 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23918 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23919 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23920
23921 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23922 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23923 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23924 copy of the message is sent.
23925
23926 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23927 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23928 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23929 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23930 fails"& facility.
23931
23932
23933 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23934 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23935 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23936 zero.
23937
23938 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23939 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23940 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23941 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23942 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23943 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23944
23945 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23946 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23947 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23948 implementations of TLS.
23949
23950 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23951 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23952 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23953 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23954 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23955 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23956 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23957 option is:
23958 .code
23959 $primary_hostname
23960 .endd
23961 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23962 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23963 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23964 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23965 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23966 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23967 interface address, you could use this:
23968 .code
23969 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23970 {$primary_hostname}}
23971 .endd
23972 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23973 callouts.
23974
23975 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23976 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23977 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23978 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23979 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23980 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23981
23982 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23983 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23984 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23985 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23986
23987 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23988 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23989 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23990 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23991 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23992 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23993 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23994
23995 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23996 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23997 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23998 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23999 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24000 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24001 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24002 address are used.
24003
24004 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24005 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24006
24007
24008 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24009 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24010 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24011 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24012 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24013 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24014 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24015 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24016 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24017 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24018
24019
24020 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24021 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24022 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24023 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24024
24025
24026 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24027 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24028 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24029 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24030
24031 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24032 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24033 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24034 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24035 to any host that matches this list.
24036
24037
24038 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24039 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24040 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24041 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24042 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24043 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24044 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24045 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24046
24047
24048 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24049 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24050 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24051 why it exists.
24052
24053
24054
24055 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24056 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24057 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24058 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24059 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24060 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24061 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24062 explanation of when this might be needed.
24063
24064 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24065 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24066 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24067 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24068 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24069 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24070 message on the same session.
24071
24072 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24073 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24074 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24075 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24076 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24077 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24078 logging.
24079
24080
24081
24082 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24083 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24084 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24085 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24086 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24087
24088
24089 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24090 .cindex "randomized host list"
24091 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24092 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24093 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24094 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24095 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24096 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24097 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24098 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24099
24100 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24101 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24102 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24103 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24104 .code
24105 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24106 .endd
24107 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24108 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24109 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24110
24111 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24112 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24113 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24114 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24115 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24116 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24117 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24118 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24119 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24120
24121
24122 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24123 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24124 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24125 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24126 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24127
24128 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24129 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24130 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24131 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24132 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24133
24134 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24135 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24136 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24137 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24138 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24139 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24140
24141 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24142 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24143 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24144 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24145 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24146 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24147 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24148
24149 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24150 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24151 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24152 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24153 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24154 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24155 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24156
24157 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24158 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24159 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24160 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24161 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24162 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24163 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24164 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24165 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24166 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24167
24168 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24169 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24170
24171 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24172 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24173 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24174 it it is always enebled. Note that legthy operations in the connect ACL,
24175 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24176
24177 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24178 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24179 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24180 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24181 for multi-recipient messages.
24182 The option can usually be left as default.
24183
24184 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24185 .cindex "bind IP address"
24186 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24187 .vindex "&$host$&"
24188 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24189 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24190 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24191 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24192 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24193 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24194 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24195 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24196 unknown.
24197
24198 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24199 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24200 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24201 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24202 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24203 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24204 .code
24205 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24206 .endd
24207 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24208 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24209 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24210 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24211
24212
24213 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24214 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24215 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24216 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24217 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24218 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24219 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24220 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24221 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24222 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24223 unreachable hosts.
24224
24225
24226 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24227 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24228 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24229 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24230 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24231
24232 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24233 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24234 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24235 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24236 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24237 permits this.
24238
24239
24240 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24241 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24242 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24243 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24244 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24245 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24246 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24247 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24248
24249 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24250 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24251 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24252
24253 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24254 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24255 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24256 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24257 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24258 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24259 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24260 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24261
24262 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24263 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24264 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24265 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24266 is deferred.
24267
24268
24269
24270 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24271 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24272 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24273 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24274 .vindex "&$port$&"
24275 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24276 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24277 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24278 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24279 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24280
24281 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24282 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24283 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24284 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24285
24286
24287 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24288 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24289 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24290 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24291 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24292 addresses is not affected.
24293
24294 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24295 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24296 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24297 Exim to use only the host name.
24298 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24299
24300
24301 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24302 .cindex "serializing connections"
24303 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24304 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24305 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24306 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24307 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24308 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24309 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24310
24311 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24312 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24313 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24314 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24315 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24316 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24317
24318 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24319 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24320 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24321 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24322 are used for ETRN serialization.
24323
24324 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24325
24326
24327 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24328 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24329 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24330 .cindex "size" "of message"
24331 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24332 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24333 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24334 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24335 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24336 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24337 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24338 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24339
24340 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24341 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24342
24343
24344 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24345 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24346 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24347 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24348
24349
24350 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24351 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24352 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24353 .vindex "&$host$&"
24354 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24355 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24356 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24357 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24358 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24359 details of TLS.
24360
24361 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24362 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24363 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24364 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24365 client.
24366
24367
24368 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24369 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24370 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24371 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24372 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24373
24374
24375 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24376 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24377 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24378 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24379 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24380 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24381 will fail.
24382
24383 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24384
24385
24386 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24387 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24388 .vindex "&$host$&"
24389 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24390 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24391 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24392 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24393 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24394 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24395 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24396 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24397
24398
24399 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24400 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24401 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24402 .vindex "&$host$&"
24403 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24404 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24405 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24406 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24407 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24408 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24409 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24410 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24411 ciphers is a preference order.
24412
24413
24414
24415 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24416 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24417 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24418 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24419 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24420 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24421 certificate and private key for the session.
24422
24423 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24424
24425 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24426 TLS extensions.
24427
24428
24429
24430
24431 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24432 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24433 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24434 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24435 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24436 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24437 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24438 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24439 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24440 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24441 in clear.
24442
24443
24444 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24445 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24446 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24447 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24448 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24449 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24450 Note that unless the host is in this list
24451 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24452 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24453 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24454 certificate verification succeeds.
24455
24456
24457 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24458 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24459 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24460 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24461 while verifying the server certificate,
24462 checks will be included on the host name
24463 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24464 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24465 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24466
24467 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24468
24469
24470 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24471 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24472 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24473 .vindex "&$host$&"
24474 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24475 The value of this option must be either the
24476 word "system"
24477 or the absolute path to
24478 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24479 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24480
24481 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24482 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24483 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24484 must be specified.
24485
24486 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24487 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24488
24489 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24490 explicitly
24491 either by file or directory
24492 are added to those given by the system default location.
24493
24494 The values of &$host$& and
24495 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24496 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24497
24498 For back-compatibility,
24499 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24500 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24501 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24502
24503
24504 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24505 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24506 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24507 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24508 certificate verification must succeed.
24509 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24510 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24511 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24512
24513
24514
24515
24516 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24517 "SECTvalhosmax"
24518 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24519 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24520 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24521 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24522 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24523
24524
24525 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24526 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24527 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24528 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24529 retrying.
24530
24531 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24532 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24533 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24534
24535 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24536 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24537 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24538 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24539 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24540
24541 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24542 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24543 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24544 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24545 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24546 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24547 see below for an exception).
24548
24549 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24550 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24551 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24552 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24553 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24554
24555 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24556 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24557 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24558 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24559 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24560 reached their retry times.
24561
24562 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24563 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24564 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24565 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24566 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24567 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24568 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24569 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24570 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24571 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24572 reached.
24573
24574 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24575 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24576 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24577 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24578 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24579 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24580
24581 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24582 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24583 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24584 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24585 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24586 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24587
24588
24589
24590
24591
24592 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24594
24595 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24596 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24597 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24598 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24599 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24600 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24601
24602 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24603 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24604 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24605 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24606 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24607 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24608 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24609
24610 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24611 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24612 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24613 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24614
24615
24616 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24617 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24618 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24619 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24620
24621 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24622 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24623 facility; you do not have to use it.
24624
24625 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24626 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24627 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24628 address to which it applies.
24629
24630 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24631 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24632 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24633 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24634 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24635 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24636 rules.
24637
24638 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24639 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24640 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24641 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24642
24643
24644 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24645 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24646 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24647 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24648 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24649 discouraged.
24650
24651 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24652 illustrated by these examples:
24653
24654 .ilist
24655 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24656 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24657 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24658 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24659 .next
24660 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24661 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24662 .endlist
24663
24664
24665
24666 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24667 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24668 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24669 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24670 message's processing.
24671
24672 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24673 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24674 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24675 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24676 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24677 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24678 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24679 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24680 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24681
24682 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24683 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24684 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24685 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24686 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24687 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24688 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24689 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24690 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24691 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24692
24693 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24694 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24695 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24696 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24697 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24698 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24699
24700 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24701 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24702 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24703
24704 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24705 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24706 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24707 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24708 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24709 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24710 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24711 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24712 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24713
24714 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24715 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24716 transport time.
24717
24718
24719
24720
24721 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24722 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24723 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24724 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24725 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24726 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24727 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24728 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24729 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24730 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24731 .code
24732 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24733 .endd
24734 might produce the output
24735 .code
24736 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24737 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24738 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24739 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24740 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24741 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24742 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24743 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24744 .endd
24745 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24746 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24747 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24748 set for a particular transport.
24749
24750
24751 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24752 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24753 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24754 rules in the form
24755 .display
24756 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24757 .endd
24758 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24759 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24760 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24761 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24762
24763 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24764 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24765 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24766 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24767 ignored.
24768
24769 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24770 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24771 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24772
24773 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24774 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24775 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24776 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24777 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24778 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24779 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24780
24781 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24782 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24783 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24784 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24785 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24786 .code
24787 *@* ${lookup ...
24788 .endd
24789 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24790 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24791
24792
24793 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24794 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24795 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24796 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24797 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24798 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24799 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24800 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24801 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24802
24803 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24804 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24805 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24806
24807 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24808 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24809 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24810 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24811 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24812 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24813 of pattern they are set as follows:
24814
24815 .ilist
24816 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24817 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24818 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24819 pattern
24820 .code
24821 *queen@*.fict.example
24822 .endd
24823 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24824 .code
24825 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24826 $1 = hearts-
24827 $2 = wonderland
24828 .endd
24829 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24830 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24831
24832 .next
24833 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24834 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24835 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24836 rewriting rule of the form
24837 .display
24838 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24839 .endd
24840 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24841 .code
24842 $1 = foo
24843 $2 = bar
24844 $3 = baz.example
24845 .endd
24846 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24847 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24848 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24849 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24850 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24851 .endlist
24852
24853
24854 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24855 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24856 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24857 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24858 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24859 .code
24860 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24861 .endd
24862 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24863 &'From:'& headers.
24864
24865 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24866 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24867 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24868 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24869 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24870 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24871 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24872 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24873 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24874 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24875 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24876 entry written to the panic log.
24877
24878
24879
24880 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24881 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24882
24883 .ilist
24884 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24885 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24886 .next
24887 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24888 .next
24889 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24890 .endlist
24891
24892 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24893 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24894
24895
24896
24897 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24898 "SECID154"
24899 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24900 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24901 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24902 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24903 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24904 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24905 .display
24906 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24907 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24908 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24909 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24910 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24911 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24912 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24913 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24914 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24915 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24916 .endd
24917 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24918 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24919 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24920
24921 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24922 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24923
24924
24925 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24926 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24927 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24928 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24929 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24930 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24931 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24932 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24933 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24934
24935 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24936 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24937 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24938 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24939 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24940 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24941 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24942 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24943
24944
24945 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24946 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24947 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24948 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24949
24950 .ilist
24951 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24952 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24953 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24954 .next
24955 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24956 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24957 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24958 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24959 .next
24960 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24961 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24962 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24963 .next
24964 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24965 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24966 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24967 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24968 .code
24969 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24970 .endd
24971 into
24972 .code
24973 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24974 .endd
24975 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24976 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24977 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24978 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24979 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24980 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24981 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24982 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24983 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24984
24985 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24986 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24987 .endlist
24988
24989
24990 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24991 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24992 .code
24993 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24994 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24995 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24996 .endd
24997 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24998 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24999 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25000 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25001 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25002 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25003 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25004 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25005
25006 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25007 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25008 .code
25009 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25010 .endd
25011 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25012 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25013
25014 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25015 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25016 messages that originate outside the local host:
25017 .code
25018 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25019 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25020 .endd
25021 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25022 space.
25023
25024 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25025 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25026 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25027 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25028 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25029 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25030 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25031 components. For example, the rule
25032 .code
25033 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25034 .endd
25035 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25036 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25037 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25038 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25039 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25040 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25041 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25042 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25043
25044
25045
25046
25047
25048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25050
25051 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25052 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25053 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25054 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25055 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25056 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25057 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25058 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25059 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25060 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25061 address, domain and error.
25062
25063 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25064 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25065 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25066 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25067 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25068 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25069 log selector is set, the message
25070 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25071 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25072 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25073 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25074
25075 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25076 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25077 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25078 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25079 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25080 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25081 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25082 domain are maintained independently.
25083
25084 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25085 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25086 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25087 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25088 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25089 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25090 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25091 the local address is reached.
25092
25093 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25094 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25095 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25096 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25097 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25098
25099 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25100 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25101 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25102 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25103 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25104 messages that it should now be retaining.
25105
25106
25107
25108 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25109 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25110 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25111 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25112 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25113 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25114 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25115 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25116 message's sender, respectively.
25117
25118
25119 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25120 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25121 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25122 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25123 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25124 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25125 example,
25126 .code
25127 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25128 .endd
25129 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25130 whereas
25131 .code
25132 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25133 .endd
25134 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25135 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25136 part.
25137
25138 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25139 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25140 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25141 expressions work in address lists.
25142 .display
25143 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25144 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25145 .endd
25146
25147
25148 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25149 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25150 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25151 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25152 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25153 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25154 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25155 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25156 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25157
25158 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25159 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25160 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25161 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25162 local transports).
25163
25164 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25165 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25166 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25167 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25168 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25169 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25170 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25171 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25172 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25173 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25174 commands.
25175
25176
25177
25178 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25179 "SECID160"
25180 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25181 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25182 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25183 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25184 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25185 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25186 .code
25187 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25188 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25189 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25190 .endd
25191 and the retry rules are
25192 .code
25193 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25194 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25195 .endd
25196 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25197 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25198 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25199 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25200 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25201 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25202
25203 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25204 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25205 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25206 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25207
25208 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25209 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25210 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25211 .code
25212 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25213 .endd
25214 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25215 textual form of the IP address.
25216
25217 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25218 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25219 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25220 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25221
25222 .vlist
25223 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25224 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25225 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25226
25227 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25228 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25229 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25230
25231 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25232 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25233
25234 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25235 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25236 .endlist
25237
25238 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25239 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25240 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25241 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25242 retry rule of this form:
25243 .code
25244 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25245 .endd
25246 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25247 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25248
25249 .vlist
25250 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25251 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25252 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25253 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25254
25255 .vitem &%lookup%&
25256 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25257 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25258 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25259 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25260 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25261
25262 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25263 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25264
25265 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25266 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25267
25268 .vitem &%refused%&
25269 A connection was refused.
25270
25271 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25272 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25273
25274 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25275 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25276
25277 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25278 A connection attempt timed out.
25279
25280 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25281 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25282 obtained from an MX record.
25283
25284 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25285 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25286 obtained from an MX record.
25287
25288 .vitem &%timeout%&
25289 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25290
25291 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25292 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25293 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25294 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25295
25296 .vitem &%quota%&
25297 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25298 transport.
25299
25300 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25301 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25302 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25303 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25304 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25305 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25306 for four days.
25307 .endlist
25308
25309 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25310 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25311 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25312 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25313 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25314 heuristic rules:
25315
25316 .ilist
25317 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25318 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25319 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25320 .next
25321 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25322 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25323 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25324 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25325 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25326 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25327 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25328 .next
25329 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25330 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25331 .endlist
25332
25333 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25334 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25335 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25336 error).
25337
25338
25339
25340 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25341 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25342 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25343 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25344 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25345 form:
25346 .display
25347 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25348 .endd
25349 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25350 .code
25351 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25352 .endd
25353 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25354 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25355 For example:
25356 .code
25357 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25358 .endd
25359 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25360 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25361 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25362 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25363 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25364
25365 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25366 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25367 .code
25368 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25369 .endd
25370 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25371 list is never matched.
25372
25373
25374
25375
25376
25377 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25378 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25379 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25380 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25381 .display
25382 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25383 .endd
25384 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25385 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25386 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25387 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25388 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25389
25390 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25391 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25392 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25393 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25394 The available algorithms are:
25395
25396 .ilist
25397 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25398 the interval.
25399 .next
25400 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25401 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25402 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25403 .next
25404 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25405 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25406 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25407 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25408 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25409 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25410 queue processing times.
25411 .endlist
25412
25413 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25414 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25415 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25416 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25417 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25418 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25419 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25420 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25421 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25422 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25423 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25424 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25425
25426 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25427 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25428 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25429 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25430 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25431 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25432 time.
25433
25434 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25435 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25436 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25437 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25438 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25439 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25440 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25441 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25442 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25443 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25444 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25445 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25446
25447 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25448 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25449 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25450 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25451 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25452 deliveries that have been deferred.
25453
25454
25455 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25456 Here are some example retry rules:
25457 .code
25458 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25459 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25460 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25461 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25462 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25463 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25464 .endd
25465 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25466 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25467 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25468 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25469 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25470 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25471 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25472 days.
25473
25474 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25475 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25476 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25477 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25478 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25479
25480 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25481 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25482 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25483 were not obtained from an MX record.
25484
25485 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25486 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25487 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25488 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25489 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25490
25491
25492
25493 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25494 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25495 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25496 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25497 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25498 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25499 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25500 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25501 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25502 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25503 failing for the first time.
25504
25505 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25506 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25507 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25508 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25509
25510 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25511 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25512 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25513
25514
25515
25516
25517 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25518 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25519 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25520 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25521 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25522 default retry rule:
25523 .code
25524 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25525 .endd
25526 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25527 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25528 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25529
25530 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25531 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25532 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25533 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25534 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25535
25536 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25537 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25538 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25539
25540 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25541 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25542 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25543 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25544 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25545 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25546 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25547 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25548
25549 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25550 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25551 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25552 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25553 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25554 notice.
25555
25556 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25557 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25558 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25559 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25560 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25561 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25562 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25563 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25564 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25565 true.
25566
25567 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25568 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25569 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25570 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25571 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25572 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25573 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25574 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25575 reached.
25576
25577 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25578 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25579 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25580 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25581 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25582 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25583 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25584 time out the address.
25585
25586 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25587 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25588 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25589 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25590 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25591 considered immediately.
25592 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25593 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25594
25595
25596
25597
25598
25599
25600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25602
25603 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25604 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25605 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25606 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25607 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25608 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25609 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25610 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25611 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25612 other.
25613
25614 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25615 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25616
25617 .ilist
25618 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25619 the client's EHLO command.
25620 .next
25621 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25622 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25623 .next
25624 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25625 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25626 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25627 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25628 with the AUTH command.
25629 .next
25630 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25631 .next
25632 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25633 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25634 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25635 connection.
25636 .next
25637 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25638 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25639 unauthenticated connection.
25640 .endlist
25641
25642 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25643 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25644 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25645 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25646 .display
25647 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25648 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25649 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25650 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25651 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25652 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25653 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25654 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25655 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25656 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25657 &`250 HELP`&
25658 .endd
25659 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25660 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25661 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25662 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25663 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25664 included by setting
25665 .code
25666 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25667 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25668 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25669 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25670 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25671 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25672 AUTH_SPA=yes
25673 AUTH_TLS=yes
25674 .endd
25675 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25676 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25677 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25678 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25679 work via a socket interface.
25680 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25681 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25682 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25683 supporting setting a server keytab.
25684 The sixth can be configured to support
25685 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25686 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25687 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25688 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25689 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25690
25691 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25692 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25693 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25694 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25695 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25696 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25697 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25698
25699 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25700 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25701 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25702 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25703 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25704 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25705 .code
25706 cram:
25707 driver = cram_md5
25708 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25709 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25710 client_name = ph10
25711 client_secret = secret2
25712 .endd
25713 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25714 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25715
25716 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25717 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25718 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25719 in Exim.
25720
25721 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25722 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25723 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25724 authenticating data.
25725
25726 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25727 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25728 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25729 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25730 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25731 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25732 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25733 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25734 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25735 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25736 choose to honour.
25737
25738 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25739 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25740 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25741 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25742
25743
25744
25745 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25746 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25747 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25748
25749 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25750 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25751 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25752 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25753 encrypted by a setting such as:
25754 .code
25755 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25756 .endd
25757
25758
25759 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25760 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25761 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25762 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25763
25764
25765 .option driver authenticators string unset
25766 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25767 authenticators is to be used.
25768
25769
25770 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25771 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25772 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25773 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25774 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25775 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25776
25777
25778 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25779 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25780 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25781 mechanism is not advertised.
25782 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25783 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25784 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25785
25786
25787 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25788 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25789 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25790 for details.
25791
25792 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25793 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25794
25795 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25796 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25797 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25798 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25799 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25800 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25801 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25802 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25803 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25804 the error text.
25805
25806
25807 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25808 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25809 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25810 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25811 out the values of variables.
25812 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25813 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25814
25815
25816 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25817 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25818 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25819 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25820 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25821 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25822 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25823 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25824 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25825
25826
25827 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25828 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25829 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25830 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25831 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25832 remembered for later use.
25833 How it is used is described in the following section.
25834
25835
25836
25837
25838
25839 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25840 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25841 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25842 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25843 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25844 message:
25845
25846 .ilist
25847 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25848 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25849 .next
25850 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25851 .next
25852 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25853 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25854 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25855 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25856 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25857 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25858 given for the MAIL command.
25859 .next
25860 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25861 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25862 authenticated.
25863 .next
25864 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25865 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25866 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25867 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25868 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25869 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25870 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25871 message.
25872 .endlist
25873
25874
25875 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25876 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25877 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25878 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25879
25880 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25881 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25882 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25883 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25884 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25885 ACL is run.
25886
25887
25888
25889 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25890 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25891 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25892 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25893 conditions:
25894
25895 .ilist
25896 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25897 .next
25898 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25899 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25900 .endlist
25901
25902 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25903 the mechanisms are advertised.
25904
25905 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25906 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25907 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25908 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25909 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25910 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25911 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25912 .code
25913 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25914 .endd
25915 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25916
25917 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25918 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25919 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25920 such as:
25921 .code
25922 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25923 .endd
25924 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25925 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25926 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25927
25928 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25929 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25930 command. This is the case if
25931
25932 .ilist
25933 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25934 .next
25935 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25936 .next
25937 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25938 server authenticators.
25939 .endlist
25940
25941
25942 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25943 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25944 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25945
25946 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25947 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25948 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25949 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25950 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25951 rejected with a 504 error.
25952
25953 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25954 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25955 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25956 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25957 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25958 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25959 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25960 no successful authentication.
25961
25962
25963
25964
25965 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25966 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25967 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25968 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25969 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25970 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25971 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25972 script:
25973 .code
25974 use MIME::Base64;
25975 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25976 .endd
25977 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25978 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25979 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25980 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25981 command line to run this script on such data might be
25982 .code
25983 encode '\0user\0password'
25984 .endd
25985 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25986 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25987 whose code value is zero.
25988
25989 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25990 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25991 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25992 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25993
25994 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25995 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25996 example, a command such as
25997 .code
25998 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25999 .endd
26000 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26001
26002 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26003 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26004 .code
26005 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26006 .endd
26007 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26008 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26009 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26010 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26011
26012
26013
26014 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26015 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26016 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26017 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26018 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26019 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26020
26021 .ilist
26022 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26023 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26024 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26025 of the authenticator.
26026 .next
26027 .vindex "&$host$&"
26028 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26029 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26030 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26031 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26032 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26033 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26034 delivery to be deferred.
26035 .next
26036 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26037 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26038 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26039 usual way.
26040 .next
26041 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26042 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26043 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26044 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26045 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26046 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26047 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26048 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26049 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26050 .endlist
26051
26052 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26053 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26054 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26055 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26056 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26057 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26058 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26059 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26060
26061 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26062
26063 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26064 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26065 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26066 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26067 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26068 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26069 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26070 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26071 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26072 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26073 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26074 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26075 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26076
26077
26078
26079
26080
26081
26082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26084
26085 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26086 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26087 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26088 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26089 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26090 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26091 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26092 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26093 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26094 connections as you do for login accounts.
26095
26096 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26097 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26098 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26099
26100 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26101 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26102 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26103
26104 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26105 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26106 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26107 given.
26108
26109 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26110 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26111 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26112 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26113 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26114 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26115 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26116
26117 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26118 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26119 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26120 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26121 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26122 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26123 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26124
26125 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26126 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26127 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26128 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26129
26130 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26131 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26132 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26133
26134 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26135 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26136 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26137 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26138 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26139 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26140 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26141 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26142 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26143 string as the error text
26144
26145 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26146 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26147 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26148
26149
26150
26151 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26152 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26153 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26154 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26155 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26156 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26157 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26158 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26159
26160 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26161 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26162 configured as follows:
26163 .code
26164 fixed_plain:
26165 driver = plaintext
26166 public_name = PLAIN
26167 server_prompts = :
26168 server_condition = \
26169 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26170 server_set_id = $auth2
26171 .endd
26172 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26173 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26174 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26175 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26176
26177 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26178 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26179 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26180 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26181 .code
26182 250-AUTH PLAIN
26183 .endd
26184 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26185 .code
26186 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26187 .endd
26188 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26189 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26190 .code
26191 AUTH PLAIN
26192 .endd
26193 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26194 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26195
26196 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26197 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26198 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26199 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26200 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26201
26202 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26203 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26204 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26205
26206 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26207 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26208 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26209 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26210 This is an incorrect example:
26211 .code
26212 server_condition = \
26213 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26214 .endd
26215 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26216 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26217 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26218 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26219 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26220 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26221 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26222 .code
26223 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26224 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26225 .endd
26226 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26227 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26228 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26229 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26230 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26231
26232
26233 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26234 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26235 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26236 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26237 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26238 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26239 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26240 .code
26241 fixed_login:
26242 driver = plaintext
26243 public_name = LOGIN
26244 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26245 server_condition = \
26246 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26247 server_set_id = $auth1
26248 .endd
26249 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26250 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26251 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26252 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26253
26254 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26255 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26256 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26257 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26258 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26259 .code
26260 login:
26261 driver = plaintext
26262 public_name = LOGIN
26263 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26264 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26265 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26266 ldapauth{\
26267 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26268 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26269 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26270 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26271 .endd
26272 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26273 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26274 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26275 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26276 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26277 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26278 uninterpreted string.
26279
26280
26281 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26282 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26283 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26284 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26285 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26286 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26287
26288
26289
26290
26291 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26292 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26293 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26294
26295 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26296 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26297 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26298 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26299 usual.
26300
26301 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26302 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26303 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26304 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26305 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26306 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26307 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26308 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26309 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26310 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26311 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26312 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26313
26314 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26315 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26316
26317 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26318 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26319 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26320 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26321 the string.
26322
26323 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26324 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26325 .code
26326 fixed_plain:
26327 driver = plaintext
26328 public_name = PLAIN
26329 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26330 .endd
26331 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26332 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26333 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26334 .code
26335 fixed_login:
26336 driver = plaintext
26337 public_name = LOGIN
26338 client_send = : username : mysecret
26339 .endd
26340 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26341 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26342 prompts.
26343 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26344 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26345
26346
26347
26348
26349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26351
26352 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26353 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26354 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26355 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26356 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26357 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26358 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26359 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26360 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26361 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26362 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26363 available in plain text at either end.
26364
26365
26366 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26367 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26368 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26369 authenticator as a server:
26370
26371 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26372 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26373 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26374 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26375 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26376 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26377 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26378 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26379 returned to the client.
26380
26381 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26382 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26383 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26384 numeric variables for other things.
26385
26386 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26387 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26388 user name, authentication fails.
26389 .code
26390 fixed_cram:
26391 driver = cram_md5
26392 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26393 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26394 server_set_id = $auth1
26395 .endd
26396 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26397 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26398 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26399 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26400 .code
26401 lookup_cram:
26402 driver = cram_md5
26403 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26404 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26405 {$value}fail}
26406 server_set_id = $auth1
26407 .endd
26408 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26409 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26410
26411 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26412 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26413 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26414 realm, with:
26415 .code
26416 cyrusless_crammd5:
26417 driver = cram_md5
26418 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26419 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26420 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26421 server_set_id = $auth1
26422 .endd
26423
26424 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26425 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26426 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26427
26428
26429
26430 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26431 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26432 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26433
26434
26435 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26436 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26437 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26438
26439
26440 .vindex "&$host$&"
26441 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26442 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26443 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26444 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26445 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26446 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26447 send the message to the current server.
26448
26449 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26450 strings, is:
26451 .code
26452 fixed_cram:
26453 driver = cram_md5
26454 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26455 client_name = ph10
26456 client_secret = secret
26457 .endd
26458 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26459 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26460
26461
26462
26463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26465
26466 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26467 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26468 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26469 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26470 .cindex "Kerberos"
26471 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26472 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26473
26474 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26475 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26476 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26477 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26478 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26479
26480 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26481 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26482 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26483 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26484
26485 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26486 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26487 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26488 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26489 depending on the driver you are using.
26490
26491 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26492 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26493 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26494 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26495 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26496 implementation.
26497
26498 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26499 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26500 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26501 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26502 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26503 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26504 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26505 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26506
26507
26508 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26509 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26510 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26511 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26512 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26513 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26514 things.
26515
26516
26517 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26518 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26519 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26520 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26521
26522
26523 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26524 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26525 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26526 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26527 example:
26528 .code
26529 sasl:
26530 driver = cyrus_sasl
26531 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26532 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26533 server_set_id = $auth1
26534 .endd
26535
26536 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26537 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26538
26539
26540 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26541 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26542
26543
26544 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26545 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26546 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26547 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26548 .code
26549 sasl_cram_md5:
26550 driver = cyrus_sasl
26551 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26552 server_set_id = $auth1
26553
26554 sasl_plain:
26555 driver = cyrus_sasl
26556 public_name = PLAIN
26557 server_set_id = $auth2
26558 .endd
26559 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26560 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26561 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26562 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26563 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26564
26565
26566
26567
26568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26570 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26571 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26572 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26573 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26574 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26575 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26576 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26577 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26578 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26579
26580 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26581
26582 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26583 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26584 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26585 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26586 .code
26587 dovecot_plain:
26588 driver = dovecot
26589 public_name = PLAIN
26590 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26591 server_set_id = $auth1
26592
26593 dovecot_ntlm:
26594 driver = dovecot
26595 public_name = NTLM
26596 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26597 server_set_id = $auth1
26598 .endd
26599 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26600 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26601 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26602 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26603 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26604 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26605 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26606 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26607
26608
26609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26611 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26612 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26613 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26614 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26615 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26616 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26617 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26618 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26619 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26620 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26621 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26622 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26623 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26624 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26625 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26626 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26627 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26628 without code changes in Exim.
26629
26630
26631 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26632 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26633 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26634 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26635 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26636 context.
26637
26638 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26639 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26640 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26641
26642 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26643 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26644 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26645
26646 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26647 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26648 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26649
26650
26651 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26652 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26653 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26654 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26655
26656
26657 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26658 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26659 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26660 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26661 example:
26662 .code
26663 sasl:
26664 driver = gsasl
26665 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26666 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26667 server_set_id = $auth1
26668 .endd
26669
26670
26671 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26672 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26673 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26674 the password itself.
26675
26676 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26677 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26678 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26679 if available, else the empty string.
26680 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26681 else the empty string.
26682
26683 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26684
26685 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26686 option to be simply "true".
26687
26688
26689 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26690 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26691 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26692
26693
26694 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26695 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26696 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26697 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26698
26699
26700 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26701 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26702 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26703 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26704
26705
26706 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26707 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26708 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26709
26710
26711 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26712 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26713 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26714 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26715
26716 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26717 meanings for these variables:
26718
26719 .ilist
26720 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26721 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26722 .next
26723 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26724 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26725 .next
26726 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26727 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26728 .endlist
26729
26730 On a per-mechanism basis:
26731
26732 .ilist
26733 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26734 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26735 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26736 .next
26737 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26738 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26739 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26740 .next
26741 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26742 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26743 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26744 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26745 .endlist
26746
26747 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26748 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26749 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26750
26751
26752 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26753 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26754 .code
26755 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26756 driver = gsasl
26757 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26758 server_realm = imap.example.org
26759 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26760 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26761 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26762 server_condition = yes
26763 .endd
26764
26765
26766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26768
26769 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26770 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26771 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26772 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26773 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26774 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26775 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26776 reliably.
26777
26778 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26779 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26780 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26781 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26782
26783 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26784 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26785 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26786 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26787
26788 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26789 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26790 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26791 from the keytab.
26792
26793
26794 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26795 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26796 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26797 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26798
26799 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26800 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26801 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26802 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26803
26804 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26805 .ilist
26806 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26807 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26808 .next
26809 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26810 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26811 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26812 GSS Display Name.
26813 .endlist
26814
26815
26816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26818
26819 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26820 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26821 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26822 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26823 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26824 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26825 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26826 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26827 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26828 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26829 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26830 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26831 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26832 follows:
26833
26834 .ilist
26835 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26836 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26837 .next
26838 The server sends back a challenge.
26839 .next
26840 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26841 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26842 .endlist
26843
26844 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26845
26846
26847
26848 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26849 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26850 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26851
26852 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26853 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26854 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26855 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26856 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26857 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26858 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26859 for other things. For example:
26860 .code
26861 spa:
26862 driver = spa
26863 public_name = NTLM
26864 server_password = \
26865 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26866 .endd
26867 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26868 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26869
26870
26871
26872
26873
26874 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26875 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26876 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26877
26878
26879
26880 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26881 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26882
26883
26884 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26885 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26886
26887
26888 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26889 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26890 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26891 &'msn.com'&:
26892 .code
26893 msn:
26894 driver = spa
26895 public_name = MSN
26896 client_username = msn/msn_username
26897 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26898 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26899 .endd
26900 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26901 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26902
26903
26904
26905
26906
26907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26909
26910 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26911 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26912 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26913 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26914 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26915 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26916 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26917 authentication based on client certificates.
26918
26919 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26920 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26921 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26922 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26923 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26924 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26925
26926 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26927 for which it must have been requested via the
26928 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26929 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26930
26931 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26932 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26933 and can authenticate the connection.
26934 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26935
26936 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26937
26938
26939 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26940 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26941
26942 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26943 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26944 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26945 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26946 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26947 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26948
26949 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26950 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26951 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26952
26953 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26954
26955
26956 Example:
26957 .code
26958 tls:
26959 driver = tls
26960 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26961 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26962 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26963 {!= {0} \
26964 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26965 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26966 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26967 } } } }
26968 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26969 .endd
26970 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26971 of your configured trust-anchors
26972 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26973 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26974 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26975 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26976
26977 . An alternative might use
26978 . .code
26979 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26980 . .endd
26981 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26982 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26983 . This would help for per-device use.
26984 .
26985 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26986 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26987
26988 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26989 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26990
26991
26992 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26993 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26994 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26995
26996
26997
26998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26999 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27000
27001 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27002 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27003 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27004 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27005 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27006 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27007 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27008 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27009 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27010 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27011 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27012 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27013 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27014 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27015 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27016 certificates are used.
27017
27018 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27019 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27020 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27021 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27022 between them is encrypted.
27023
27024 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27025 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27026 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27027 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27028 encryption state.
27029
27030 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27031 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27032 in order to get TLS to work.
27033
27034
27035
27036 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27037 "SECID284"
27038 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27039 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27040 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27041 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27042 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
27043 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
27044 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
27045 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
27046 allocated for this purpose.
27047
27048 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
27049 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
27050 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
27051 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
27052 .code
27053 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27054 .endd
27055 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27056 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27057 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27058 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27059 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27060 defined elsewhere.
27061
27062 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27063 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
27064
27065
27066
27067
27068
27069
27070 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27071 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27072 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27073 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27074 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27075 .code
27076 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27077 .endd
27078 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27079 .code
27080 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27081 .endd
27082 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27083 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27084
27085 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27086
27087 .ilist
27088 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27089 cannot be the path of a directory
27090 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27091 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27092 .next
27093 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27094 .next
27095 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27096 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27097 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27098 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27099 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27100 .next
27101 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27102 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27103 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27104 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27105 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27106 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27107 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27108 option).
27109 .next
27110 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27111 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27112 .next
27113 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27114 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27115 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27116 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27117 .next
27118 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27119 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27120 .next
27121 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27122 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27123 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27124 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27125 .endlist
27126
27127
27128 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27129 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27130 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27131 but not the chosen filename.
27132 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27133 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27134
27135 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27136 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27137 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27138 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27139 of bits requested.
27140 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27141 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27142 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27143 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27144 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27145 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27146 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27147
27148 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27149 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27150 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27151 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27152 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27153
27154 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27155 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27156 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27157 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27158 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27159 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27160
27161 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27162 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27163 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27164
27165 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27166 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27167 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27168 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27169 .code
27170 # ls
27171 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27172 # rm -f new-params
27173 # touch new-params
27174 # chown exim:exim new-params
27175 # chmod 0600 new-params
27176 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27177 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27178 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27179 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27180 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27181 # chmod 0400 new-params
27182 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27183 .endd
27184 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27185 stalling is removed.
27186
27187 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27188 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27189 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27190 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27191 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27192 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27193 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27194 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27195 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27196 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27197 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27198
27199 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27200 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27201 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27202 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27203
27204 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27205 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27206 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27207 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27208 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27209
27210
27211 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27212 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27213 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27214 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27215 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27216 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27217 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27218 directly to this function call.
27219 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27220 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27221 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27222 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27223
27224 .ilist
27225 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27226 .next
27227 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27228 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27229 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27230 SSL v3 algorithms.
27231 .next
27232 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27233 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27234 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27235 algorithms.
27236 .endlist
27237
27238 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27239 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27240 .ilist
27241 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27242 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27243 stated.
27244 .next
27245 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27246 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27247 .next
27248 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27249 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27250 .endlist
27251
27252 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27253 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27254 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27255 not be moved to the end of the list.
27256 .endlist
27257
27258 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27259 string:
27260 .code
27261 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27262 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27263 .endd
27264
27265 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27266 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27267 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27268 choice of clients used:
27269 .code
27270 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27271 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27272 {DEFAULT}\
27273 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27274 .endd
27275
27276 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27277 .code
27278 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27279 .endd
27280
27281
27282 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27283 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27284 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27285 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27286 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27287 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27288 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27289 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27290 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27291 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27292 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27293 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27294
27295 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27296 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27297
27298 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27299 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27300 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27301 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27302 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27303 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27304
27305 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27306 "Priority strings". This is online as
27307 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27308 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27309 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27310 then the example code
27311 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27312 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27313
27314 For example:
27315 .code
27316 # Disable older versions of protocols
27317 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27318 .endd
27319
27320 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27321 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27322 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27323
27324 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27325 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27326 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27327 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27328 used:
27329 .code
27330 # GnuTLS variant
27331 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27332 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27333 {SECURE128}}
27334 .endd
27335
27336
27337 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27338 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27339 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27340 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27341 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27342 that STARTTLS is alway advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27343 this is reasonble for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27344
27345 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27346 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27347
27348 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27349 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27350 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27351 with the error
27352 .code
27353 554 Security failure
27354 .endd
27355 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27356 rejected with a 554 error code.
27357
27358 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27359 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27360
27361 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27362 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27363 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27364 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27365
27366 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27367
27368 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27369 .code
27370 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27371 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27372 .endd
27373 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27374 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27375 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27376 that goes with it. These files need to be
27377 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27378 always be given as full path names.
27379 The key must not be password-protected.
27380 They can be the same file if both the
27381 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27382 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27383 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27384 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27385 the server's certificate.
27386
27387 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27388 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27389 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27390 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27391 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27392 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27393
27394 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27395 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27396 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27397
27398 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27399 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27400 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27401 transport.
27402
27403 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27404 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27405 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27406 .code
27407 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27408 .endd
27409 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27410 with the parameters contained in the file.
27411 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27412 available:
27413 .code
27414 tls_dhparam = none
27415 .endd
27416 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27417 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27418 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27419 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27420
27421 See the command
27422 .code
27423 openssl dhparam
27424 .endd
27425 for a way of generating file data.
27426
27427 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27428 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27429 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27430 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27431 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27432
27433 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27434 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27435 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27436 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27437 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27438 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27439 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27440 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27441 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27442
27443 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27444 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27445 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27446 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27447 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27448 documentation for more details.
27449
27450 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27451 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27452
27453
27454 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27455 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27456 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27457 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27458 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27459 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27460 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27461 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27462 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27463 expected certificates.
27464 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27465 an explicit file or,
27466 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27467 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27468
27469 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27470 directory is used
27471 (OpenSSL only),
27472 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27473 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27474 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27475 .code
27476 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27477 .endd
27478 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27479
27480 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27481 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27482 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27483 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27484 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27485 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27486 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27487 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27488 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27489 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27490
27491 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27492 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27493 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27494 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27495
27496 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27497 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27498 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27499 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27500 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27501 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27502
27503
27504 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27505 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27506 .cindex "revocation list"
27507 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27508 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27509 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27510 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27511 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27512 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27513 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27514 CRL in PEM format.
27515 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27516 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27517
27518 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27519 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27520 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27521 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27522 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27523 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27524
27525 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27526 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27527 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27528 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27529
27530 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27531 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27532 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27533 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27534 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27535 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27536 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27537 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27538
27539 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27540 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27541 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27542
27543 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27544 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27545 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27546 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27547 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27548
27549 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27550 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27551 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27552 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27553 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27554 next connection.
27555
27556 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27557 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27558 ignored.
27559
27560 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27561 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27562 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27563 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27564 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27565 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27566
27567 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27568 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27569
27570 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27571
27572 .code
27573 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27574 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27575 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27576
27577 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27578 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27579 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27580 .endd
27581
27582
27583
27584
27585 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27586 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27587 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27588 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27589 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27590 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27591 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27592 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27593 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27594
27595 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27596 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27597 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27598 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27599 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27600
27601 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27602 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27603 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27604 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27605 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27606 usual way.
27607
27608 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27609 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27610 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27611 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27612 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27613 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27614 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27615 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27616 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27617 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27618 unencrypted.
27619
27620 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27621 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27622 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27623 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27624
27625 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27626 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27627 These may be
27628 the system default set (depending on library version),
27629 a file,
27630 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27631 The client verifies the server's certificate
27632 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27633 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27634 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27635 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27636
27637 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27638 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27639 or need not succeed respectively.
27640
27641 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27642 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27643 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27644 value is empty.
27645 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27646 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27647 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27648 otherwise.
27649
27650 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27651 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27652 for OCSP to be relevant.
27653
27654 If
27655 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27656 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27657 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27658 alternative hosts, if any.
27659
27660 &*Note*&:
27661 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27662 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27663 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27664 client.
27665
27666 .vindex "&$host$&"
27667 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27668 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27669 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27670 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27671 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27672
27673 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27674 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27675 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27676 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27677 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27678 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27679 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27680 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27681 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27682 outgoing connection.
27683
27684
27685
27686 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27687 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27688 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27689 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27690 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27691 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27692 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27693 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27694 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27695 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27696 for this session.
27697
27698 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27699 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27700 address.
27701
27702 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27703 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27704 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27705 be of limited use in that environment.
27706
27707 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27708 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27709 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27710 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27711 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27712
27713 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27714 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27715 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27716 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27717 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27718
27719 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27720 received from a client.
27721 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27722
27723 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27724 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27725 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27726
27727 .ilist
27728 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27729 &%tls_certificate%&
27730 .next
27731 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27732 &%tls_crl%&
27733 .next
27734 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27735 &%tls_privatekey%&
27736 .next
27737 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27738 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27739 .next
27740 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27741 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27742 .endlist
27743
27744 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27745 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27746 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27747 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27748 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27749 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27750 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27751
27752 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27753 are re-expanded.
27754
27755 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27756 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27757 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27758 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27759
27760 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27761 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27762 built, then you have SNI support).
27763
27764
27765
27766 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27767 "SECTmulmessam"
27768 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27769 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27770 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27771 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27772 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27773 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27774 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27775 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27776 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27777 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27778
27779 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27780 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27781 this list the proxy process descibed above is not used; instead Exim
27782 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27783 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27784 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27785 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27786
27787 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27788 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27789 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27790 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27791 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27792 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27793 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27794 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27795 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27796
27797 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27798 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27799 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27800 information is recorded.
27801
27802 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27803 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27804 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27805
27806
27807
27808
27809 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27810 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27811 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27812 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27813 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27814 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27815 to Apache, currently at
27816 .display
27817 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27818 .endd
27819 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27820 links to further files.
27821 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27822 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27823 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27824 .display
27825 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27826 .endd
27827
27828
27829 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27830 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27831 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27832 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27833 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27834 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27835 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27836 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27837 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27838 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27839 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27840 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27841 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27842
27843 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27844 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27845 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27846 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27847
27848
27849
27850 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27851 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27852 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27853 with OpenSSL, like this:
27854 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27855 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27856 .code
27857 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27858 -days 9999 -nodes
27859 .endd
27860 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27861 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27862 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27863 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27864 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27865 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27866 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27867
27868 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27869 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27870 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27871 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27872 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27873 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27874 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27875 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27876 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27877 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27878 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27879 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27880 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27881 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27882 be a sensible resolution).
27883
27884 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27885 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27886 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27887
27888 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27889 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27890 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27891 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27892 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27893 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27894
27895 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27896 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27897 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27898 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27899 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27900 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27901
27902
27903
27904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27906
27907 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27908 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27909 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27910 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27911 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27912 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27913 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27914 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27915 one very small ACL:
27916 .code
27917 begin acl
27918 small_acl:
27919 accept hosts = one.host.only
27920 .endd
27921 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27922 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27923
27924 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27925 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27926 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27927 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27928 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27929 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27930 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27931 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27932
27933
27934 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27935 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27936 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27937
27938
27939 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27940 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27941 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27942 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27943 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27944 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27945 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27946 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27947 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27948 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27949 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27950 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27951 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27952 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27953 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27954 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27955 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27956 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27957 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27958 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27959
27960 .table2 140pt
27961 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27962 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27963 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27964 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27965 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27966 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27967 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27968 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27969 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27970 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27971 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27972 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27973 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27974 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27975 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27976 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27977 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27978 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27979 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27980 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27981 .endtable
27982
27983 For example, if you set
27984 .code
27985 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27986 .endd
27987 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27988 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27989 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27990 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27991 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27992 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27993 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27994
27995
27996 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27997 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27998 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27999 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28000 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28001 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28002 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28003 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28004 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28005 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28006 in any of these ACLs.
28007
28008 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28009 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28010 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28011 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28012 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28013 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28014 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28015 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28016 .code
28017 control = suppress_local_fixups
28018 .endd
28019 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28020 run, it is too late.
28021
28022 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28023 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28024
28025 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28026 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28027 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28028
28029
28030 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28031 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28032 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28033 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28034 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28035 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28036 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28037 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28038 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28039
28040
28041 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28042 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28043 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28044 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28045 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28046 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28047 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28048 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28049 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28050
28051 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28052 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28053 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28054
28055 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28056 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28057 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28058 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28059 an EHLO response.
28060
28061
28062 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28063 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28064 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28065 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28066 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28067 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28068 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28069 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28070 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28071 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28072
28073 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28074 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28075 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28076 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28077 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28078 associated with the DATA command.
28079
28080 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28081 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28082 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28083 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28084 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28085 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28086 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28087 the data specified is received.
28088
28089 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28090 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28091 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28092 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28093 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28094 your resources.
28095
28096 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28097 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28098 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28099 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28100
28101 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28102 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28103 enabled (which is the default).
28104
28105 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28106 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28107 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28108
28109 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28110
28111 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28112
28113
28114 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28115 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28116 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28117
28118 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28119
28120
28121 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28122 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28123 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28124 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28125 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28126 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28127 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28128 has been accepted.
28129
28130 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28131 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28132 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28133 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28134 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28135 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28136 for some or all recipients.
28137
28138 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28139 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28140 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28141 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28142 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28143 is &"yes"&.
28144 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28145 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28146 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28147
28148 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28149 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28150
28151 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28152 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28153 the feature was not requested by the client.
28154
28155 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28156 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28157 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28158 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28159 does not in fact control any access.
28160 For this reason, it may only accept
28161 or warn as its final result.
28162
28163 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28164 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28165 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28166 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28167
28168 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28169 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28170
28171 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28172 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28173 response to QUIT.
28174
28175 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28176 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28177 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28178 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28179 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28180
28181
28182 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28183 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28184 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28185 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28186 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28187 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28188 situation even worse.
28189
28190 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28191 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28192 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28193 and &%warn%&.
28194
28195 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28196 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28197 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28198 connection. The possible values are:
28199 .table2
28200 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28201 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28202 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28203 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28204 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28205 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28206 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28207 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28208 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28209 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28210 .endtable
28211 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28212 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28213 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28214 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28215 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28216 used.
28217
28218
28219 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28220 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28221 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28222 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28223 .code
28224 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28225 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28226 .endd
28227 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28228 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
28229 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28230 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28231 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28232
28233 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28234 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28235 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28236
28237 .ilist
28238 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28239 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28240 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28241 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28242 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28243 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28244 .code
28245 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28246 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28247 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28248 .endd
28249 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28250 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28251 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28252 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28253 .next
28254 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28255 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28256 matches the string.
28257 .next
28258 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28259 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28260 want to have something like
28261 .code
28262 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28263 .endd
28264 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28265 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28266 .endlist
28267
28268
28269
28270
28271 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28272 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28273 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28274 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28275 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28276 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28277 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28278 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28279 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28280
28281 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28282 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28283 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28284
28285
28286 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28287 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28288 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28289 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28290
28291 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28292 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28293 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28294 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28295 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28296 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28297 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28298
28299 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28300 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28301
28302
28303 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28304 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28305 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28306
28307
28308
28309 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28310 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28311 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28312 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28313 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28314 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28315
28316 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28317 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28318 used to accept or reject anything.
28319
28320 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28321 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28322 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28323 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28324
28325 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28326 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28327 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28328 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28329 configuration file.
28330
28331
28332
28333
28334 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28335 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28336 .vindex &$domain$&
28337 .vindex &$local_part$&
28338 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28339 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28340 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28341 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28342 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28343 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28344 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28345 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28346 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28347
28348 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28349 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28350 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28351 how it is used.
28352
28353 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28354 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28355 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28356 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28357 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28358 received).
28359
28360 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28361 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28362 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28363 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28364 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28365 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28366 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28367 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28368
28369
28370
28371
28372
28373 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28374 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28375 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28376 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28377 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28378 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28379 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28380 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28381 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28382 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28383 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28384 unencrypted connections.
28385 .code
28386 acl_check_auth:
28387 accept encrypted = *
28388 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28389 {CRAM-MD5}}
28390 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28391 .endd
28392 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28393 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28394 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28395 option to do this.)
28396
28397
28398
28399 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28400 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28401 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28402 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28403 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28404 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28405 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28406
28407 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28408 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28409 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28410 example:
28411 .code
28412 deny dnslists = list1.example
28413 dnslists = list2.example
28414 .endd
28415 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28416 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28417 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28418 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28419 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28420
28421
28422 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28423 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28424
28425 .ilist
28426 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28427 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28428 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28429 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28430 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28431 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28432 check a RCPT command:
28433 .code
28434 accept domains = +local_domains
28435 endpass
28436 verify = recipient
28437 .endd
28438 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28439 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28440 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28441 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28442 &%endpass%&.
28443
28444 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28445 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28446 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28447 configuration.
28448
28449 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28450 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28451 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28452 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28453 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28454 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28455 .display
28456 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28457 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28458 .endd
28459 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28460 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28461 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28462
28463 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28464 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28465 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28466 of &%endpass%&.
28467
28468
28469 .next
28470 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28471 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28472 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28473 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28474 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28475 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28476 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28477
28478
28479 .next
28480 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28481 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28482 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28483 example,
28484 .code
28485 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28486 .endd
28487 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28488
28489
28490 .next
28491 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28492 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28493 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28494 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28495 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28496 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28497 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28498 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28499 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28500
28501 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28502 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28503 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28504
28505
28506 .next
28507 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28508 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28509 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28510 .code
28511 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28512 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28513 .endd
28514 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28515 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28516
28517 .next
28518 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28519 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28520 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28521 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28522 .code
28523 require message = Sender did not verify
28524 verify = sender
28525 .endd
28526 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28527 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28528 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28529 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28530
28531 .next
28532 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28533 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28534 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28535 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28536 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28537 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28538 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28539
28540 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28541 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28542 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28543 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28544 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28545
28546 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28547 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28548 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28549 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28550 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28551 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28552 onwards.
28553
28554
28555 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28556 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28557 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28558 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28559 .code
28560 warn !verify = sender
28561 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28562 .endd
28563 .endlist
28564
28565 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28566
28567 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28568 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28569 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28570 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28571 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28572
28573
28574
28575 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28576 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28577 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28578 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28579 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28580 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28581 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28582 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28583 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28584 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28585 .ilist
28586 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28587 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28588 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28589 on the same SMTP connection.
28590 .next
28591 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28592 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28593 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28594 .endlist
28595
28596 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28597 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28598 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28599 .code
28600 accept hosts = whatever
28601 set acl_m4 = some value
28602 accept authenticated = *
28603 set acl_c_auth = yes
28604 .endd
28605 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28606 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28607 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28608
28609 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28610 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28611 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28612 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28613 error is generated.
28614
28615 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28616 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28617
28618
28619 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28620 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28621 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28622 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28623 .code
28624 deny domains = *.dom.example
28625 !verify = recipient
28626 .endd
28627 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28628 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28629 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28630 two statements are equivalent:
28631 .code
28632 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28633 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28634 .endd
28635 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28636 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28637
28638 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28639 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28640 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28641 .code
28642 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28643 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28644 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28645 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28646 .endd
28647 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28648 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28649 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28650 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28651 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28652 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28653 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28654
28655 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28656 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28657 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28658 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28659 message is handled.
28660
28661 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28662 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28663 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28664 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28665 .code
28666 require message = Can't verify sender
28667 verify = sender
28668 message = Can't verify recipient
28669 verify = recipient
28670 message = This message cannot be used
28671 .endd
28672 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28673 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28674 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28675 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28676 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28677 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28678
28679 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28680 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28681 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28682 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28683 .code
28684 deny hosts = ...
28685 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28686 message = Invalid sender from client host
28687 .endd
28688 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28689 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28690
28691
28692
28693 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28694 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28695 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28696
28697 .vlist
28698 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28699 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28700 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28701 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28702
28703 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28704 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28705 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28706 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28707 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28708 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28709 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28710 write rather ugly lines like this:
28711 .display
28712 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28713 .endd
28714 Instead, all you need is
28715 .display
28716 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28717 .endd
28718
28719 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28720 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28721 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28722 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28723 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28724 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28725 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28726 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28727
28728 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28729 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28730 in several different ways. For example:
28731
28732 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28733 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28734 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28735 . ==== way.
28736
28737 .ilist
28738 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28739 .code
28740 accept ...some conditions
28741 control = queue_only
28742 .endd
28743 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28744 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28745
28746 .next
28747 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28748 .code
28749 accept ...some conditions...
28750 control = queue_only
28751 ...some more conditions...
28752 .endd
28753 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28754 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28755 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28756 to be relevant.
28757
28758 .next
28759 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28760 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28761 example:
28762 .code
28763 warn ...some conditions...
28764 control = freeze
28765 accept ...
28766 .endd
28767 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28768 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28769 log entry.
28770
28771 .next
28772 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28773 &%require%& verb. For example:
28774 .code
28775 require control = no_multiline_responses
28776 .endd
28777 .endlist
28778
28779 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28780 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28781 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28782 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28783 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28784 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28785 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28786 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28787 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28788
28789 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28790 example:
28791 .code
28792 deny ...some conditions...
28793 delay = 30s
28794 .endd
28795 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28796 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28797 .code
28798 deny delay = 30s
28799 ...some conditions...
28800 .endd
28801 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28802 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28803 .code
28804 warn ...some conditions...
28805 delay = 2m
28806 control = freeze
28807 accept ...
28808 .endd
28809
28810 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28811 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28812 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28813 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28814 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28815 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28816 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28817
28818
28819 .vitem &*endpass*&
28820 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28821 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28822 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28823 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28824 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28825 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28826 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28827
28828
28829 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28830 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28831 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28832 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28833 .code
28834 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28835 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28836 .endd
28837 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28838 example:
28839 .display
28840 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28841 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28842 .endd
28843 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28844 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28845 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28846 message.
28847
28848 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28849 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28850 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28851 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28852 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28853 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28854 ignored.
28855
28856 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28857 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28858 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28859 error message.
28860
28861 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28862 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28863 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28864 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28865 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28866 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28867
28868 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28869 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28870 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28871 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28872 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28873 logging rejections.
28874
28875
28876 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28877 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28878 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28879 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28880 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28881 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28882 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28883 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28884 .display
28885 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28886 &` log_reject_target =`&
28887 .endd
28888 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28889 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28890 current ACL.
28891
28892
28893 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28894 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28895 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28896 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28897 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28898 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28899 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28900 ACLs. For example:
28901 .display
28902 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28903 &` control = freeze`&
28904 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28905 .endd
28906 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28907 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28908 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28909 example:
28910 .code
28911 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28912 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28913 .endd
28914
28915
28916 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28917 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28918 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28919 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28920 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28921 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28922 &%accept%& for details.)
28923
28924 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28925 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28926 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28927 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28928 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28929 .code
28930 require message = Host not recognized
28931 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28932 .endd
28933 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28934 processed.)
28935
28936 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28937 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28938 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28939 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28940 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28941 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28942 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28943 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28944 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28945 EHLO options.
28946
28947 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28948 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28949 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28950 .code
28951 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28952 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28953 .endd
28954 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28955 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28956 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28957 2&'xx'&.
28958
28959 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28960 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28961
28962 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28963 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28964 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28965 response.
28966
28967 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28968 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28969 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28970
28971 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28972 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28973 However, the original message is available in the variable
28974 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28975 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28976 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28977 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28978
28979 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28980 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28981 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28982 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28983 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28984 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28985 effect.
28986
28987
28988 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28989 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
28990 for the message.
28991 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
28992 the DATA ACL).
28993 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
28994 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
28995 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
28996 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
28997
28998
28999 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29000 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29001 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29002 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29003
29004
29005 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29006 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29007 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29008 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29009
29010
29011 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29012 .cindex "UDP communications"
29013 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29014 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29015 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29016 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29017 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29018 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29019 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29020 when:
29021 .code
29022 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29023 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29024 .endd
29025 .endlist
29026
29027
29028
29029
29030 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29031 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29032 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29033
29034 .vlist
29035 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29036 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29037 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29038 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29039 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29040 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29041 not work without it. For example:
29042 .code
29043 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29044 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29045 .endd
29046 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29047 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29048 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29049 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29050 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29051
29052
29053 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29054 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29055 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29056 .cindex "case of local parts"
29057 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29058 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29059 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29060 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29061 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29062 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29063 is encountered.
29064
29065 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29066 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29067 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29068 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29069 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29070
29071 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29072 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29073 spam score:
29074 .code
29075 warn control = caseful_local_part
29076 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29077 $acl_m4 + \
29078 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29079 }
29080 control = caselower_local_part
29081 .endd
29082 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29083 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29084
29085
29086 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29087 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29088 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29089 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29090
29091 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29092 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29093 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29094 is used for all recipients of the message,
29095 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29096 and data is copied from one to the other.
29097
29098 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29099 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29100 If a recipient-verify callout
29101 (with use_sender)
29102 connection is subsequently
29103 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29104 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29105 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29106
29107 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29108 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29109 Note also that headers cannot be
29110 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29111 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29112 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29113 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29114 this will affect the timestamp.
29115
29116 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29117 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29118 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29119 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29120 message body.
29121
29122 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29123 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29124 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29125 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29126 or CHUNKING
29127 options in use.
29128
29129 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29130 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29131 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29132 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29133 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29134
29135 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29136 usual fashion.
29137 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29138 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29139 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29140 and does not queue the message.
29141 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29142
29143 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29144 (possibly faked)
29145 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29146
29147
29148 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29149 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29150 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29151 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29152 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29153 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29154 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29155 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29156 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29157 option.
29158 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29159 with the &'kill'& option.
29160 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29161 contexts):
29162 .code
29163 control = debug
29164 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29165 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29166 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29167 control = debug/kill
29168 .endd
29169
29170
29171 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29172 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29173 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29174 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29175 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
29176
29177
29178 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29179 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29180 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29181 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29182 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29183 strings or to numeric value.
29184 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29185 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29186 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29187
29188 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29189 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29190 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29191 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29192 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29193
29194
29195 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29196 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29197 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29198 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29199 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29200 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29201 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29202 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29203
29204 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29205 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29206 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29207 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29208 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29209 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29210 work with.
29211
29212
29213 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29214 .cindex "fake defer"
29215 .cindex "defer, fake"
29216 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29217 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29218 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29219 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29220 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29221
29222 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29223 .cindex "fake rejection"
29224 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29225 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29226 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29227 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29228 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29229 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29230 the same SMTP connection.
29231
29232 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29233 message is supplied, the following is used:
29234 .code
29235 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29236 550-kept for evaluation.
29237 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29238 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29239 .endd
29240 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29241
29242 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29243 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29244 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29245 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29246 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29247 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29248 SMTP connection.
29249
29250 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29251 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29252 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29253 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29254
29255 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29256 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29257 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29258 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29259 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29260 disables such output flushing.
29261
29262 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29263 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29264 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29265 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29266 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29267 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29268
29269 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29270 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29271 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29272 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29273 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29274 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29275 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29276 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29277 to be useful in production.
29278
29279 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29280 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29281 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29282 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29283 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29284
29285 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29286 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29287 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29288 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29289 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29290 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29291
29292 .ilist
29293 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29294 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29295 verification failed"&) is sent.
29296 .next
29297 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29298 line is output.
29299 .endlist
29300
29301 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29302 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29303
29304 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29305 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29306 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29307 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29308 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29309 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29310 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29311
29312 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29313 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29314 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29315 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29316 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29317 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29318 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29319 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29320 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29321 same SMTP connection.
29322
29323 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29324 .cindex "message" "submission"
29325 .cindex "submission mode"
29326 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29327 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29328 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29329 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29330 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29331 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29332 late (the message has already been created).
29333
29334 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29335 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29336 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29337 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29338 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29339
29340 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29341 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29342 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29343 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29344 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29345
29346 .ilist
29347 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29348 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29349 .next
29350 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29351 .next
29352 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29353 .endlist ilist
29354
29355 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29356 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29357 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29358 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29359 data is read.
29360
29361 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29362 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29363
29364 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29365 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29366 to a-label form.
29367 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29368 .endlist vlist
29369
29370
29371 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29372 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29373
29374 .ilist
29375 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29376 .next
29377 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29378 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29379 .next
29380 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29381 .next
29382 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29383 .endlist
29384
29385
29386
29387 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29388 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29389 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29390 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29391 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29392 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29393 .code
29394 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29395 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29396 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29397 .endd
29398 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29399 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29400 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29401 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29402 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29403 RCPT ACL).
29404
29405 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29406 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29407
29408 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29409 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29410 contains one or more newlines that
29411 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29412 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29413 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29414
29415 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29416 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29417 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29418 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29419 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29420 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29421 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29422 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29423 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29424 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29425 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29426
29427 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29428 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29429 of message headers
29430 until they are added to the
29431 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29432 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29433 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29434 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29435 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29436 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29437 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29438
29439 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29440
29441 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29442 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29443 .display
29444 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29445 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29446
29447 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29448 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29449 .endd
29450 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29451 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29452 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29453 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29454 honoured.
29455
29456 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29457 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29458 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29459 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29460 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29461 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29462 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29463 specifications.
29464
29465 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29466 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29467 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29468 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29469 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29470
29471 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29472 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29473 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29474 to be a header name first.) For example:
29475 .code
29476 warn add_header = \
29477 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29478 .endd
29479 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29480 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29481 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29482 up in reverse order.
29483
29484 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29485 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29486 system filter or in a router or transport.
29487
29488
29489
29490 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29491 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29492 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29493 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29494 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29495 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29496 .code
29497 warn message = Remove internal headers
29498 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29499 .endd
29500 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29501 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29502 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29503 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29504 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29505 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29506
29507 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29508 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29509
29510 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29511 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29512 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29513 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29514 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29515 .code
29516 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29517 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29518 warn message = Remove internal headers
29519 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29520 .endd
29521 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29522 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29523 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29524 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29525 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29526 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29527 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29528 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29529 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29530 would have been removed.
29531
29532 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29533 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29534 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29535 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29536 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29537 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29538 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29539 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29540 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29541
29542 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29543 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29544 .display
29545 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29546 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29547
29548 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29549 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29550 .endd
29551 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29552 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29553 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29554 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29555 are honoured.
29556
29557 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29558 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29559 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29560
29561
29562
29563
29564 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29565 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29566 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29567 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29568 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29569 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29570
29571 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29572 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29573 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29574 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29575 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29576 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29577 The conditions are as follows:
29578
29579
29580 .vlist
29581 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29582 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29583 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29584 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29585 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29586 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29587 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29588 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29589 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29590 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29591 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29592 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29593
29594 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29595 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29596 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29597 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29598 The name and values are expanded separately.
29599 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29600 will act as argument separators.
29601
29602 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29603 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29604 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29605 conditions are tested.
29606
29607 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29608 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29609 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29610 for different local users or different local domains.
29611
29612 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29613 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29614 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29615 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29616 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29617 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29618 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29619 .code
29620 authenticated = *
29621 .endd
29622
29623 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29624 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29625 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29626 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29627 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29628 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29629 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29630 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29631 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29632 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29633 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29634 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29635 negative.
29636
29637 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29638 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29639 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29640 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29641 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29642 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29643 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29644 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29645
29646 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29647 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29648 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29649 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29650 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29651 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29652 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29653 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29654 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29655 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29656
29657 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29658 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29659 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29660 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29661 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29662 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29663 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29664 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29665 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29666 &%domains%& test.
29667
29668 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29669 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29670
29671
29672 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29673 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29674 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29675 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29676 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29677 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29678 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29679 .code
29680 encrypted = *
29681 .endd
29682
29683
29684 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29685 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29686 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29687 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29688 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29689 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29690 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29691 .code
29692 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29693 .endd
29694 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29695 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29696 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29697
29698 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29699 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29700 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29701 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29702 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29703 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29704
29705 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29706 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29707 .code
29708 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29709 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29710 .endd
29711 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29712 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29713 statement can then check the IP address.
29714
29715 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29716 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29717 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29718 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29719 .code
29720 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29721 message = $host_data
29722 .endd
29723 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29724
29725 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29726 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29727 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29728 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29729 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29730 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29731 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29732 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29733 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29734 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29735
29736 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29737 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29738 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29739 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29740 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29741 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29742 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29743
29744 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29745 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29746 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29747 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29748 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29749 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29750 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29751 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29752
29753 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29754 .cindex "rate limiting"
29755 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29756 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29757
29758 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29759 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29760 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29761 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29762 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29763 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29764
29765 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29766 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29767 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29768 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29769 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29770 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29771 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29772
29773 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29774 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29775 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29776 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29777 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29778 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29779 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29780 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29781 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29782 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29783 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29784 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29785 influence the sender checking.
29786
29787 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29788 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29789
29790 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29791 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29792 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29793 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29794 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29795 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29796 .code
29797 senders = :
29798 .endd
29799 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29800 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29801
29802 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29803 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29804 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29805 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29806 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29807 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29808
29809 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29810 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29811 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29812 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29813 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29814 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29815 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29816 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29817 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29818 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29819
29820 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29821 .cindex "CSA verification"
29822 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29823 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29824 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29825
29826 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29827 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29828 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29829 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29830 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29831 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29832 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29833 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29834 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29835 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29836
29837 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29838 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29839 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29840
29841 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29842 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29843 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29844 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29845 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29846 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29847 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29848 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29849 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29850 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29851 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29852 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29853 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29854 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29855 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29856
29857 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29858 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29859 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29860 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29861 .code
29862 deny senders = :
29863 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29864 !verify = header_sender
29865 .endd
29866
29867 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29868 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29869 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29870 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29871 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29872 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29873 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29874 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29875 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29876 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29877 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29878 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29879 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29880 appropriate.
29881
29882 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29883 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29884 .code
29885 To: @
29886 .endd
29887 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29888 common as they used to be.
29889
29890 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29891 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29892 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29893 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29894 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29895 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29896 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29897 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29898 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29899 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29900 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29901 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29902 independently of this condition.
29903
29904 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29905 option), this condition is always true.
29906
29907
29908 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29909 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29910 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29911 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29912 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29913 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29914 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29915 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29916 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29917
29918 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29919 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29920
29921
29922 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29923 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29924 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29925 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29926 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29927 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29928 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29929 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29930 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29931 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29932 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29933 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29934 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29935 value for the child address.
29936
29937 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29938 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29939 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29940 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29941 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29942 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29943 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29944 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29945 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29946 original IP address.
29947
29948 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29949 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29950
29951 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29952 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29953
29954 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29955 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29956 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29957 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29958 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29959 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29960 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29961 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29962 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29963
29964 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29965 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29966 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29967 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29968 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29969 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29970 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29971
29972 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29973 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29974 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29975
29976 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29977 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29978 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29979 verified as a sender.
29980
29981 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
29982 (eg. is generated from the received message)
29983 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
29984 .code
29985 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
29986 .endd
29987 .endlist
29988
29989
29990
29991 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29992 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29993 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29994 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29995 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29996 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29997 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29998 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29999 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30000 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30001 .code
30002 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30003 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30004 .endd
30005 the following records are looked up:
30006 .code
30007 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30008 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30009 .endd
30010 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30011 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30012 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30013 use two separate conditions:
30014 .code
30015 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30016 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30017 .endd
30018 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30019 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30020 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30021 processed.
30022
30023 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30024 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30025 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30026 following special items in the list:
30027 .display
30028 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30029 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30030 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30031 .endd
30032 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30033 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30034 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30035 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30036 .code
30037 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30038 .endd
30039 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30040 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30041 .code
30042 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30043 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30044 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30045 .endd
30046 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30047 .cindex DNS TTL
30048 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30049 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30050 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30051 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30052 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30053 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30054
30055
30056
30057 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30058 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30059 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30060 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30061 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30062 .code
30063 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30064 .endd
30065 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30066 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30067 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30068 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30069
30070
30071
30072
30073 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30074 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30075 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30076 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30077 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30078 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30079 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30080 .code
30081 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30082 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30083 .endd
30084 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30085 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30086 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30087 up by this example is
30088 .code
30089 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30090 .endd
30091 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30092 addresses. For example:
30093 .code
30094 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30095 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30096 .endd
30097 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30098 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30099
30100
30101
30102
30103 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30104 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30105 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30106 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30107 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30108 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30109 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30110 either to double the separators like this:
30111 .code
30112 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30113 .endd
30114 or to change the separator character, like this:
30115 .code
30116 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30117 .endd
30118 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30119 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30120 occurs. Consider this condition:
30121 .code
30122 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30123 .endd
30124 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30125 .code
30126 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30127 a.domain.black.list.tld
30128 .endd
30129 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30130 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30131 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30132 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30133 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30134 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30135 error for a previous item.
30136
30137 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30138 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30139 .code
30140 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30141 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30142 .endd
30143 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30144 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30145 .code
30146 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30147 $sender_address_domain \
30148 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30149 see $dnslist_text.
30150 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30151 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30152 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30153 .endd
30154 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30155 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30156 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30157 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30158 .code
30159 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30160 .endd
30161 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30162 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30163
30164 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30165 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30166
30167
30168
30169
30170 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30171 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30172 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30173 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30174 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30175 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30176 .display
30177 127.1.0.1 RBL
30178 127.1.0.2 DUL
30179 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30180 127.1.0.4 RSS
30181 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30182 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30183 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30184 .endd
30185 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30186 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30187 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30188
30189
30190 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30191 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30192 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30193 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30194 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30195 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30196 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30197 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30198 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30199 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30200 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30201 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30202 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30203 cases, for example:
30204 .code
30205 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30206 .endd
30207 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30208 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30209 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30210 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30211 .code
30212 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30213 .endd
30214 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30215 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30216
30217 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30218 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30219 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30220 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30221 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30222 information.
30223
30224 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30225 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30226 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30227 .code
30228 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30229 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30230 at $dnslist_domain
30231 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30232 .endd
30233
30234
30235
30236 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30237 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30238 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30239 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30240 For example,
30241 .code
30242 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30243 .endd
30244 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30245 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30246 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30247 describes how multiple records are handled.
30248
30249 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30250 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30251 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30252 .code
30253 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30254 .endd
30255 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30256 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30257 first. For example:
30258 .code
30259 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30260 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30261 .endd
30262
30263 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30264 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30265 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30266 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30267 tested. For example:
30268 .code
30269 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30270 .endd
30271 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30272 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30273 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30274 .code
30275 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30276 .endd
30277 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30278 an odd number.
30279
30280
30281
30282 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30283 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30284 condition. Whereas
30285 .code
30286 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30287 .endd
30288 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30289 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30290 .code
30291 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30292 .endd
30293 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30294 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30295 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30296 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30297
30298 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30299 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30300
30301 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30302 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30303 .code
30304 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30305 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30306 .endd
30307 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30308 Consider this example:
30309 .code
30310 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30311 list.dsbl.org : \
30312 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30313 relays.ordb.org
30314 .endd
30315 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30316 .code
30317 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30318 list.dsbl.org
30319 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30320 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30321 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30322 .endd
30323 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30324
30325
30326
30327
30328 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30329 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30330 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30331 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30332 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30333 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30334 .code
30335 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30336 .endd
30337 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30338 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30339 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30340 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30341 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30342 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30343
30344 .ilist
30345 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30346 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30347 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30348 .next
30349 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30350 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30351 changed to:
30352 .code
30353 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30354 .endd
30355 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30356 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30357 .code
30358 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30359 .endd
30360 for the condition to be true.
30361 .endlist
30362
30363 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30364 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30365 .ilist
30366 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30367 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30368 .code
30369 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30370 .endd
30371 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30372 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30373 .next
30374 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30375 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30376 .code
30377 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30378 .endd
30379 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30380 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30381 .code
30382 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30383 .endd
30384 for the condition to be false.
30385 .endlist
30386 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30387 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30388
30389
30390
30391
30392 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30393 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30394 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30395 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30396 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30397 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30398 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30399 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30400 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30401 lists.
30402
30403 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30404 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30405 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30406 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30407 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30408 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30409 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30410 .code
30411 reject message = \
30412 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30413 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30414 dnslists = \
30415 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30416 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30417 .endd
30418 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30419 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30420 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30421 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30422 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30423 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30424
30425 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30426 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30427 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30428 .code
30429 reject dnslists = \
30430 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30431 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30432 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30433 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30434 .endd
30435 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30436 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30437 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30438
30439
30440
30441 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30442 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30443 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30444 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30445 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30446 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30447 .code
30448 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30449 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30450 .endd
30451 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30452 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30453 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30454 .code
30455 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30456 .endd
30457 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30458 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30459
30460 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30461 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30462 .code
30463 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30464 dnslists = some.list.example
30465 .endd
30466
30467 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30468 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30469 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30470 .code
30471 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30472 .endd
30473
30474 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30475 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30476 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30477 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30478 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30479 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30480 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30481 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30482 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30483 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30484 .display
30485 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30486 .endd
30487 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30488 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30489
30490 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30491 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30492 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30493 of &'p'&.
30494
30495 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30496 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30497 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30498 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30499 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30500 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30501 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30502 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30503 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30504
30505 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30506 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30507 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30508 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30509
30510 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30511 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30512 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30513 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30514 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30515 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30516 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30517 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30518 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30519 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30520
30521 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30522 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30523 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30524 ACL.
30525
30526 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30527 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30528 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30529 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30530 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30531 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30532
30533 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30534 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30535 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30536 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30537 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30538 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30539 the &%count=%& option.
30540
30541
30542 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30543 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30544 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30545 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30546 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30547
30548 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30549 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30550 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30551 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30552
30553 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30554 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30555 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30556 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30557 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30558 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30559 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30560
30561 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30562 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30563 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30564 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30565 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30566 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30567 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30568
30569 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30570 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30571 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30572 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30573 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30574
30575 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30576 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30577 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30578 multiple different commands.
30579
30580 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30581 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30582 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30583 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30584 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30585
30586 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30587
30588
30589 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30590 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30591 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30592 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30593 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30594
30595 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30596 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30597
30598 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30599 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30600 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30601 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30602 new rate.
30603 .code
30604 acl_check_connect:
30605 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30606 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30607 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30608 # ...
30609 acl_check_mail:
30610 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30611 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30612 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30613 .endd
30614
30615 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30616 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30617 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30618 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30619 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30620 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30621 checks.
30622
30623 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30624 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30625 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30626 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30627 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30628
30629
30630 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30631 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30632 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30633 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30634 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30635 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30636 rest of the ACL.
30637
30638 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30639 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30640 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30641 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30642 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30643 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30644 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30645 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30646 from getting any email through.
30647
30648 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30649 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30650 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30651 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30652 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30653 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30654 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30655 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30656 .code
30657 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30658 .endd
30659
30660
30661 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30662 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30663 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30664 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30665 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30666 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30667 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30668 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30669 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30670
30671 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30672 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30673 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30674 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30675 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30676 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30677
30678 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30679 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30680 rate.
30681
30682 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30683 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30684 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30685 required increases with larger limits.
30686
30687 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30688 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30689 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30690 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30691 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30692 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30693 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30694 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30695 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30696 as intended.
30697
30698
30699 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30700 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30701 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30702 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30703 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30704 message. For example:
30705 .code
30706 # Log all senders' rates
30707 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30708 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30709
30710 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30711 # at the decimal point.
30712 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30713 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30714 $sender_rate_limit }s
30715
30716 # Keep authenticated users under control
30717 deny authenticated = *
30718 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30719
30720 # System-wide rate limit
30721 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30722 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30723
30724 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30725 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30726 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30727 messages per $sender_rate_period
30728 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30729 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30730 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30731 .endd
30732 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30733 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30734 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30735 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30736 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30737 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30738 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30739
30740
30741
30742 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30743 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30744 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30745 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30746 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30747 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30748 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30749 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30750 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30751 .code
30752 verify = sender/callout
30753 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30754 .endd
30755 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30756 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30757 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30758 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30759 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30760 The available options are as follows:
30761
30762 .ilist
30763 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30764 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30765 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30766 .next
30767 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30768 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30769 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30770 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30771 .next
30772 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30773 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30774 .next
30775 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30776 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30777 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30778 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30779 .endlist
30780
30781 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30782 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30783 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30784 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30785 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30786 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30787 coding like this:
30788 .code
30789 warn !verify = sender
30790 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30791 .endd
30792 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30793 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30794 verification failure.
30795
30796 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30797 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30798
30799 .ilist
30800 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30801 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30802 .next
30803 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30804 .next
30805 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30806 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30807 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30808 .next
30809 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30810 .next
30811 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30812 .endlist
30813
30814 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30815 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30816
30817
30818
30819
30820 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30821 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30822 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30823 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30824 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30825 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30826 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30827 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30828 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30829 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30830 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30831 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30832 sender's domain.
30833
30834 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30835 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30836 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30837 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30838 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30839 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30840
30841 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30842 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30843 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30844 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30845 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30846
30847 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30848 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30849 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30850 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30851 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30852 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30853 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30854 supplies a host list.
30855 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30856
30857 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30858 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30859 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30860 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30861 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30862 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30863 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30864
30865 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30866 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30867 following SMTP commands are sent:
30868 .display
30869 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30870 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30871 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30872 &`QUIT`&
30873 .endd
30874 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30875 set to &"lmtp"&.
30876
30877 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30878 settings.
30879
30880 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30881 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30882 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30883 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30884 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30885 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30886
30887 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30888 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30889 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30890 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30891 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30892
30893 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30894 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30895 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30896 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30897 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30898
30899
30900
30901
30902 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30903 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30904 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30905 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30906 .code
30907 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30908 .endd
30909 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30910 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30911 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30912
30913
30914 .vlist
30915 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30916 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30917 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30918 For example:
30919 .code
30920 verify = sender/callout=5s
30921 .endd
30922 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30923 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30924 the &%connect%& parameter.
30925
30926
30927 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30928 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30929 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30930 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30931 .code
30932 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30933 .endd
30934 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30935
30936 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30937 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30938 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30939 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30940 updated in this circumstance.
30941
30942 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30943 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30944 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30945 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30946 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30947 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30948
30949
30950 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30951 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30952 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30953 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30954 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30955 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30956 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30957 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30958 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30959 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30960 .code
30961 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30962 .endd
30963 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30964
30965
30966 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30967 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30968 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30969 For example:
30970 .code
30971 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30972 .endd
30973 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30974 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30975 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30976 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30977 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30978
30979
30980 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30981 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30982 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30983 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30984
30985 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30986 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30987 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30988 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30989 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30990 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30991 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30992 made, until the cache record expires.
30993
30994 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30995 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30996 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30997 For example:
30998 .code
30999 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31000 .endd
31001 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31002 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31003 .code
31004 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31005 .endd
31006 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31007 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31008 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31009 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31010
31011
31012 .vitem &*random*&
31013 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31014 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31015 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31016 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31017 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31018 .code
31019 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31020 .endd
31021 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31022 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31023 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31024 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31025 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31026
31027 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31028 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31029 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31030 .code
31031 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31032 .endd
31033 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31034 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31035 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31036 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31037 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31038
31039 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31040 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31041 .code
31042 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31043 .endd
31044 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31045 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31046 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31047 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31048 usefulness of callout caching.
31049
31050 .vitem &*hold*&
31051 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31052 .code
31053 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31054 .endd
31055 It causes the connection to be helod open and used for any further recipients
31056 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31057 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31058 when that is used for the connections.
31059 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31060 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31061 if the use_sender option is used,
31062 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31063 and if no other callouts intervene.
31064 .endlist
31065
31066 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31067 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31068 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31069 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31070 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31071 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31072 these circumstances.
31073
31074 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31075 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31076 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31077 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31078 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31079 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31080 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31081
31082 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31083 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31084 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31085 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31086
31087
31088
31089
31090 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31091 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31092 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31093 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31094 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31095 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31096 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31097 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31098 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31099 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31100
31101 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31102 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31103 is not available.
31104
31105 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31106 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31107 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31108
31109 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31110 commands up to and including
31111 .code
31112 MAIL FROM:<>
31113 .endd
31114 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31115 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31116 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31117 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31118 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31119 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31120 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31121
31122 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31123 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31124 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31125 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31126 will eventually be noticed.
31127
31128 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31129 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31130 behaviour will be the same.
31131
31132
31133
31134 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31135 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31136 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31137 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31138 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31139 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31140 you might see:
31141 .code
31142 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31143 250 OK
31144 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31145 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31146 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31147 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31148 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31149 550 Sender verification failed
31150 .endd
31151 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31152 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31153 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31154 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31155 example:
31156 .code
31157 verify = sender/no_details
31158 .endd
31159
31160 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31161 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31162 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31163 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31164 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31165 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31166 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31167
31168 .ilist
31169 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31170 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31171 verification also fails.
31172 .next
31173 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31174 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31175 .endlist
31176
31177 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31178 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31179 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31180 .code
31181 A.Wol: aw123
31182 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31183 .endd
31184 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31185 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31186 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31187 verification to succeed.
31188
31189 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31190 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31191 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31192 option. For example:
31193 .code
31194 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31195 .endd
31196 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31197 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31198
31199 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31200 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31201 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31202 address and a report is output for each of them.
31203
31204
31205
31206 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31207 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31208 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31209 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31210 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31211 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31212 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31213 .code
31214 verify = csa
31215 .endd
31216 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31217 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31218 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31219 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31220 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31221 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31222
31223 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31224 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31225 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31226 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31227
31228 .ilist
31229 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31230 .next
31231 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31232 .next
31233 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31234 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31235 .next
31236 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31237 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31238 .endlist
31239
31240 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31241 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31242 .code
31243 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31244 .endd
31245 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31246 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31247 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31248 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31249 meaningful to say:
31250 .code
31251 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31252 .endd
31253 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31254 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31255 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31256
31257 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31258 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31259 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31260 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31261 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31262 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31263 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31264 of legitimate HELO domains.
31265
31266 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31267 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31268 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31269 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31270 lookup such as:
31271 .code
31272 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31273 .endd
31274 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31275 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31276 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31277
31278
31279
31280
31281 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31282 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31283 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31284 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31285 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31286 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31287 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31288 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31289
31290 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31291 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31292 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31293 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31294 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31295 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31296 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31297 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31298
31299 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31300 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31301 like this:
31302 .code
31303 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31304 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31305 }{$value}}
31306 .endd
31307 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31308 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31309 use this:
31310 .code
31311 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31312 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31313 senders = :
31314 recipients = +batv_senders
31315
31316 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31317 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31318 senders = :
31319 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31320 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31321 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31322 .endd
31323 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31324 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31325 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31326 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31327 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31328
31329 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31330 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31331 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31332 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31333 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31334 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31335 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31336
31337 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31338 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31339 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31340 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31341 .code
31342 batv_redirect:
31343 driver = redirect
31344 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31345 .endd
31346 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31347 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31348 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31349 local addresses.
31350
31351 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31352 can be used:
31353 .code
31354 external_smtp_batv:
31355 driver = smtp
31356 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31357 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31358 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31359 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31360 {$value}fail}}}
31361 .endd
31362 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31363
31364
31365
31366 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31367 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31368 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31369 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31370 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31371 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31372 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31373 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31374 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31375 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31376
31377 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31378 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31379 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31380 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31381 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31382 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31383 . ///
31384 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31385 . ///
31386 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31387 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31388 system to arbitrary domains.
31389
31390
31391 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31392 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31393 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31394 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31395
31396 .ilist
31397 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31398 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31399 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31400 .next
31401 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31402 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31403 .next
31404 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31405 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31406 .endlist
31407
31408
31409 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31410 .code
31411 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31412 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31413 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31414 .endd
31415 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31416 command:
31417 .code
31418 acl_check_rcpt:
31419 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31420 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31421 .endd
31422 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31423 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31424 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31425 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31426 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31427 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31428 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31429
31430
31431
31432 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31433 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31434 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31435 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31436 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31437 .ecindex IIDacl
31438
31439
31440
31441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31443
31444 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31445 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31446 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31447 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31448 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31449 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31450 specification.
31451
31452 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31453 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31454 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31455 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31456 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31457
31458 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31459 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31460 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31461
31462 .ilist
31463 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31464 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31465 .next
31466 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31467 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31468 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31469 .next
31470 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31471 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31472 .next
31473 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31474 conditions.
31475 .next
31476 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31477 .endlist
31478
31479 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31480 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31481 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31482 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31483 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31484 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31485
31486 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31487 temporarily created in a file called:
31488 .display
31489 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31490 .endd
31491 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31492 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31493 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31494 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31495 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31496 .code
31497 control = no_mbox_unspool
31498 .endd
31499 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31500 same directory by default.
31501
31502
31503
31504 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31505 .cindex "virus scanning"
31506 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31507 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31508 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31509 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31510 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31511 in memory and thus are much faster.
31512
31513 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31514 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31515
31516 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31517 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31518 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31519 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31520 .display
31521 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31522 .endd
31523 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31524 .code
31525 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31526 .endd
31527 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31528 before use.
31529 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31530 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31531
31532 .vlist
31533 .vitem &%avast%&
31534 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31535 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31536 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31537 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31538 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31539 This scanner type takes one option,
31540 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31541 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31542 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31543 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31544 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31545 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31546 For example:
31547 .code
31548 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31549 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31550 .endd
31551 If you omit the argument, the default path
31552 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31553 is used.
31554 If you use a remote host,
31555 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31556 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31557 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31558 .code
31559 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31560 FLAGS
31561 SENSITIVITY
31562 PACK
31563 .endd
31564
31565
31566 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31567 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31568 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31569 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31570 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31571 example:
31572 .code
31573 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31574 .endd
31575
31576
31577 .vitem &%clamd%&
31578 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31579 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31580 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31581 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31582 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31583
31584 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31585 a UNIX socket specification,
31586 a TCP socket specification,
31587 or a (global) option.
31588
31589 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31590 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31591 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31592 and the second a port number,
31593 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31594 These per-server options are supported:
31595 .code
31596 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31597 .endd
31598
31599 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31600 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31601
31602 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31603
31604 Examples:
31605 .code
31606 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31607 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31608 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31609 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31610 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31611 .endd
31612 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31613 &`local`&
31614 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31615 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31616 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31617 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31618 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31619 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31620
31621 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31622 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31623 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31624 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31625 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31626 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31627 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31628 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31629 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31630 .code
31631 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31632 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31633 (Connection refused)
31634 .endd
31635
31636 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31637 contributing the code for this scanner.
31638
31639 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31640 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31641 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31642 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31643 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31644
31645 .olist
31646 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31647 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31648
31649 .next
31650 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31651 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31652 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31653 the &"trigger"& expression.
31654
31655 .next
31656 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31657 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31658 &"name"& expression.
31659 .endlist olist
31660
31661 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31662 .code
31663 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31664 .endd
31665 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31666 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31667 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31668 configuration setting:
31669 .code
31670 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31671 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31672 found in file:'(.+)'
31673 .endd
31674 .vitem &%drweb%&
31675 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31676 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31677 takes one option,
31678 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31679 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31680 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31681 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31682 For example:
31683 .code
31684 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31685 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31686 .endd
31687 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31688 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31689
31690 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31691 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31692 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31693 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31694 (or port-range).
31695 For example:
31696 .code
31697 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31698 .endd
31699 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31700
31701 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31702 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31703 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31704 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31705 For example:
31706 .code
31707 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31708 .endd
31709 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31710
31711 .vitem &%fsecure%&
31712 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31713 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31714 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31715 .code
31716 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31717 .endd
31718 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31719 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31720
31721 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31722 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31723 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31724 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31725 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31726 For example:
31727 .code
31728 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31729 .endd
31730 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31731
31732 .vitem &%mksd%&
31733 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31734 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31735 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31736 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31737 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31738 provided that mksd has
31739 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31740 .code
31741 av_scanner = mksd:2
31742 .endd
31743 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31744
31745 .vitem &%sock%&
31746 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31747 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31748 running on the local machine.
31749 There are four options:
31750 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31751 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31752 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31753 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31754 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31755 For example:
31756 .code
31757 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
31758 .endd
31759 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
31760 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
31761 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
31762 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
31763 specify an empty element to get this.
31764
31765 .vitem &%sophie%&
31766 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31767 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31768 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31769 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31770 client communication. For example:
31771 .code
31772 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31773 .endd
31774 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31775 the option.
31776 .endlist
31777
31778 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31779 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31780 ACL.
31781
31782 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31783 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31784 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31785 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31786 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31787 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31788 message.
31789
31790 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31791 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31792 The first element can then be one of
31793
31794 .ilist
31795 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31796 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31797 recommended usage.
31798 .next
31799 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31800 the condition fails immediately.
31801 .next
31802 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31803 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31804 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31805 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31806 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31807 .endlist
31808
31809 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31810 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31811 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31812
31813 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31814 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31815 For example:
31816 .code
31817 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31818 .endd
31819 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31820
31821 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31822 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31823 is set to record the actual address used.
31824
31825 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31826 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31827 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31828 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31829 logging data.
31830
31831 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31832 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31833
31834 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31835 .code
31836 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31837 malware = *
31838 .endd
31839 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31840 .code
31841 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31842 malware = */defer_ok
31843 .endd
31844 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31845 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31846 .code
31847 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31848 .endd
31849 in the main Exim configuration.
31850 .code
31851 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31852 set acl_m0 = sophie
31853 malware = *
31854
31855 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31856 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31857 malware = *
31858 .endd
31859
31860
31861 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31862 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31863 .cindex "spam scanning"
31864 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31865 .cindex "Rspamd"
31866 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31867 score and a report for the message.
31868 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31869
31870 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31871 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31872 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31873
31874 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31875 .code
31876 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31877 .endd
31878 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31879 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31880 nicely, however.
31881
31882 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31883 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31884 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31885 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31886 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31887 configuration as follows (example):
31888 .code
31889 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31890 .endd
31891 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
31892 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
31893 iptables firewall, consider setting
31894 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
31895 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
31896 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
31897 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
31898 soon.
31899
31900
31901 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31902 on TCP port 11333)
31903 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31904 .code
31905 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31906 .endd
31907
31908 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31909 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31910 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31911 .code
31912 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31913 .endd
31914 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31915 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31916 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31917 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31918 .code
31919 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31920 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31921 192.168.2.12 783
31922 .endd
31923 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31924 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31925 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31926 condition defers.
31927
31928 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31929 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31930 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
31931
31932 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31933 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31934 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31935 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31936
31937 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31938 are options.
31939 The supported options are:
31940 .code
31941 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31942 weight=<value> Selection bias
31943 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31944 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31945 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31946 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31947 .endd
31948
31949 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31950 higher values being tried first.
31951 The default priority is 1.
31952
31953 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31954 Within a priority set
31955 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31956 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31957
31958 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31959 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31960 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31961 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31962
31963 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31964 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31965
31966 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31967 The default value is two minutes.
31968
31969 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31970 a failed connect is made.
31971 The default is to not retry.
31972
31973 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31974 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31975 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31976 expansion.
31977
31978 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31979 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31980 is set to record the actual address used.
31981
31982 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31983 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31984 .code
31985 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31986 spam = joe
31987 .endd
31988 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31989 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31990 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31991 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31992 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31993 right-hand side.
31994
31995 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31996 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31997 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31998 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31999 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32000 are not set.
32001 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32002 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32003 after the first),
32004 or the use of PRDR,
32005 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32006 are needed to use this feature.
32007
32008 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32009 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32010 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32011
32012
32013 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32014 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32015 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32016 example:
32017 .code
32018 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32019 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32020 spam = nobody
32021 .endd
32022
32023 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32024 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32025 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32026 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32027
32028 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32029 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32030 variables.
32031 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32032 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32033 available for use at delivery time.
32034
32035 .vlist
32036 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32037 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32038 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32039
32040 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32041 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32042 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32043 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32044 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32045
32046 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32047 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32048 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32049 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32050 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32051 spam bar is 50 characters.
32052
32053 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32054 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32055 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32056 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32057 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32058 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32059 unencoded in headers.
32060
32061 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32062 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32063 spam score versus threshold.
32064 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32065
32066 .endlist
32067
32068 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32069 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32070 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32071
32072 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32073 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32074 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32075 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32076 spam condition, like this:
32077 .code
32078 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32079 spam = joe/defer_ok
32080 .endd
32081 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32082
32083 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32084 condition:
32085 .code
32086 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32087 warn spam = nobody:true
32088 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32089 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32090
32091 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32092 # is over threshold
32093 warn spam = nobody
32094 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32095
32096 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32097 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32098 spam = nobody:true
32099 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32100 .endd
32101
32102
32103
32104 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32105 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32106 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32107 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32108 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32109 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32110 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32111 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32112 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32113 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32114 cases.
32115
32116 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32117 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32118 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32119 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32120 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32121 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32122 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32123
32124 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32125 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32126 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32127 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32128 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32129
32130 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32131 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32132 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32133 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32134 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32135 syntax is:
32136 .display
32137 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32138 .endd
32139 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32140 the value can be:
32141
32142 .olist
32143 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32144 .next
32145 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32146 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32147 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32148 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32149 .next
32150 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32151 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32152 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32153 the full path and file name.
32154 .next
32155 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32156 filename, and the default path is then used.
32157 .endlist
32158 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32159 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32160 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32161 .code
32162 decode = $mime_filename
32163 .endd
32164 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32165 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32166 automatically unlinked.
32167
32168 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32169 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32170 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32171 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32172 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32173
32174 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32175 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32176 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32177
32178 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32179 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32180 available in the MIME ACL:
32181
32182 .vlist
32183 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32184 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32185 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32186 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32187 contains the empty string.
32188
32189 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32190 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32191 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32192 .code
32193 us-ascii
32194 gb2312 (Chinese)
32195 iso-8859-1
32196 .endd
32197 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32198 case-insensitively.
32199
32200 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32201 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32202 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32203 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32204 only used for display purposes.
32205
32206 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32207 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32208 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32209
32210 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32211 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32212 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32213
32214 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32215 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32216 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32217 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32218 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32219
32220 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32221 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32222 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32223 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32224
32225 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32226 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32227 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32228 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32229 .code
32230 text/plain
32231 text/html
32232 application/octet-stream
32233 image/jpeg
32234 audio/midi
32235 .endd
32236 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32237 empty string.
32238
32239 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32240 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32241 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32242 containing the decoded data.
32243 .endlist
32244
32245 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32246 .vlist
32247 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32248 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32249 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32250 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32251 RFC2047
32252 or RFC2231
32253 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32254 If no filename was
32255 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32256
32257 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32258 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32259 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32260 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32261
32262 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32263 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32264 follows:
32265
32266 .olist
32267 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32268
32269 .next
32270 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32271 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32272
32273 .next
32274 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32275 and the rest are attachments.
32276
32277 .next
32278 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32279 .endlist olist
32280
32281 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32282 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32283 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32284 .code
32285 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32286 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32287 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32288 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32289 .endd
32290 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32291 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32292 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32293 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32294 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32295
32296 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32297 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32298 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32299 decoding is fully recursive.
32300
32301 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32302 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32303 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32304 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32305 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32306 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32307 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32308 .endlist
32309
32310
32311
32312 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32313 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32314 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32315 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32316 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32317
32318 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32319 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32320 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32321 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32322 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32323
32324 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32325 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32326 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32327 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32328 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32329 32K characters are checked.
32330
32331 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32332 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32333 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32334 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32335 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32336 .code
32337 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32338 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32339 .endd
32340 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32341 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32342 matching regular expression.
32343 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32344 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32345
32346 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32347 CPU-intensive.
32348
32349 .ecindex IIDcosca
32350
32351
32352
32353
32354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32356
32357 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32358 "Local scan function"
32359 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32360 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32361 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32362 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32363 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32364
32365 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32366 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32367 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32368 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32369 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32370
32371 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32372 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32373 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32374 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32375
32376 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32377 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32378 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32379 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32380
32381 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32382 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32383 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32384 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32385 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32386 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32387 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32388 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32389 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32390
32391
32392
32393 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32394 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32395 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32396 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32397 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32398 directory, so you might set
32399 .code
32400 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32401 .endd
32402 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32403 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32404 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32405 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32406 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32407 _src/local_scan.c_.
32408
32409 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32410 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32411 .code
32412 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32413 .endd
32414 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32415
32416
32417
32418
32419 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32420 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32421 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32422 .code
32423 #include "local_scan.h"
32424 .endd
32425 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32426 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32427 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32428 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32429 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32430 strings and pointers to character strings:
32431 .code
32432 #define CS (char *)
32433 #define CCS (const char *)
32434 #define CSS (char **)
32435 #define US (unsigned char *)
32436 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32437 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32438 .endd
32439 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32440 .code
32441 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32442 .endd
32443 The arguments are as follows:
32444
32445 .ilist
32446 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32447 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32448 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32449
32450 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32451 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32452 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32453 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32454 case this changes in some future version.
32455 .next
32456 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32457 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32458 .endlist
32459
32460 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32461
32462 .vlist
32463 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32464 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32465 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32466 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32467 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32468 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32469
32470 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32471 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32472 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32473
32474 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32475 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32476 queued without immediate delivery.
32477
32478 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32479 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32480 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32481 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32482 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32483 used.
32484
32485 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32486 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32487 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32488 problem"& is used.
32489
32490 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32491 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32492 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32493 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32494 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32495 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32496 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32497
32498 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32499 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32500 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32501 .endlist
32502
32503 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32504 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32505 &%-oe%& command line options.
32506
32507
32508
32509 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32510 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32511 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32512 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32513 want to do this, you must have the line
32514 .code
32515 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32516 .endd
32517 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32518 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32519 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32520 to define them.
32521
32522 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32523 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32524 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32525 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32526 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32527 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32528 .code
32529 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32530 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32531
32532 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32533 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32534 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32535 };
32536
32537 int local_scan_options_count =
32538 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32539 .endd
32540 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32541 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32542 .code
32543 begin local_scan
32544 my_integer = 99
32545 my_string = some string of text...
32546 .endd
32547 The available types of option data are as follows:
32548
32549 .vlist
32550 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32551 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32552 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32553 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32554 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32555 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32556 values.)
32557
32558 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32559 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32560 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32561 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32562
32563 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32564 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32565 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32566 Exim.
32567
32568 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32569 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32570 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32571 printed with the suffix K or M.
32572
32573 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32574 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32575 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32576 always output in octal.
32577
32578 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32579 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32580 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32581
32582 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32583 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32584 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32585 .endlist
32586
32587 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32588 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32589
32590
32591
32592 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32593 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32594 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32595 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32596 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32597 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32598 C variables are as follows:
32599
32600 .vlist
32601 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32602 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32603 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32604
32605 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32606 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32607 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32608
32609 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32610 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32611 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32612 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32613
32614 .ilist
32615 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32616 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32617 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32618
32619 .next
32620 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32621 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32622 of debugging bits.
32623 .endlist ilist
32624
32625 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32626 selected, you should use code like this:
32627 .code
32628 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32629 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32630 .endd
32631 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32632 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32633 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32634
32635 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32636 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32637 discussed below.
32638
32639 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32640 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32641
32642 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32643 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32644
32645 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32646 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32647 &%-bh%& command line option.
32648
32649 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32650 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32651 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32652
32653 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32654 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32655 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32656 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32657
32658 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32659 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32660 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32661
32662 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32663 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32664
32665 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32666 The number of accepted recipients.
32667
32668 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32669 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32670 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32671 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32672 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32673 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32674 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32675 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32676 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32677 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32678 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32679 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32680
32681 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32682 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32683
32684 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32685 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32686 locally-submitted messages.
32687
32688 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32689 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32690 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32691
32692 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32693 The name of the sending host, if known.
32694
32695 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32696 The port on the sending host.
32697
32698 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32699 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32700
32701 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32702 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32703
32704 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32705 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32706 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32707 .endlist
32708
32709
32710 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32711 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32712 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32713 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32714 their type to *.
32715
32716
32717 .vlist
32718 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32719 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32720
32721 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32722 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32723 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32724 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32725 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32726 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32727 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32728
32729 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32730 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32731 internal newlines.
32732
32733 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32734 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32735 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32736 .endlist
32737
32738
32739
32740 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32741 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32742
32743 .vlist
32744 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32745 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32746
32747 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32748 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32749 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32750 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32751
32752 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32753 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32754 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32755 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32756 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32757 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32758 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32759 is NULL for all recipients.
32760 .endlist
32761
32762
32763
32764 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32765 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32766 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32767 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32768 release:
32769
32770 .vlist
32771 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32772 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32773
32774 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32775 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32776 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32777 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32778
32779 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32780 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32781 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32782 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32783 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32784
32785 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32786
32787 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32788 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32789 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32790 return value is as follows:
32791
32792 .ilist
32793 >= 0
32794
32795 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32796 ending status.
32797
32798 .next
32799 < 0 and > &--256
32800
32801 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32802 signal number.
32803
32804 .next
32805 &--256
32806
32807 The process timed out.
32808 .next
32809 &--257
32810
32811 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32812 .endlist
32813
32814 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32815 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32816 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32817 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32818 forks a subprocess that is running
32819 .code
32820 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32821 .endd
32822 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32823 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32824 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32825 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32826
32827 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32828 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32829 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32830 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32831
32832
32833 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32834 *sender_authentication)*&
32835 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32836 that it runs is:
32837 .display
32838 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32839 .endd
32840 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32841
32842
32843 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32844 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32845 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32846 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32847 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32848 .code
32849 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32850 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32851 .endd
32852
32853 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32854 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32855 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32856 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32857 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32858 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32859 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32860 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32861
32862 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32863 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32864 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32865 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32866 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32867 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32868
32869 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32870 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32871 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32872 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32873
32874 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32875 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32876 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32877 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32878 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32879 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32880 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32881 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32882 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32883 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32884 .code
32885 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32886 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32887 .endd
32888 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32889 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32890
32891
32892 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32893 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32894 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32895 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32896 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32897
32898
32899 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32900 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32901 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32902 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32903 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32904 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32905 .code
32906 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32907 .endd
32908 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32909 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32910 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32911 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32912 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32913 zero-terminated.
32914
32915 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32916 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32917 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32918 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32919 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32920 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32921 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32922 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32923
32924 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32925 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32926 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32927 .display
32928 &`OK `& match succeeded
32929 &`FAIL `& match failed
32930 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32931 .endd
32932 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32933 inability to contact a database.
32934
32935 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32936 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32937 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32938 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32939 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32940
32941 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32942 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32943 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32944 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32945 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32946
32947 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32948 uschar&~*list)*&"
32949 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32950 expected to be
32951 .code
32952 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32953 .endd
32954 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32955 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32956 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32957 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32958 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32959 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32960 failed.
32961
32962 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32963 *format,&~...)*&"
32964 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32965 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32966 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32967 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32968 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32969 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32970
32971
32972 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32973 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32974 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32975 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32976
32977 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32978 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32979 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32980 value afterwards. For example:
32981 .code
32982 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32983 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32984 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32985 .endd
32986
32987 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32988 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32989 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32990 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32991 address.
32992 .endlist
32993
32994
32995 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32996 .vlist
32997 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32998 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32999 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33000 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33001 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33002 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33003 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33004 binary string is returned with an error message.
33005
33006 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33007 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33008 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33009
33010 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33011 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33012 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33013 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33014 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33015
33016 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33017 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33018 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33019
33020 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33021 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33022 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33023 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33024 with translation.
33025
33026
33027 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33028 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33029 below.
33030
33031 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33032 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33033 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33034 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33035 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33036 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33037 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33038 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33039 is involved.
33040
33041 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33042 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33043
33044 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33045 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33046 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33047 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33048 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33049 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33050 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33051 .code
33052 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33053 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33054 .endd
33055 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33056 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33057 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33058 multiple output lines.
33059
33060 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33061 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33062 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33063 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33064 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33065 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33066 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33067 is an error.
33068
33069 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33070 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33071 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33072 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33073
33074 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33075 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33076 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33077
33078 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33079 See below.
33080
33081 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33082 See below.
33083
33084 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33085 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33086 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33087 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33088 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33089 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33090 more discussion.
33091 .endlist
33092
33093
33094
33095 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33096 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33097 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33098 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33099 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33100 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33101 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33102 terminates.
33103
33104 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33105 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33106 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33107 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33108
33109 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33110 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33111 .code
33112 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33113 .endd
33114 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33115 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33116 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33117 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33118
33119 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33120 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33121 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33122 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33123 &%store_pool%&.
33124 .ecindex IIDlosca
33125
33126
33127
33128
33129 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33131
33132 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33133 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33134 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33135 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33136 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33137 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33138 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33139 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33140
33141 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33142 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33143 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33144 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33145 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33146
33147 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33148 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33149 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33150 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33151 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33152 prevent it happening on retries.
33153
33154 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33155 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33156 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33157 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33158 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33159 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33160 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33161 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33162
33163
33164 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33165 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33166 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33167 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33168 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33169 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33170 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33171 .code
33172 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33173 system_filter_user = exim
33174 .endd
33175 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33176 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33177 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33178 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33179 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33180 by the &%reply%& command.
33181
33182
33183 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33184 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33185 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33186 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33187
33188 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33189 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33190
33191
33192
33193 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33194 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33195 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33196 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33197 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33198 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33199 they cause errors.
33200
33201 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33202 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33203 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33204 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33205 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33206 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33207 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33208
33209 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33210 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33211 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33212 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33213 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33214
33215 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33216 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33217 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33218 to which users' filter files can refer.
33219
33220
33221
33222 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33223 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33224 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33225 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33226 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33227
33228
33229
33230 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33231 .cindex "freezing messages"
33232 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33233 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33234 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33235 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33236 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33237 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33238 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33239 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33240 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33241 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33242 .code
33243 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33244 .endd
33245 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33246
33247 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33248 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33249 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33250 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33251 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33252 run.
33253
33254 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33255 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33256 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33257 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33258
33259 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33260 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33261 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33262 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33263 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33264 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33265 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33266 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33267 message. For example:
33268 .code
33269 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33270 because it contains attachments that we are \
33271 not prepared to receive."
33272 .endd
33273
33274 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33275 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33276 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33277 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33278 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33279 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33280 use, for example
33281 .code
33282 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33283 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33284 .endd
33285 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33286 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33287 generated by the filter.
33288
33289 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33290 &%defer%&,
33291 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33292 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33293 as
33294 .code
33295 mail ...
33296 freeze
33297 .endd
33298 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33299 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33300 take place.
33301
33302
33303
33304 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33305 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33306 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33307 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33308 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33309 .code
33310 headers add <string>
33311 headers remove <string>
33312 .endd
33313 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33314 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33315 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33316 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33317 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33318
33319 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33320 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33321 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33322 example:
33323 .code
33324 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33325 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33326 X-header-2: ...."
33327 .endd
33328 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33329 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33330 space after input continuations is ignored.
33331
33332 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33333 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33334 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33335 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33336 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33337
33338 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33339 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33340 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33341 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33342 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33343 used for all recipients of the message.
33344
33345 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33346 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33347 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33348 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33349 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33350 until the message is actually being written (see section
33351 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33352
33353 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33354 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33355 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33356 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33357 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33358 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33359 modified more than once.
33360
33361 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33362 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33363 For example:
33364 .code
33365 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33366 headers remove "Subject"
33367 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33368 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33369 .endd
33370
33371
33372
33373 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33374 .cindex "envelope sender"
33375 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33376 .code
33377 errors_to <some address>
33378 .endd
33379 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33380 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33381 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33382 might use
33383 .code
33384 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33385 .endd
33386 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33387 address if its delivery failed.
33388
33389
33390
33391 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33392 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33393 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33394 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33395 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33396 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33397 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33398 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33399 which implements such a filter:
33400 .code
33401 central_filter:
33402 check_local_user
33403 driver = redirect
33404 domains = +local_domains
33405 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33406 no_verify
33407 allow_filter
33408 allow_freeze
33409 .endd
33410 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33411 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33412 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33413 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33414
33415 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33416 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33417 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33418 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33419 normal way.
33420 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33421 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33422 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33423
33424
33425
33426
33427
33428
33429 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33430 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33431
33432 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33433 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33434 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33435 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33436 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33437 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33438 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33439 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33440
33441 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33442 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33443 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33444 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33445 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33446
33447 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33448 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33449 loopback interface specially in any way.
33450
33451 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33452 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33453
33454
33455
33456
33457 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33458 .cindex "message" "submission"
33459 .cindex "submission mode"
33460 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33461 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33462 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33463 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33464 .code
33465 control = submission
33466 .endd
33467 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33468 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33469 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33470 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33471 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33472 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33473 .code
33474 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33475 control = submission
33476 .endd
33477 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33478 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33479 is used to separate options. For example:
33480 .code
33481 control = submission/sender_retain
33482 .endd
33483 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33484 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33485 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33486 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33487 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33488 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33489 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33490
33491 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33492 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33493 example:
33494 .code
33495 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33496 .endd
33497 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33498 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33499 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33500 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33501 .code
33502 accept authenticated = *
33503 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33504 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33505 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33506 .endd
33507 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33508 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33509 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33510 .code
33511 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33512 .endd
33513 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33514 line would be:
33515 .code
33516 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33517 .endd
33518 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33519 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33520 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33521 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33522
33523 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33524 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33525 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33526 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33527 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33528 spoof another's address.
33529
33530 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33531 .cindex "line endings"
33532 .cindex "carriage return"
33533 .cindex "linefeed"
33534 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33535 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33536 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33537 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33538 use CRLF or just CR.
33539
33540 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33541 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33542 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33543 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33544 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33545 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33546 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33547 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33548 follows:
33549
33550 .ilist
33551 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33552 .next
33553 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33554 is ignored.
33555 .next
33556 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33557 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33558 terminator.
33559 .next
33560 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33561 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33562 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33563 people trying to play silly games.
33564 .next
33565 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33566 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33567 line.
33568 .endlist
33569
33570
33571
33572
33573
33574 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33575 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33576 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33577 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33578 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33579 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33580 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33581 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33582
33583 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33584 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33585 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33586 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33587 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33588
33589 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33590 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33591 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33592 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33593 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33594 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33595 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33596 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33597
33598
33599
33600
33601 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33602 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33603 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33604 .cindex "sender" "address"
33605 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33606 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33607 .cindex "envelope sender"
33608 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33609 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33610 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33611 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33612 .code
33613 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33614 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33615 .endd
33616 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33617 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33618 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33619 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33620 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33621 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33622 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33623 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33624 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33625
33626 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33627 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33628 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33629 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33630 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33631 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33632 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33633
33634 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33635 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33636 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33637
33638 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33639 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33640 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33641 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33642
33643
33644
33645 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33646 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33647 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33648 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33649 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33650 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33651 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33652 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33653
33654 .blockquote
33655 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33656 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33657 .endblockquote
33658
33659 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33660 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33661 follows:
33662
33663 .ilist
33664 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33665 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33666 .next
33667 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33668 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33669 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33670 .next
33671 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33672 also removed.
33673 .next
33674 For a locally-submitted message,
33675 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33676 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33677 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33678 included in log lines in this case.
33679 .next
33680 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33681 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33682 .endlist
33683
33684
33685
33686
33687 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33688 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33689 includes the header line:
33690 .code
33691 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33692 .endd
33693
33694 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33695 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33696 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33697 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33698 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33699 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33700
33701
33702 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33703 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33704 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33705 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33706 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33707 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33708
33709 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33710 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33711 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33712 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33713 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33714 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33715 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33716 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33717 messages.
33718
33719
33720 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33721 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33722 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
33723 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33724 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33725 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33726 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33727 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33728 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33729 messages.
33730
33731
33732 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33733 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33734 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
33735 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33736 .cindex "message" "submission"
33737 .cindex "submission mode"
33738 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33739 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33740
33741 .ilist
33742 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33743 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33744 .next
33745 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33746 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33747 .olist
33748 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33749 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33750 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33751 .next
33752 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33753 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33754 .next
33755 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33756 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33757 .endlist
33758 .endlist
33759
33760 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33761
33762 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33763 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33764 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33765 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33766 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33767 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33768 &%qualify_domain%&.
33769
33770 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33771 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33772 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33773 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33774
33775
33776 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33777 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33778 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
33779 .cindex "message" "submission"
33780 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33781 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33782 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33783 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33784 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33785 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33786 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33787 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33788 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33789 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33790
33791
33792 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33793 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33794 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
33795 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33796 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33797 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33798
33799 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33800 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33801 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33802 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33803
33804 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33805 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33806 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33807
33808
33809 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33810 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33811 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
33812 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33813 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33814 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33815 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33816 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33817 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33818 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33819 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33820 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33821
33822
33823
33824 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33825 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33826 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
33827 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33828 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33829 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33830 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33831 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33832 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33833
33834
33835
33836 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33837 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33838 .cindex "message" "submission"
33839 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
33840 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33841 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33842 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33843 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33844 control setting.
33845
33846 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33847 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33848 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33849 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33850 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33851 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33852 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33853 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33854 line is added to the message.
33855
33856 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33857 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33858 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33859 options true at the same time.
33860
33861 .cindex "submission mode"
33862 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33863 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33864 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33865 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33866
33867 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33868 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33869 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33870 created as follows:
33871
33872 .ilist
33873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33874 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33875 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33876 .next
33877 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33878 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33879 .next
33880 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33881 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33882 .endlist
33883
33884 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33885 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33886 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33887 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33888
33889 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33890 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33891 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33892 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33893
33894
33895
33896 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33897 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33898 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33899 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33900 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33901 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33902 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33903 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33904 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33905
33906 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33907 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33908 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33909 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33910 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33911 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33912
33913 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33914 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33915 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33916
33917 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33918 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33919 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33920 .code
33921 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33922 X-added-second: another added header line
33923 .endd
33924 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33925
33926 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33927 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33928 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33929
33930 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33931 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33932 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33933 not part of the names. For example:
33934 .code
33935 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33936 .endd
33937
33938 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33939 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33940 Each item is separately expanded.
33941 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33942 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33943 will act as list separators.
33944
33945 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33946 items are expanded at routing time,
33947 and then associated with all addresses that are
33948 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33949 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33950 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33951
33952 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33953 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33954 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33955 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33956
33957 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33958 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33959 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33960 requirements.
33961
33962 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33963 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33964 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33965 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33966 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33967 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33968 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33969
33970 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33971 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33972 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33973 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33974
33975 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33976 the following consequences:
33977
33978 .ilist
33979 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33980 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33981 to it, at all times.
33982 .next
33983 Header lines that are added by a router's
33984 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33985 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33986 .next
33987 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33988 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33989 .next
33990 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33991 a later router or by a transport.
33992 .next
33993 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33994 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33995 .code
33996 headers_remove = subject
33997 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33998 .endd
33999 .endlist
34000
34001 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34002 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34003
34004
34005
34006
34007
34008 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34009 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34010 .cindex "constructed address"
34011 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34012 the form
34013 .display
34014 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34015 .endd
34016 For example:
34017 .code
34018 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34019 .endd
34020 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34021 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34022 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34023 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34024 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34025 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34026 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34027 there is no password file entry.
34028
34029 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34030 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34031 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34032 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34033 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34034 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34035 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34036 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34037 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34038
34039
34040
34041 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34042 .cindex "case of local parts"
34043 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34044 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34045 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34046 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34047 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34048 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34049 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34050 router option.
34051
34052 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34053 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34054 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34055 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34056 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34057 .code
34058 correct_case:
34059 driver = redirect
34060 domains = +local_domains
34061 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34062 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34063 @$domain
34064 .endd
34065 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34066 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34067 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34068 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34069 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34070
34071
34072
34073 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34074 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34075 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34076 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34077 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34078 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34079 empty components for compatibility.
34080
34081
34082
34083 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34084 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34085 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34086 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34087 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34088 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34089
34090 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34091 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34092 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34093 example, a header such as
34094 .code
34095 To: hare@teaparty
34096 .endd
34097 might get rewritten as
34098 .code
34099 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34100 .endd
34101 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34102 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34103 been routed.
34104
34105 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34106 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34107 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34108 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34109 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34110 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34111 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34112
34113
34114
34115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34117
34118 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34119 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34120 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34121 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34122 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34123 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34124 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34125
34126 .ilist
34127 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34128 .next
34129 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34130 .next
34131 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34132 .endlist
34133
34134 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34135
34136 .ilist
34137 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34138 .next
34139 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34140 &"lmtp"&);
34141 .next
34142 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34143 transport);
34144 .next
34145 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34146 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34147 .endlist
34148
34149 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34150 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34151 used to contain the envelope information.
34152
34153
34154
34155 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34156 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34157 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34158 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34159 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34160 .cindex "EHLO"
34161 .cindex "HELO"
34162 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34163 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34164 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34165 processing is the same in both cases.
34166
34167 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34168 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34169 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34170 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34171 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34172 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34173 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34174 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34175 suppressed.
34176
34177 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34178 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34179 required for the transaction.
34180
34181 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34182 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34183 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34184 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34185 is called for verification.
34186
34187 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34188 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34189 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34190
34191 .cindex "carriage return"
34192 .cindex "linefeed"
34193 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34194 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34195 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34196 line terminator.
34197
34198 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34199 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34200 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34201 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34202 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34203 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34204 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34205 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34206 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34207
34208 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34209 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34210 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34211 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34212
34213 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34214 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34215 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34216 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34217
34218 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34219 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34220 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34221 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34222 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34223 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34224 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34225 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34226 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34227 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34228
34229 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34230 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34231
34232 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34233 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34234 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34235 square bracket of the IP address.
34236
34237
34238
34239
34240 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34241 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34242 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34243 .cindex "host" "error"
34244 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34245 message errors, and recipient errors.
34246
34247 .vlist
34248 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34249 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34250 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34251
34252 .ilist
34253 Connection refused or timed out,
34254 .next
34255 Any error response code on connection,
34256 .next
34257 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34258 .next
34259 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34260 .next
34261 I/O errors at any time,
34262 .next
34263 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34264 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34265 .endlist ilist
34266
34267 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34268 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34269 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34270 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34271 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34272 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34273 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34274 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34275
34276 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34277 .cindex "message" "error"
34278 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34279 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34280 message errors are:
34281
34282 .ilist
34283 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34284 the data,
34285 .next
34286 Timeout after MAIL,
34287 .next
34288 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34289 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34290 connection at any other time.
34291 .endlist ilist
34292
34293 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34294 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34295 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34296 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34297 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34298 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34299 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34300 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34301 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34302 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34303
34304 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34305 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34306 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34307 response to MAIL.
34308
34309 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34310 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34311 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34312 recipient errors are:
34313
34314 .ilist
34315 Any error response to RCPT,
34316 .next
34317 Timeout after RCPT.
34318 .endlist
34319
34320 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34321 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34322 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34323 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34324 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34325 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34326 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34327 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34328 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34329 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34330 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34331 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34332 the retry clock is reset.
34333
34334 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34335 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34336 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34337 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34338 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34339 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34340 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34341 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34342 recipient's retry time.
34343 .endlist
34344
34345 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34346 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34347 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34348 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34349 until the next delivery attempt.
34350
34351 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34352 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34353 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34354 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34355 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34356 is created.
34357
34358 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34359 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34360 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34361 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34362 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34363 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34364 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34365
34366 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34367 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34368 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34369 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34370 then to be treated as a host error.
34371
34372 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34373 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34374 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34375 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34376 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34377
34378
34379
34380
34381 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34382 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34383 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34384 .cindex "inetd"
34385 .cindex "daemon"
34386 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34387 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34388 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34389 .code
34390 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34391 .endd
34392 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34393 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34394 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34395 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34396 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34397 stream and exits with an error code.
34398
34399 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34400 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34401 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34402 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34403
34404 .cindex "carriage return"
34405 .cindex "linefeed"
34406 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34407 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34408 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34409 line terminator.
34410 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34411 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34412 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34413
34414 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34415 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34416 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34417 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34418 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34419 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34420 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34421 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34422
34423 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34424 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34425 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34426 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34427 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34428 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34429 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34430 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34431 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34432
34433 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34434 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34435 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34436
34437 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34438 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34439 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34440 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34441 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34442
34443 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34444 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34445 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34446 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34447 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34448 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34449 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34450
34451 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34452 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34453 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34454 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34455 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34456
34457 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34458 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34459 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34460 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34461 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34462 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34463 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34464 a delivery process.
34465
34466 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34467 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34468 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34469 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34470 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34471
34472 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34473 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34474 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34475 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34476
34477 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34478 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34479 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34480
34481
34482
34483 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34484 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34485 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34486 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34487 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34488 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34489 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34490 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34491
34492
34493 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34494 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34495 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34496 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34497 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34498 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34499 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34500 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34501 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34502 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34503 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34504
34505
34506
34507 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34508 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34509 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34510 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34511 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34512 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34513 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34514 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34515
34516 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34517 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34518 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34519 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34520 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34521 counted.
34522
34523 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34524 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34525 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34526
34527 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34528 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34529 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34530 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34531 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34532
34533
34534
34535
34536 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34537 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34538 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34539 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34540
34541 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34542 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34543 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34544 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34545 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34546 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34547 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34548 SMTP response codes.
34549
34550 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34551 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34552 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34553 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34554 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34555 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34556 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34557 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34558 RCPT failures.
34559
34560
34561
34562 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34563 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34564 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34565 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34566 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34567 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34568 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34569
34570 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34571 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34572 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34573 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34574 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34575 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34576 argument. For example,
34577 .code
34578 ETRN #brigadoon
34579 .endd
34580 runs the command
34581 .code
34582 exim -R brigadoon
34583 .endd
34584 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34585 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34586 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34587 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34588 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34589
34590 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34591 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34592 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34593 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34594 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34595 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34596 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34597 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34598
34599 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34600 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34601 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34602 whatever the form of its argument. For
34603 example:
34604 .code
34605 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34606 $sender_host_address
34607 .endd
34608 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34609 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34610 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34611 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34612 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34613 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34614 for it to change them before running the command.
34615
34616
34617
34618 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34619 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34620 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34621 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34622 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34623 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34624 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34625 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34626 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34627 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34628 runs for RCPT commands:
34629 .code
34630 accept hosts = :
34631 .endd
34632 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34633
34634
34635
34636 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34637 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34638 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34639 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34640 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34641 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34642 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34643 envelope along with the message.
34644
34645 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34646 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34647 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34648 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34649 can be used to specify it.
34650
34651 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34652 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34653 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34654 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34655 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34656
34657 .vindex "&$host$&"
34658 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34659 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34660 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34661 router:
34662 .code
34663 begin routers
34664 route_append:
34665 driver = manualroute
34666 transport = smtp_appendfile
34667 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34668
34669 begin transports
34670 smtp_appendfile:
34671 driver = appendfile
34672 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34673 batch_max = 1000
34674 use_bsmtp
34675 user = exim
34676 .endd
34677 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34678 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34679 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34680
34681
34682
34683 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34684 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34685 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34686 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34687 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34688 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34689 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34690 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34691 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34692 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34693
34694 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34695 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34696
34697 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34698 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34699 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34700 make some use of automatically, for example:
34701 .code
34702 554 Unexpected end of file
34703 Transaction started in line 10
34704 Error detected in line 14
34705 .endd
34706 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34707 file, for example:
34708 .code
34709 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34710 The error message was:
34711
34712 501 '>' missing at end of address
34713
34714 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34715 The error was detected in line 12.
34716 The SMTP command at fault was:
34717
34718 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34719
34720 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34721 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34722 .endd
34723 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34724 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34725 accepted.
34726 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34727 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34728
34729
34730
34731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34733
34734 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34735 "Customizing messages"
34736 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34737 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34738 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34739 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34740 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34741
34742 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34743 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34744 option. Exim also adds the line
34745 .code
34746 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34747 .endd
34748 to all warning and bounce messages,
34749
34750
34751 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34752 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34753 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34754 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34755 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34756 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34757 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34758
34759 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34760 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34761 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34762 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34763 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34764 item.
34765
34766 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34767 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34768 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34769 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34770 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34771 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34772 option, rounded to a whole number.
34773
34774 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34775
34776 .ilist
34777 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34778 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34779 .next
34780 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34781 failing addresses with their error messages.
34782 .next
34783 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34784 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34785 .next
34786 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34787 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34788 .endlist
34789
34790 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34791 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34792 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34793 .code
34794 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34795 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34796 {: returning message to sender}}
34797 ****
34798 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34799
34800 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34801 {that you sent }{sent by
34802
34803 <$sender_address>
34804
34805 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34806 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34807 ****
34808 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34809 ****
34810 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34811 ------
34812 ****
34813 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34814 only the first
34815 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34816 ****
34817 .endd
34818 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34819 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34820 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34821 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34822 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34823 text sections:
34824
34825 .ilist
34826 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34827 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34828 .next
34829 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34830 the delayed addresses.
34831 .next
34832 The third item then ends the message.
34833 .endlist
34834
34835 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34836 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34837 .code
34838 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34839 $warn_message_delay
34840 ****
34841 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34842
34843 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34844 {that you sent }{sent by
34845
34846 <$sender_address>
34847
34848 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34849 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34850
34851 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34852 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34853 The date of the message is: $h_date
34854
34855 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34856 ****
34857 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34858 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34859 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34860 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34861 the message will be returned to you.
34862 .endd
34863 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34864 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34865 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34866 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34867 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34868 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34869 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34870 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34871 handled them.
34872
34873
34874
34875
34876 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34877 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34878
34879 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34880 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34881 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34882
34883
34884
34885 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34886 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34887 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34888 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34889 routing explicitly:
34890 .code
34891 send_to_smart_host:
34892 driver = manualroute
34893 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34894 transport = remote_smtp
34895 .endd
34896 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34897 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34898 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34899 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34900 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34901
34902
34903
34904
34905 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34906 .cindex "mailing lists"
34907 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34908 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34909 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34910
34911 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34912 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34913 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34914 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34915 .code
34916 lists:
34917 driver = redirect
34918 domains = lists.example
34919 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34920 forbid_pipe
34921 forbid_file
34922 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34923 no_more
34924 .endd
34925 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34926 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34927 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34928 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34929
34930 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34931 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34932 a mailing list.
34933
34934 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34935 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34936 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34937 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34938 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34939
34940 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34941 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34942 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34943 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34944 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34945 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34946 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34947 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34948 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34949
34950
34951
34952 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34953 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34954 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34955 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34956 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34957 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34958 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34959
34960 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34961 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34962 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34963 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34964 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34965
34966
34967
34968 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34969 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34970 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34971 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34972 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34973 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34974 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34975 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34976 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34977 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34978
34979 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34980 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34981 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34982 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34983 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34984 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34985 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34986 pre-existing messages.
34987
34988 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34989 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34990 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34991 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34992 one level of expansion anyway.
34993
34994
34995
34996 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34997 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34998 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34999 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35000 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35001 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35002
35003 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35004 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35005 .code
35006 lists_request:
35007 driver = redirect
35008 domains = lists.example
35009 local_part_suffix = -request
35010 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35011 no_more
35012
35013 lists_post:
35014 driver = redirect
35015 domains = lists.example
35016 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35017 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35018 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35019 forbid_pipe
35020 forbid_file
35021 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35022 no_more
35023
35024 lists_closed:
35025 driver = redirect
35026 domains = lists.example
35027 allow_fail
35028 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35029 .endd
35030 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35031 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35032 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35033 mailing list.
35034
35035 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35036 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35037 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35038 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35039 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35040 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35041 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35042 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35043 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35044
35045 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35046 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35047 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35048
35049
35050
35051
35052 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35053 .cindex "VERP"
35054 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35055 .cindex "envelope sender"
35056 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35057 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35058 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35059 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35060 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35061 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35062
35063 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35064 .oindex &%return_path%&
35065 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35066 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35067 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35068 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35069 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35070 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35071 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35072 .code
35073 verp_smtp:
35074 driver = smtp
35075 max_rcpt = 1
35076 return_path = \
35077 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35078 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35079 .endd
35080 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35081 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35082 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35083 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35084 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35085 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35086 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35087 rewritten as
35088 .code
35089 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35090 .endd
35091 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35092 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35093 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35094 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35095 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35096 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35097
35098 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35099 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35100 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35101 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35102 .code
35103 dnslookup:
35104 driver = dnslookup
35105 domains = ! +local_domains
35106 transport = \
35107 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35108 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35109 no_more
35110 .endd
35111 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35112 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35113 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35114 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35115 address.
35116
35117 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35118 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35119 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35120 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35121 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35122 .code
35123 verp_dnslookup:
35124 driver = dnslookup
35125 domains = ! +local_domains
35126 transport = remote_smtp
35127 errors_to = \
35128 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35129 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35130 no_more
35131 .endd
35132 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35133 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35134 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35135 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35136 them.
35137
35138 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35139 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35140 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35141 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35142 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35143 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35144 used).
35145
35146
35147
35148
35149
35150
35151 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35152 .cindex "virtual domains"
35153 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35154 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35155 meanings:
35156
35157 .ilist
35158 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35159 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35160 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35161 .next
35162 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35163 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35164 have login accounts on that host.
35165 .endlist
35166
35167 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35168 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35169 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35170 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35171 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35172 to a router of this form:
35173 .code
35174 virtual:
35175 driver = redirect
35176 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35177 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35178 no_more
35179 .endd
35180 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35181 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35182 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35183 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35184 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35185 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35186
35187 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35188 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35189 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35190 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35191
35192 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35193 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35194 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35195 .code
35196 my_domains:
35197 driver = accept
35198 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35199 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35200 transport = my_mailboxes
35201 .endd
35202 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35203 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35204 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35205 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35206 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35207 follows:
35208 .code
35209 my_mailboxes:
35210 driver = appendfile
35211 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35212 user = mail
35213 .endd
35214 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35215 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35216
35217 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35218 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35219 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35220 information about the domains.
35221
35222
35223
35224 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35225 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35226 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35227 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35228 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35229 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35230 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35231 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35232 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35233 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35234 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35235 example, consider this router:
35236 .code
35237 userforward:
35238 driver = redirect
35239 check_local_user
35240 file = $home/.forward
35241 local_part_suffix = -*
35242 local_part_suffix_optional
35243 allow_filter
35244 .endd
35245 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35246 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35247 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35248 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35249 .code
35250 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35251 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35252 endif
35253 .endd
35254 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35255 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35256 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35257 control over which suffixes are valid.
35258
35259 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35260 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35261 another MTA:
35262 .code
35263 userforward:
35264 driver = redirect
35265 check_local_user
35266 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35267 local_part_suffix = -*
35268 local_part_suffix_optional
35269 allow_filter
35270 .endd
35271 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35272 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35273 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35274 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35275 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35276
35277
35278
35279 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35280 .cindex "vacation processing"
35281 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35282 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35283 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35284 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35285 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35286
35287 .ilist
35288 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35289 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35290 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35291 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35292 .code
35293 spqr, vacation-spqr
35294 .endd
35295 .next
35296 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35297 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35298 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35299 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35300 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35301 message.
35302 .endlist
35303
35304 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35305 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35306
35307
35308
35309 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35310 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35311 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35312 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35313 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35314 each day's messages.
35315
35316 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35317 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35318 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35319 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35320
35321
35322
35323 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35324 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35325 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35326 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35327 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35328 permanently connected.
35329
35330 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35331 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35332 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35333
35334
35335 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35336 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35337 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35338 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35339 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35340 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35341 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35342 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35343
35344 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35345 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35346 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35347 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35348 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35349 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35350 if required.
35351
35352 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35353 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35354 intermittent host. For example:
35355 .code
35356 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35357 .endd
35358 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35359 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35360 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35361 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35362 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35363 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35364 immediately.
35365
35366 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35367 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35368 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35369 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35370 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35371 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35372 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35373
35374
35375
35376 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35377 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35378 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35379 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35380 delivered immediately.
35381
35382 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35383 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35384 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35385 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35386 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35387 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35388 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35389 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35390 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35391 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35392 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35393 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35394 single SMTP connection.
35395
35396
35397
35398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35400
35401 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35402 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35403 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35404 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35405 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35406 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35407 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35408 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35409 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35410 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35411 messages this way.
35412
35413 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35414 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35415 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35416 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35417 email is not desirable.
35418
35419 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35420 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35421 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35422 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35423 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35424 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35425 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35426
35427 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35428 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35429 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35430 before sending a message to the smart host.
35431
35432 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35433 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35434 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35435
35436 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35437 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35438 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35439 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35440 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35441 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35442 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35443
35444 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35445 following ways:
35446
35447 .ilist
35448 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35449 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35450 .next
35451 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35452 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35453 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35454 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35455 successful, a zero return code is given.
35456 .next
35457 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35458 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35459 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35460 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35461 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35462 are.
35463 .next
35464 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35465 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35466 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35467 .next
35468 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35469 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35470 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35471 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35472 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35473 .next
35474 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35475 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35476 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35477 .next
35478 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35479 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35480 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35481 are ever generated.
35482 .next
35483 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35484 .next
35485 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35486 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35487 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35488 .endlist
35489
35490 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35491 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35492 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35493 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35494 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35495 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35496
35497
35498
35499
35500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35502
35503 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35504 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35505 .cindex "log" "types of"
35506 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35507 and the panic log:
35508
35509 .ilist
35510 .cindex "main log"
35511 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35512 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35513 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35514 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35515 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35516 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35517 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35518 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35519 .next
35520 .cindex "reject log"
35521 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35522 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35523 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35524 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35525 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35526 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35527 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35528 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35529 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35530 false.
35531 .next
35532 .cindex "panic log"
35533 .cindex "system log"
35534 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35535 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35536 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35537 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35538 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35539 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35540 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35541 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35542 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35543 .endlist
35544
35545 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35546 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35547 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35548 .code
35549 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35550 by QUIT
35551 .endd
35552 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35553 ways of changing this:
35554
35555 .ilist
35556 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35557 you set
35558 .code
35559 timezone = UTC
35560 .endd
35561 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35562 .next
35563 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35564 example:
35565 .code
35566 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35567 .endd
35568 .endlist
35569
35570 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35571 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35572 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35573 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35574 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35575 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35576
35577
35578
35579
35580 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35581 .cindex "log" "destination"
35582 .cindex "log" "to file"
35583 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35584 .cindex "syslog"
35585 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35586 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35587 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35588 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35589 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35590 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35591 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35592
35593 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35594 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35595 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35596 references to the host name:
35597 .code
35598 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35599 .endd
35600 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35601 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35602 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35603 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35604 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35605 log at all.
35606
35607 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35608 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35609 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35610 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35611 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35612 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35613 implying the use of a default path.
35614
35615 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35616 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35617 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35618 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35619 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35620 equivalent to the setting:
35621 .code
35622 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35623 .endd
35624 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35625 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35626 that is where the logs are written.
35627
35628 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35629 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35630
35631 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35632 .display
35633 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35634 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35635 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35636 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35637 .endd
35638 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35639 error is logged.
35640
35641
35642
35643 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35644 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35645 .cindex "cycling logs"
35646 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35647 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35648 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35649 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35650 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35651 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35652 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35653
35654 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35655 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35656 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35657 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35658 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35659 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35660 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35661 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35662 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35663 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35664 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35665 renamed.
35666
35667
35668
35669 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35670 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35671 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35672 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35673 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35674 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35675 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35676 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35677 .code
35678 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35679 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35680 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35681 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35682 .endd
35683 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35684 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35685 .code
35686 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35687 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35688 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35689 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35690 .endd
35691 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35692 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35693 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35694 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35695
35696 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35697 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35698 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35699 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35700 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35701 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35702 log names:
35703 .code
35704 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35705 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35706 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35707 /var/log/exim/panic
35708 .endd
35709
35710
35711 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35712 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35713 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35714 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35715 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35716 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35717 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35718 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35719 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35720 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35721 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35722 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35723 the time and host name to each line.
35724 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35725
35726 .ilist
35727 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35728 .next
35729 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35730 .next
35731 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35732 .endlist
35733
35734 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35735 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35736 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35737 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35738
35739 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35740 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35741 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35742 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35743 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35744 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35745 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35746 RFC 3164, you should set
35747 .code
35748 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35749 .endd
35750 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35751 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35752
35753 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35754 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35755 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35756 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35757 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35758 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35759 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35760 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35761 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35762 .code
35763 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35764 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35765 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35766 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35767 [5/5] mple>)
35768 .endd
35769 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35770 (LOG_NOTICE):
35771 .code
35772 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35773 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35774 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35775 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35776 [5\18] .example>)
35777 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35778 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35779 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35780 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35781 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35782 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35783 [12\18] F From: <>
35784 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35785 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35786 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35787 [16\18] le>
35788 [17\18] B Bcc:
35789 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35790 .endd
35791 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35792 without modification.
35793
35794 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35795 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35796 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35797 where it is.
35798
35799
35800
35801 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35802 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35803 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35804 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35805 timestamp. The flags are:
35806 .display
35807 &`<=`& message arrival
35808 &`(=`& message fakereject
35809 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35810 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35811 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35812 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35813 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35814 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35815 .endd
35816
35817
35818 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35819 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35820 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35821 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35822 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35823 .code
35824 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35825 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35826 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35827 .endd
35828 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35829 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35830 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35831 .code
35832 R=<message id>
35833 .endd
35834 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35835
35836 .cindex "HELO"
35837 .cindex "EHLO"
35838 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35839 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35840 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35841 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35842 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35843 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35844 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35845 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35846 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35847 name in parentheses.
35848
35849 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35850 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35851 the log containing text like these examples:
35852 .code
35853 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35854 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35855 .endd
35856 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35857 on.
35858
35859 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35860 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35861 of Exim.
35862
35863 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35864 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35865 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35866 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35867 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35868 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35869 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35870 suite that was used.
35871
35872 .cindex log protocol
35873 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35874 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35875 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35876 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35877 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35878 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35879 authenticator name.
35880
35881 .cindex "size" "of message"
35882 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35883 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35884 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35885 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35886 other).
35887
35888 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35889 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35890
35891
35892
35893 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35894 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35895 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35896 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35897 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35898 to fit it on the page:
35899 .code
35900 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35901 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35902 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35903 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35904 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35905 .endd
35906 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35907 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35908 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35909 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35910 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35911
35912 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35913 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35914 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35915 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35916
35917 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35918 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35919 .display
35920 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35921 .endd
35922 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35923 parentheses afterwards.
35924
35925 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35926 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35927 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35928 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35929 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35930 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35931 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
35932 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
35933 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35934 TLS cipher information is still available.
35935
35936 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35937 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35938 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35939 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35940 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35941
35942 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35943 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35944
35945 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35946 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35947
35948
35949 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35950 .cindex "discarded messages"
35951 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35952 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35953 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35954 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35955 .code
35956 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35957 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35958 .endd
35959 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35960 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35961 .code
35962 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35963 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35964 .endd
35965
35966
35967 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35968 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35969 .code
35970 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35971 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35972 .endd
35973 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35974 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35975 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35976 .code
35977 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35978 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35979 .endd
35980 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35981 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35982 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35983
35984
35985
35986 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35987 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35988 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35989 following form is logged:
35990 .code
35991 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35992 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35993 .endd
35994 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35995 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35996 .code
35997 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35998 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35999 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36000 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36001 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36002 .endd
36003 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36004 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36005 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36006 flagged with &`**`&.
36007
36008
36009
36010 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36011 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36012 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36013 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36014 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36015
36016
36017
36018 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36019 A line of the form
36020 .code
36021 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36022 .endd
36023 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36024 at the end of its processing.
36025
36026
36027
36028
36029 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36030 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36031 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36032 the following table:
36033 .display
36034 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36035 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36036 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36037 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36038 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36039 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36040 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36041 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36042 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36043 &`H `& host name and IP address
36044 &`I `& local interface used
36045 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36046 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36047 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36048 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36049 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36050 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36051 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36052 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36053 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36054 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36055 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36056 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36057 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36058 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36059 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36060 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36061 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36062 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36063 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36064 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36065 .endd
36066
36067
36068 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36069 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36070 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36071
36072 .ilist
36073 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36074 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36075 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36076 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36077 during the first delivery attempt.
36078 .next
36079 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36080 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36081 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36082 .next
36083 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36084 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36085 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36086 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36087 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36088 doing.
36089 .next
36090 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36091 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36092 message:
36093 .olist
36094 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36095 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36096 .next
36097 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36098 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36099 .next
36100 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36101 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36102 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36103 .code
36104 errors_to = <>
36105 .endd
36106 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36107 .endlist olist
36108 .endlist ilist
36109
36110
36111
36112
36113
36114 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36115 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36116 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36117 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36118 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36119 example:
36120 .code
36121 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36122 .endd
36123 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36124 selection marked by asterisks:
36125 .display
36126 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36127 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36128 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36129 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36130 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36131 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36132 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36133 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36134 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36135 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36136 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36137 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36138 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36139 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36140 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36141 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36142 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36143 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and QT,DT,D times
36144 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36145 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36146 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36147 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36148 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36149 &` pid `& Exim process id
36150 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36151 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36152 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36153 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36154 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36155 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36156 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36157 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36158 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36159 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36160 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36161 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36162 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36163 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36164 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36165 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36166 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36167 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36168 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36169 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36170 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36171 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36172 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36173
36174 &` all `& all of the above
36175 .endd
36176 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36177 section &<<SECID99>>&
36178
36179 More details on each of these items follows:
36180
36181 .ilist
36182 .cindex "8BITMIME"
36183 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36184 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36185 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36186 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36187 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36188 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36189 .next
36190 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36191 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36192 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36193 this log selector is set.
36194 .next
36195 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36196 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36197 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36198 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36199 such users cannot access the log).
36200 .next
36201 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36202 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36203 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36204 parentheses between them.
36205 .next
36206 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36207 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36208 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36209 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36210 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36211 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36212 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36213 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36214 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36215 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36216 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36217 between the caller and Exim.
36218 .next
36219 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36220 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36221 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36222 .next
36223 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36224 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36225 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36226 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36227 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36228 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36229 .next
36230 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36231 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36232 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36233 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36234 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304`&.
36235 .next
36236 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36237 .cindex "size" "of message"
36238 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36239 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36240 .next
36241 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36242 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36243 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36244 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36245 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36246 .next
36247 .cindex log dnssec
36248 .cindex dnssec logging
36249 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36250 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36251 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36252 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36253 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36254 .next
36255 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36256 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36257 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36258 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36259 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36260 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36261 .next
36262 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36263 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36264 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36265 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36266 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36267 .next
36268 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36269 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36270 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36271 client's ident port times out.
36272 .next
36273 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36274 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36275 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36276 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36277 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36278 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36279 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36280 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36281 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36282 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36283 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36284 .next
36285 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36286 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36287 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36288 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36289 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36290 on a proxied connection
36291 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36292 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36293 .next
36294 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36295 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36296 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36297 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36298 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36299 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36300 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36301 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36302 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36303 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36304 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36305 .next
36306 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36307 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36308 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36309 .next
36310 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36311 .cindex millisecond logging
36312 .cindex timstamps "millisecond, in logs"
36313 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36314 appended to the seconds value.
36315 .next
36316 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36317 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36318 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36319 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36320 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36321 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36322 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36323 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36324 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36325 .next
36326 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36327 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
36328 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36329 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36330 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36331 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36332 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36333 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36334 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36335 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36336 .next
36337 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36338 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36339 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36340 immediately after the time and date.
36341 .next
36342 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36343 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36344 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36345 .next
36346 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36347 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36348 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36349 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36350 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36351 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36352 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36353 message has been successfully received.
36354 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36355 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36356 .next
36357 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36358 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36359 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36360 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36361 .next
36362 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36363 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36364 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36365 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36366 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36367 has taken place.
36368 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36369 in the list.
36370 .next
36371 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36372 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36373 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36374 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36375 .next
36376 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36377 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36378 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36379 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36380 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36381 .next
36382 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36383 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36384 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36385 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36386 attempt.
36387 .next
36388 .cindex "log" "return path"
36389 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36390 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36391 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36392 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36393 .next
36394 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36395 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36396 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36397 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36398 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36399 .next
36400 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36401 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36402 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36403 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36404 detail is lost.
36405 .next
36406 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36407 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36408 it is too big.
36409 .next
36410 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36411 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36412 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36413 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36414 it.
36415 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36416 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36417 .next
36418 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36419 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36420 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36421 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36422 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36423 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36424 response.
36425 .next
36426 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36427 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36428 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36429 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36430 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36431 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36432 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36433 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36434 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36435 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36436
36437 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36438 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36439 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36440 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36441 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36442 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36443 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36444 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36445 .next
36446 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36447 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36448 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36449 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36450 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36451 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36452 .next
36453 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36454 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36455 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36456 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36457 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36458 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36459 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36460 already have their own log lines.
36461
36462 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36463 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36464 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36465 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36466 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36467 the same logging options.
36468
36469 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36470 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36471 .code
36472 C=EHLO,QUIT
36473 .endd
36474 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36475 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36476 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36477 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36478 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36479 .next
36480 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36481 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36482 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36483 was accepted or used.
36484 .next
36485 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36486 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36487 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36488 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36489 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36490 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36491 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36492 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36493 .next
36494 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36495 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36496 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36497 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36498 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36499 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36500 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36501 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36502 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36503 .next
36504 .cindex "log" "subject"
36505 .cindex "subject, logging"
36506 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36507 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36508 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36509 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36510 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36511 .next
36512 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36513 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36514 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36515 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36516 .next
36517 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36518 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36519 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36520 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36521 .next
36522 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36523 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36524 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36525 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36526 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36527 .next
36528 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36529 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36530 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36531 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36532 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36533 .next
36534 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36535 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36536 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36537 .endlist
36538
36539
36540 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36541 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36542 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36543 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36544 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36545 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36546 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36547 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36548 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36549 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36550 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36551 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36552 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36553
36554 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36555 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36556 &%message_logs%& option false.
36557 .ecindex IIDloggen
36558
36559
36560
36561
36562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36564
36565 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36566 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36567 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36568 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36569 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36570
36571 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36572 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36573 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36574 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36575 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36576 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36577 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36578 various criteria"
36579 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36580 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36581 "extract statistics from the log"
36582 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36583 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36584 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36585 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36586 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36587 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36588 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36589 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36590 .endtable
36591
36592 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36593 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36594 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36595
36596
36597
36598
36599 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36600 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36601 .cindex "process, querying"
36602 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36603 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36604 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36605 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36606 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36607 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36608 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36609 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36610 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36611
36612 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36613 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36614 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36615
36616
36617 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36618 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36619 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36620 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36621 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36622 options:
36623 .display
36624 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36625 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36626 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36627 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36628 .endd
36629 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36630 .code
36631 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36632 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36633 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36634 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36635 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36636 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36637 .endd
36638 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36639 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36640
36641
36642
36643 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36644 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36645 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36646 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36647 .code
36648 exim -bpu
36649 .endd
36650 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36651 .code
36652 exim -bp
36653 .endd
36654 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36655 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36656
36657 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36658 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36659
36660 .vlist
36661 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36662 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36663 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36664 .code
36665 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36666 .endd
36667 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36668 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36669 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36670
36671 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36672 Match against the size field.
36673
36674 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36675 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36676
36677 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36678 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36679
36680 .vitem &*-z*&
36681 Match only frozen messages.
36682
36683 .vitem &*-x*&
36684 Match only non-frozen messages.
36685 .endlist
36686
36687 The following options control the format of the output:
36688
36689 .vlist
36690 .vitem &*-c*&
36691 Display only the count of matching messages.
36692
36693 .vitem &*-l*&
36694 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36695 the default.
36696
36697 .vitem &*-i*&
36698 Display message ids only.
36699
36700 .vitem &*-b*&
36701 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36702
36703 .vitem &*-R*&
36704 Display messages in reverse order.
36705
36706 .vitem &*-a*&
36707 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36708 .endlist
36709
36710 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36711
36712
36713
36714 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36715 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36716 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36717 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36718 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36719 running a command such as
36720 .code
36721 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36722 .endd
36723 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36724 it, as in the following example:
36725 .code
36726 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36727 .endd
36728 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36729 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36730 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36731 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36732
36733 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36734 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36735 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36736 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36737 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36738 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36739 sender.
36740
36741 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36742 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36743 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36744 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36745 level"& addresses).
36746
36747
36748
36749
36750 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36751 "SECTextspeinf"
36752 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36753 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36754 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36755 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36756 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36757 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36758 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36759 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36760 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36761 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36762 .display
36763 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36764 .endd
36765 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36766
36767 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36768 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36769 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36770
36771 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36772 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36773 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36774 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36775 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36776
36777 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36778 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36779 regular expression.
36780
36781 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36782 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36783
36784 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36785 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36786 normally.
36787
36788 Example of &%-M%&:
36789 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36790 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36791 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36792 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36793 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36794 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36795 search term.
36796
36797 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36798 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36799 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36800 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36801 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36802
36803
36804 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36805 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36806 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36807 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36808 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
36809 the &%--help%& option.
36810
36811
36812 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36813 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36814 .cindex "cycling logs"
36815 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36816 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36817 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36818 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36819 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36820 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36821 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36822 .ilist
36823 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36824 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36825 .next
36826 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36827 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36828 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36829 configuration.
36830 .endlist
36831
36832 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36833 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36834 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36835 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36836 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36837 logs are handled similarly.
36838
36839 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36840 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36841 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36842 any existing log files.
36843
36844 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36845 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36846 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36847 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36848 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36849 .code
36850 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36851 .endd
36852 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36853 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36854
36855
36856
36857 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36858 .cindex "statistics"
36859 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36860 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36861 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36862 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36863 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36864
36865 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36866 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36867 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36868 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36869 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36870 .code
36871 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36872 .endd
36873 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36874 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36875 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36876 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36877 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36878 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36879 also produced per user.
36880
36881 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36882 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36883 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36884 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36885 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36886
36887 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36888 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36889 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36890 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36891 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36892 an entirely separate message.
36893
36894 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36895 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36896 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36897 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36898 least one address that failed.
36899
36900 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36901 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36902 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36903 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36904 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36905 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36906 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36907
36908 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36909 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36910 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36911
36912 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36913 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36914 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36915 .code
36916 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36917 .endd
36918
36919 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36920 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36921 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36922 .cindex "checking access"
36923 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36924 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36925 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36926 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36927 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36928 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36929
36930 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36931 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36932 .code
36933 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36934 .endd
36935 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36936 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36937 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36938 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36939 .code
36940 Rejected:
36941 550 Relay not permitted
36942 .endd
36943 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36944 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36945 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36946 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36947 you can use:
36948 .code
36949 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36950 -f himself@there.example
36951 .endd
36952 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36953 mandatory arguments.
36954
36955 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36956 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36957 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36958
36959
36960
36961 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36962 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36963 .cindex "building DBM files"
36964 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36965 .cindex "lower casing"
36966 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36967 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36968 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36969 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36970 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36971 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36972
36973 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36974 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36975 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36976 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36977 files.
36978
36979 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36980 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36981 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36982 well.
36983
36984 .cindex "USE_DB"
36985 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36986 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36987 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36988 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36989 .code
36990 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36991 .endd
36992 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36993 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36994
36995 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36996 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36997 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36998 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36999 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37000 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37001
37002 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37003 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37004 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37005 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37006 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37007 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37008 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37009 return code is 2.
37010
37011
37012
37013
37014 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37015 .cindex "retry" "times"
37016 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37017 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37018 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37019 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37020 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37021 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37022 output. For example:
37023 .code
37024 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37025 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37026 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37027 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37028 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37029 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37030 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37031 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37032 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37033 past final cutoff time
37034 .endd
37035 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37036 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37037 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37038 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37039 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37040 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37041 run very often.
37042
37043 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37044 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37045 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37046 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37047 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37048 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37049
37050
37051
37052 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37053 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37054 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37055 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37056 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37057 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37058 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37059
37060 .ilist
37061 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37062 .next
37063 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37064 for remote hosts
37065 .next
37066 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37067 .next
37068 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37069 .next
37070 &'misc'&: other hints data
37071 .endlist
37072
37073 The &'misc'& database is used for
37074
37075 .ilist
37076 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37077 .next
37078 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37079 &(smtp)& transport)
37080 .next
37081 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37082 in a transport)
37083 .endlist
37084
37085
37086
37087 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37088 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37089 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37090 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37091 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37092 .code
37093 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37094 .endd
37095 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37096 .code
37097 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37098 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37099 .endd
37100 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37101 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37102 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37103 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37104 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37105 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37106 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37107 and a textual description of the error.
37108
37109 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37110 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37111 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37112 exceeded.
37113
37114 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37115 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37116 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37117 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37118 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37119 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37120 cross-references.
37121
37122
37123
37124 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37125 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37126 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37127 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37128 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37129 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37130 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37131 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37132 updated sufficiently often.
37133
37134 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37135 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37136 the retry database:
37137 .code
37138 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37139 .endd
37140 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37141 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37142 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37143 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37144 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37145 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37146 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37147 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37148 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37149 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37150 whenever it removes information from the database.
37151
37152 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37153 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37154 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37155 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37156 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37157
37158 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37159 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37160 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37161 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37162 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37163 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37164 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37165 tidied.
37166
37167 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37168 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37169
37170
37171
37172
37173 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37174 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37175 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37176 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37177 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37178 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37179 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37180 displayed.
37181
37182 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37183 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37184 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37185 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37186 by new data, for example:
37187 .code
37188 > 4 951102:1000
37189 .endd
37190 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37191 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37192 used as optional separators.
37193
37194
37195
37196
37197 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37198 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37199 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37200 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37201 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37202 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37203 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37204 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37205 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37206 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37207 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37208 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37209 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37210
37211 .vlist
37212 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
37213 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37214
37215 .vitem &%-flock%&
37216 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37217 supports it.
37218
37219 .vitem &%-interval%&
37220 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37221 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37222
37223 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37224 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37225
37226 .vitem &%-mbx%&
37227 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37228
37229 .vitem &%-q%&
37230 Suppress verification output.
37231
37232 .vitem &%-retries%&
37233 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37234 the lock (default 10).
37235
37236 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37237 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37238 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37239 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37240 subsequently sees.
37241
37242 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37243 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37244 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37245 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37246
37247 .vitem &%-v%&
37248 Generate verbose output.
37249 .endlist
37250
37251 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37252 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37253 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37254 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37255 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37256 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37257 more than 30 minutes old.
37258
37259 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37260 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37261 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37262 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37263 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37264 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37265
37266 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37267 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37268 suppresses all output except error messages.
37269
37270 A command such as
37271 .code
37272 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37273 .endd
37274 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37275 .display
37276 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37277 <&'some commands'&>
37278 &`End`&
37279 .endd
37280 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37281 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37282 such as
37283 .code
37284 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37285 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37286 .endd
37287 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37288 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37289 .ecindex IIDutils
37290
37291
37292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37294
37295 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37296 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37297 .cindex "X-windows"
37298 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37299 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37300 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37301 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37302 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37303 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37304 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37305 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37306
37307
37308
37309 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37310 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37311 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37312 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37313 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37314 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37315 parameters are for.
37316
37317 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37318 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37319 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37320 .code
37321 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37322 .endd
37323 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37324 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37325 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37326 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37327 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37328
37329 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37330 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37331 .code
37332 Eximon*background: gray94
37333 .endd
37334 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37335 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37336 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37337 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37338 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37339 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37340 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37341 .code
37342 xrdb -merge <<End
37343 Eximon*highlight: gray
37344 End
37345 .endd
37346 .cindex "admin user"
37347 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37348 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37349
37350 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37351 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37352 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37353 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37354 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37355
37356 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37357 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37358 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37359 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37360 different parts of the display.
37361
37362
37363
37364
37365 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37366 .cindex "stripchart"
37367 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37368 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37369 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37370 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37371 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37372 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37373 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37374 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37375 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37376
37377 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37378 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37379 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37380 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37381
37382 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37383 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37384 to a single partition.
37385
37386 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37387 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37388 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37389 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37390 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37391 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37392 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37393
37394
37395
37396
37397 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37398 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37399 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37400 .cindex "window size"
37401 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37402 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37403 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37404 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37405 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37406 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37407
37408 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37409 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37410 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37411 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37412
37413 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37414 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37415 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37416 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37417 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37418 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37419
37420 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37421 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37422 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37423
37424
37425
37426 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37427 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37428 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37429 the main log is maintained.
37430 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37431 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37432 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37433 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37434 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37435
37436 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37437 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37438 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37439 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37440 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37441 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37442 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37443 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37444 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37445 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37446 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37447
37448 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37449 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37450 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37451 It cannot go further back up the log.
37452
37453 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37454 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37455 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37456 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37457 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37458 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37459
37460 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37461 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37462 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37463 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37464 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37465 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37466
37467 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37468 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37469 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37470 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37471 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37472 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37473 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37474 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37475 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37476 window.
37477
37478
37479
37480 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37481 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37482 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37483 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37484 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37485 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37486 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37487 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37488 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37489 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37490
37491 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37492 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37493 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37494 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37495 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37496 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37497 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37498
37499 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37500 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37501 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37502 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37503 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37504 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37505 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37506
37507 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37508 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37509 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37510 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37511
37512 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37513 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37514 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37515 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37516 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37517 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37518 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37519 not shown.
37520
37521 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37522 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37523
37524 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37525 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37526 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37527 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37528 display is updated.
37529
37530
37531
37532 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37533 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37534 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37535 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37536 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37537 any selected text.
37538
37539 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37540 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37541 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37542 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37543 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37544 .code
37545 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37546 .endd
37547 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37548 follows:
37549
37550 .ilist
37551 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37552 in a new text window.
37553 .next
37554 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37555 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37556 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37557 .next
37558 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37559 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37560 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37561 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37562 .next
37563 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37564 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37565 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37566 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37567 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37568 .next
37569 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37570 that the message be frozen.
37571 .next
37572 .cindex "thawing messages"
37573 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37574 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37575 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37576 that the message be thawed.
37577 .next
37578 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37579 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37580 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37581 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37582 .next
37583 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37584 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37585 message.
37586 .next
37587 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37588 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37589 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37590 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37591 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37592 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37593 which case no action is taken.
37594 .next
37595 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37596 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37597 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37598 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37599 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37600 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37601 case no action is taken.
37602 .next
37603 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37604 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37605 .next
37606 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37607 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37608 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37609 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37610 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37611 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37612 the address is qualified with that domain.
37613 .endlist
37614
37615 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37616 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37617 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37618 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37619 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37620 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37621 if no output is generated.
37622
37623 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37624 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37625 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37626 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37627
37628 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37629 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37630 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37631 .ecindex IIDeximon
37632
37633
37634
37635
37636
37637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37639
37640 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37641 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37642 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37643 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37644
37645 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37646 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37647 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37648 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37649 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37650 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37651
37652 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37653 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37654 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37655 as soon as possible.
37656
37657
37658 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37659 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37660 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37661 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37662 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37663 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37664
37665 .ilist
37666 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37667 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37668 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37669 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37670 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37671 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37672
37673 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37674 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37675 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37676 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37677 .next
37678
37679 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37680 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37681 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37682 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37683 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37684 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37685 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37686 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37687 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37688 separate commands.
37689
37690 .next
37691 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37692 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37693 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37694 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37695 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37696 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37697 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37698 .next
37699 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37700 is disabled.
37701 .next
37702 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37703 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37704 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37705 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37706 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37707 .endlist
37708
37709
37710
37711 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37712 .cindex "setuid"
37713 .cindex "root privilege"
37714 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37715 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37716 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37717 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37718 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37719 is required for two things:
37720
37721 .ilist
37722 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37723 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37724 not required.
37725 .next
37726 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37727 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37728 configuration.
37729 .endlist
37730
37731 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37732 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37733 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37734 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37735 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37736 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37737 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37738 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37739
37740 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37741 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37742 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37743
37744 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37745 uid and gid in the following cases:
37746
37747 .ilist
37748 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37749 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37750 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37751 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37752 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37753 the calling process.
37754 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37755 option may not be used at all.
37756 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37757 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37758 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37759 .next
37760 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37761 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37762 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37763 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37764 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37765 calling process.
37766 .next
37767 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37768 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37769 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37770 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37771 testing address verification
37772 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37773 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37774 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37775 option).
37776 .next
37777 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37778 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37779 .endlist
37780
37781 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37782
37783 .ilist
37784 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37785 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37786 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37787 will be used during message reception.
37788 .next
37789 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37790 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37791 .next
37792 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37793 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37794 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37795 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37796 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37797 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37798 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37799 generating bounce and warning messages.
37800
37801 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37802 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37803 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37804 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37805 .next
37806 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37807 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37808 .endlist
37809
37810
37811
37812
37813 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37814 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37815 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37816 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37817 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37818 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37819 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37820 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37821 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37822 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37823 to any other uid.
37824
37825 .cindex SIGHUP
37826 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37827 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37828 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37829 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37830
37831 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37832 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37833 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37834 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37835 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37836
37837 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37838 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37839 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37840 effect.
37841
37842 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37843 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37844 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37845
37846 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37847 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37848 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37849 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37850 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37851 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37852 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37853 address this problem at this time.
37854
37855 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37856 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37857 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37858 be used in the most straightforward way.
37859
37860 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37861 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37862
37863 .ilist
37864 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37865 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37866 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37867 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37868 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37869 .next
37870 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37871 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37872 .next
37873 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37874 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37875 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37876 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37877 .next
37878 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37879 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37880
37881 .olist
37882 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37883 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37884 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37885 .next
37886 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37887 owned by the Exim user.
37888 .next
37889 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37890 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37891 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37892 .endlist olist
37893 .endlist ilist
37894
37895
37896 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37897 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37898 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37899 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37900
37901 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37902 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37903
37904
37905
37906
37907 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37908 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37909 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37910
37911
37912
37913 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37914 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37915 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37916 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37917 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37918 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37919 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37920
37921 .ilist
37922 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37923 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37924 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37925 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37926 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37927 .next
37928 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37929 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37930 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37931 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37932 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37933 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37934 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37935 .next
37936 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37937 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37938 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37939 .next
37940 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37941 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37942 .next
37943 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37944 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37945 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37946 .next
37947 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37948 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37949 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37950 of opaque strings.
37951 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37952 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37953 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37954 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37955 .endlist
37956
37957
37958
37959
37960 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37961 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37962 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37963 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37964 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37965 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37966 are some issues to be aware of:
37967
37968 .ilist
37969 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37970 .next
37971 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37972 .next
37973 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37974 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37975 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37976 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37977 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37978 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37979 data.
37980 .next
37981 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37982 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37983 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37984 .next
37985 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37986 expected to yield one result.
37987 .endlist
37988
37989
37990
37991
37992 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37993 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37994 .cindex "IP source routing"
37995 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37996 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37997 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37998 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37999
38000
38001
38002 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38003 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38004 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38005
38006
38007
38008
38009 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38010 .cindex "trusted users"
38011 .cindex "admin user"
38012 .cindex "privileged user"
38013 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38014 .cindex "user" "admin"
38015 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38016 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38017 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38018 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38019 permit a remote host to be specified.
38020
38021 .oindex "&%-f%&"
38022 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38023 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38024 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38025 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38026 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38027 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38028
38029 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38030 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38031 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38032 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38033 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38034
38035 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38036 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38037 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38038 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38039 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38040
38041 .oindex "&%-M%&"
38042 .oindex "&%-q%&"
38043 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38044 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38045 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38046 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38047 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38048 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38049
38050 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38051 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38052 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38053 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38054 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38055 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38056 files.
38057
38058 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38059 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38060 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38061 This affects most of the checking options,
38062 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38063
38064
38065 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38066 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38067 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38068 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38069 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38070 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38071
38072
38073
38074 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38075 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38076 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38077 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38078 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38079 this.
38080
38081
38082
38083 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38084 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38085 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38086 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38087 converted output.
38088
38089
38090
38091 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38092 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38093 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38094 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38095 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38096
38097
38098
38099 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38100 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38101 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38102 loading it.
38103
38104
38105 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38106 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38107 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38108 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38109 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38110 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38111 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38112
38113 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38114 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38115 string.
38116
38117
38118
38119 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38120 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38121 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38122 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38123
38124
38125
38126 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38127 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38128 enough to hold the result.
38129 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38130
38131
38132
38133
38134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38136
38137 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38138 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38139 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38140 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38141 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38142 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38143 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38144 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38145 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38146 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38147 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38148 themselves are recoverable.
38149
38150 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38151 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38152 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38153
38154 .ilist
38155 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38156 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38157 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38158 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38159 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38160 .next
38161 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38162 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38163 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38164 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38165 .next
38166 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38167 .next
38168 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38169 signature.
38170 .endlist
38171 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38172
38173 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38174 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38175 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38176 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38177 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38178 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38179 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38180 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38181 attempt.
38182
38183 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38184 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38185 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38186 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38187
38188 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38189 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38190 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38191 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38192 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38193 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38194 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38195 normally the Exim user.
38196
38197 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38198 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38199 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38200 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38201 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38202 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38203 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38204 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38205
38206 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38207 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38208 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38209 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38210
38211 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38212 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38213
38214 .vlist
38215 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38216 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38217 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38218 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38219 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38220 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38221 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38222 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38223 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38224 newlines.
38225
38226 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38227 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38228 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38229 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38230 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38231 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38232
38233 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38234 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38235 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38236 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38237 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38238 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38239
38240 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38241 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38242 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38243
38244 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38245 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38246 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38247 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38248 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38249
38250 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38251 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38252 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38253 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38254 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38255
38256 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38257 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38258 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38259
38260 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38261 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38262 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38263
38264 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38265 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38266 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38267
38268 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38269 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38270 present if the number is greater than zero.
38271
38272 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38273 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38274 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38275
38276 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38277 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38278 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38279
38280 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38281 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38282 command.
38283
38284 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38285 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38286 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38287 messages.
38288
38289 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38290 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38291 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38292 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38293
38294 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38295 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38296 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38297
38298 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38299 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38300 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38301 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38302 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38303 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38304
38305 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38306 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38307 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38308 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38309 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38310
38311 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38312 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38313 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38314 generated messages.
38315
38316 .vitem &%-local%&
38317 The message is from a local sender.
38318
38319 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38320 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38321
38322 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38323 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38324 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38325 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38326
38327 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38328 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38329 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38330
38331 .vitem &%-N%&
38332 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38333 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38334 &%-N%& is assumed.
38335
38336 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38337 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38338 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38339
38340 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38341 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38342 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38343
38344 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38345 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38346 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38347
38348 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38349 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38350 rather than Unix-format.
38351 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38352 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38353
38354 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38355 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38356 certificate was verified by the server.
38357
38358 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38359 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38360 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38361
38362 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38363 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38364 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38365 certificate.
38366 .endlist
38367
38368 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38369 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38370 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38371 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38372 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38373 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38374 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38375 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38376 addresses are complete.
38377
38378 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38379 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38380 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38381 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38382 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38383 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38384 .code
38385 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38386 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38387 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38388 .endd
38389 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38390 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38391 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38392 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38393 example:
38394 .code
38395 4
38396 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38397 darcy@austen.fict.example
38398 rdo@foundation
38399 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38400 .endd
38401 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38402 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38403 line is of the following form:
38404 .display
38405 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38406 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38407 .endd
38408 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38409 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38410 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38411 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38412 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38413 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38414 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38415 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38416
38417
38418 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38419 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38420 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38421 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38422 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38423 following:
38424
38425 .table2 50pt
38426 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38427 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38428 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38429 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38430 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38431 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38432 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38433 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38434 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38435 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38436 .endtable
38437
38438 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38439 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38440 typical set of headers:
38441 .code
38442 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38443 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38444 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38445 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38446 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38447 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38448 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38449 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38450 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38451 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38452 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38453 .endd
38454 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38455 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38456 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38457 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38458 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38459 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38460
38461 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38462 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38463 an ASCII newline character.
38464 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38465 can have an alternate format.
38466 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38467 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38468 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38469 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38470 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38471 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38472
38473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38474 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38475
38476 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38477 "DKIM Support"
38478 .cindex "DKIM"
38479
38480 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38481 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38482 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38483 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38484
38485 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38486 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38487
38488 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38489 .olist
38490 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38491 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38492 (including transport filters)
38493 except cutthrough delivery.
38494 .next
38495 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38496 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38497 different signature contexts.
38498 .endlist
38499
38500 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38501 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38502 Exim's standard controls.
38503
38504 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38505 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38506 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38507 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38508 .code
38509 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38510 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38511 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38512 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38513 .endd
38514 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38515 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38516 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38517 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38518 senders).
38519
38520
38521 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38522 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38523
38524 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38525 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38526
38527 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38528 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38529 After expansion, this can be a list.
38530 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38531 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38532 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38533
38534 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38535 This sets the key selector string.
38536 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38537 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38538 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38539 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38540 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain.
38541
38542 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38543 This sets the private key to use.
38544 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38545 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38546 The result can either
38547 .ilist
38548 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38549 .next
38550 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38551 the private key.
38552 .next
38553 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38554 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38555 is set.
38556 .endlist
38557 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38558
38559 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38560 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38561 method. Note that sha1 is now condidered insecure, and deprecated.
38562
38563 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
38564 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
38565 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
38566 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
38567 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
38568 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
38569
38570 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38571 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38572 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38573 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38574 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38575
38576 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38577 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38578 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38579 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38580 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38581 variables here.
38582
38583 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
38584 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
38585 list of header names.
38586 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
38587 in the message signature.
38588 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
38589 whether or not each header is present in the message.
38590 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
38591 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
38592
38593 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence therof)
38594 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
38595 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
38596
38597 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
38598 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
38599 will be signed.
38600 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
38601 will be signed, and one signtature added for a missing header with the
38602 name will be appended.
38603
38604
38605 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38606 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38607
38608 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38609 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38610 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38611 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38612 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38613 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
38614 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38615
38616 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38617 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38618 runtime of the ACL.
38619
38620 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38621 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38622 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38623 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38624
38625 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38626 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38627 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38628 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38629 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38630 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38631 it defaults as:
38632 .code
38633 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38634 .endd
38635 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38636 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38637 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38638 .code
38639 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38640 .endd
38641 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38642 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38643 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38644 .code
38645 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38646 .endd
38647
38648 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38649 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38650
38651 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
38652 for each matching signature.
38653
38654
38655 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38656 available (from most to least important):
38657
38658
38659 .vlist
38660 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38661 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38662 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38663 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38664
38665 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38666 Within the DKIM ACL,
38667 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38668 .ilist
38669 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38670 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38671 .next
38672 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38673 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38674 .next
38675 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38676 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38677 .next
38678 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38679 .endlist
38680
38681 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
38682 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
38683 hash-method or key-size:
38684 .code
38685 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}}
38686 condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
38687 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
38688 set dkim_verify_status = fail
38689 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak
38690 .endd
38691
38692 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
38693 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
38694
38695 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38696 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38697 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38698 .ilist
38699 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38700 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38701 .next
38702 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38703 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38704 .next
38705 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38706 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38707 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38708 .next
38709 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38710 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38711 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38712 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38713 .endlist
38714
38715 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
38716
38717 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38718 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38719 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38720 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38721
38722 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38723 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38724 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38725 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38726
38727 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38728 The key record selector string.
38729
38730 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38731 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38732
38733 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38734 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38735
38736 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
38737 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38738
38739 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38740 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38741 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38742 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
38743 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
38744 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
38745
38746 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38747 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38748 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38749 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38750
38751 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38752 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38753 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38754
38755 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38756 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38757 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38758 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38759 integer size comparisons against this value.
38760
38761 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38762 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38763
38764 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38765 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38766
38767 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38768 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38769
38770 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38771 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38772 in the key record.
38773
38774 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38775 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38776 in the key record.
38777
38778 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38779 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38780
38781 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38782 Number of bits in the key.
38783 .endlist
38784
38785 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38786
38787 .vlist
38788 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38789 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38790 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38791 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38792 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38793
38794 .code
38795 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
38796 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
38797 sender_domains = gmail.com
38798 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38799 dkim_status = none
38800 .endd
38801
38802 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
38803 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
38804
38805 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38806 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38807 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38808 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38809
38810 .code
38811 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38812 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38813 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38814 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38815 .endd
38816
38817 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38818 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38819 for more information of what they mean.
38820 .endlist
38821
38822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38823 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38824
38825 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38826 "Proxy support"
38827 .cindex "proxy support"
38828 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38829
38830 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38831 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38832
38833
38834 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38835 .cindex proxy inbound
38836 .cindex proxy "server side"
38837 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38838 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38839
38840 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38841 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38842 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38843 in Local/Makefile.
38844
38845 It was built on specifications from:
38846 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
38847 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38848 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
38849
38850 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38851 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38852 to distribute load.
38853 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38854 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38855 There is no logging if a host passes or
38856 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38857 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38858
38859 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38860 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38861 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38862 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
38863 automatically determines which version is in use.
38864
38865 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
38866 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
38867 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
38868 Exim and the proxy server.
38869
38870 The following expansion variables are usable
38871 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38872 of the proxy):
38873 .display
38874 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
38875 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
38876 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
38877 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
38878 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38879 .endd
38880 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
38881 there was a protocol error.
38882
38883 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38884 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38885 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38886 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38887 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38888 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38889 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38890 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38891 A possible solution is:
38892 .display
38893 # Set max number of connections per host
38894 LIMIT = 5
38895 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38896 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38897
38898 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38899 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38900 .endd
38901
38902
38903
38904 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38905 .cindex proxy outbound
38906 .cindex proxy "client side"
38907 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38908 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38909 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38910 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38911 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38912 Local/Makefile.
38913
38914 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38915 on an smtp transport.
38916 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38917 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38918 Each proxy specifier is a list
38919 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38920 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38921
38922 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38923 The list of options is in the following table:
38924 .display
38925 &'auth '& authentication method
38926 &'name '& authentication username
38927 &'pass '& authentication password
38928 &'port '& tcp port
38929 &'tmo '& connection timeout
38930 &'pri '& priority
38931 &'weight '& selection bias
38932 .endd
38933
38934 More details on each of these options follows:
38935
38936 .ilist
38937 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38938 .cindex proxy authentication
38939 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38940 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38941 for access to the proxy.
38942 Default is &"none"&.
38943 .next
38944 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38945 Default is empty.
38946 .next
38947 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38948 Default is empty.
38949 .next
38950 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38951 Default is 1080.
38952 .next
38953 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38954 Default is 5.
38955 .next
38956 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38957 higher values being tried first.
38958 The default priority is 1.
38959 .next
38960 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38961 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38962 weighted by this value.
38963 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38964 .endlist
38965
38966 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38967 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38968 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38969
38970 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
38971 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38972 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38973 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38974
38975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38977
38978 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38979 "Internationalisation""
38980 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
38981 .cindex EAI
38982 .cindex i18n
38983 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38984
38985 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38986 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38987 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38988
38989 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
38990 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
38991 requirement, upon libidn2.
38992
38993 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38994 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38995 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38996 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38997 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38998 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38999
39000 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39001 international handling for the message is enabled and
39002 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39003
39004 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39005 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39006 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39007 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39008
39009 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39010 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39011 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39012 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39013
39014 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39015 components expanded to a-label form,
39016 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39017 form of the name.
39018
39019 .cindex log protocol
39020 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39021 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39022 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39023
39024 The following expansion operators can be used:
39025 .code
39026 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39027 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39028 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39029 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39030 .endd
39031
39032 ACLs may use the following modifier:
39033 .display
39034 control = utf8_downconvert
39035 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39036 .endd
39037 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39038 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39039 Message Submission Agent context.
39040 If a value is appended it may be:
39041 .display
39042 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39043 &`0 `& no downconversion
39044 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39045 .endd
39046
39047 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39048 is initially set to -1.
39049
39050
39051 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39052 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39053 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39054
39055 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39056 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39057 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39058
39059 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39060 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39061
39062
39063
39064 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39065 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39066 the following expansion operator can be used:
39067 .code
39068 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39069 .endd
39070
39071 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39072 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39073 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39074 to the
39075 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39076 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
39077 (which has to be a single character)
39078 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39079 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39080
39081 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39082 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39083
39084 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39085 by many other IMAP servers.
39086
39087 Examples:
39088 .display
39089 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39090 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39091 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39092 .endd
39093
39094 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39095 must be representable in UTF-16.
39096
39097
39098 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39099 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39100
39101 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39102 "Events"
39103 .cindex events
39104
39105 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39106 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39107 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39108 processing actions.
39109
39110 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39111 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39112 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39113
39114 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39115 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39116 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39117
39118 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39119 An example might look like:
39120 .cindex logging custom
39121 .code
39122 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39123 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39124 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39125 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39126 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39127 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39128 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39129 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39130 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39131 } {}}
39132 .endd
39133
39134 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39135 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39136 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39137
39138 The current list of events is:
39139 .display
39140 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39141 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39142 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39143 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39144 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39145 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39146 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39147 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39148 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39149 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39150 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39151 .endd
39152 New event types may be added in future.
39153
39154 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39155 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39156 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39157
39158 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39159 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39160 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39161
39162 The third column in the table above says what section of the configumration
39163 should define the event action.
39164
39165 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39166 with the event type:
39167 .display
39168 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39169 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39170 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39171 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39172 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39173 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39174 .endd
39175
39176 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39177
39178 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39179 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39180 the course of its processing:
39181 .ilist
39182 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39183 transport call
39184 .next
39185 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39186 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39187 .endlist
39188 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39189 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39190
39191 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39192 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39193 following will be forced:
39194 .display
39195 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
39196 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
39197 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
39198 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39199 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
39200 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39201 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39202 .endd
39203 No other use is made of the result string.
39204
39205 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39206 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39207 the target system.
39208
39209 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39210 chain element received on the connection.
39211 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39212 loaded locally.
39213
39214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39216
39217 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39218 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39219 .cindex "adding drivers"
39220 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39221 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39222 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39223 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39224
39225 .olist
39226 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39227 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39228 .next
39229 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39230 .display
39231 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39232 .endd
39233 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39234 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39235 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39236 .next
39237 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39238 .code
39239 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39240 .endd
39241 .next
39242 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39243 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39244 .next
39245 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39246 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39247 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39248 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39249 simple form that most lookups have.
39250 .next
39251 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39252 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39253 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39254 .next
39255 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39256 &_src_&.
39257 .next
39258 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39259 as for other drivers and lookups.
39260 .endlist
39261
39262 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39263 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39264 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39265 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39266 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39267
39268 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39269 the interface that is expected.
39270
39271
39272
39273
39274 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39276
39277 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39278 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39279 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39280 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39281 . processors.
39282 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39283
39284 .literal xml
39285 <?sdop
39286 format="newpage"
39287 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39288 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39289 ?>
39290 .literal off
39291
39292 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39293 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39294 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39295
39296
39297 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39298 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////